This document contains the general technical specifications for the 1200 MW Teesta Stage-III Hydroelectric Project. It outlines requirements for various site installations, services, safety precautions, surveying, quality assurance, and commissioning. The contractor must provide site offices, camps, communication systems, medical facilities, and ensure environmental compliance. Safety standards and measures for blasting, ventilation, and pollution control in underground works are also specified. The contractor is responsible for surveying, quality control testing, and commissioning all hydro-mechanical and electrical equipment upon project completion.
This document contains the general technical specifications for the 1200 MW Teesta Stage-III Hydroelectric Project. It outlines requirements for various site installations, services, safety precautions, surveying, quality assurance, and commissioning. The contractor must provide site offices, camps, communication systems, medical facilities, and ensure environmental compliance. Safety standards and measures for blasting, ventilation, and pollution control in underground works are also specified. The contractor is responsible for surveying, quality control testing, and commissioning all hydro-mechanical and electrical equipment upon project completion.
This document contains the general technical specifications for the 1200 MW Teesta Stage-III Hydroelectric Project. It outlines requirements for various site installations, services, safety precautions, surveying, quality assurance, and commissioning. The contractor must provide site offices, camps, communication systems, medical facilities, and ensure environmental compliance. Safety standards and measures for blasting, ventilation, and pollution control in underground works are also specified. The contractor is responsible for surveying, quality control testing, and commissioning all hydro-mechanical and electrical equipment upon project completion.
This document contains the general technical specifications for the 1200 MW Teesta Stage-III Hydroelectric Project. It outlines requirements for various site installations, services, safety precautions, surveying, quality assurance, and commissioning. The contractor must provide site offices, camps, communication systems, medical facilities, and ensure environmental compliance. Safety standards and measures for blasting, ventilation, and pollution control in underground works are also specified. The contractor is responsible for surveying, quality control testing, and commissioning all hydro-mechanical and electrical equipment upon project completion.
Contents 1. PREAMBLE TO THE TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS ..................................................... 1 1.1. GENERAL .............................................................................................................. 1 1.2. SUBMITTALS ........................................................................................................ 1 1.3. STANDARDS AND CODES .................................................................................. 1 1.4. SYSTEM OF UNITS .............................................................................................. 2 1.5. DEFINITION OF TIME AND KEY DATES ............................................................. 3 2. SITE INSTALLATIONS, SERVICES AND ENVIRONMENTAL OBLIGATIONS ................ 3 2.1. SCOPE OF WORK ................................................................................................ 3 2.2. SUBMITTALS ........................................................................................................ 4 2.3. SITE OFFICES, STORES, WAREHOUSES, MATERIALS YARDS ...................... 5 2.4. CONCRETE AND MATERIALS PROCESSING PLANTS ..................................... 5 2.5. MATERIALS TESTING LABORATORY ................................................................ 5 2.6. COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS .............................................................................. 6 2.7. COMMUNICATION SYSTEM IN UNDERGROUND WORKS ............................... 6 2.8. SERVICE & INSPECTION VEHICLES .................................................................. 7 2.9. CAMPS FOR CONTRACTOR'S EMPLOYEES ..................................................... 7 2.10. COMMERCIAL CONCESSIONS ........................................................................... 7 2.11. MEDICAL CARE FACILITIES ................................................................................ 7 2.12. POWER SUPPLY AND ILLUMINATION ............................................................... 8 2.13. WATER SUPPLY ................................................................................................... 8 2.14. SANITATION AND SEWERAGE ........................................................................... 9 2.15. WASTE AND GARBAGE DISPOSAL .................................................................... 9 2.16. FENCING AND SITE SECURITY .......................................................................... 9 ii 2.17. INSPECTION BY THE ENGINEER-IN-CHARGE ................................................. 9 2.18. FINAL CLEAN UP ................................................................................................. 9 2.19. ENVIRONMENTAL OBLIGATIONS .................................................................... 10 2.20. PAYMENT FOR SITE INSTALLATION AND SERVICES ................................... 11 3. SAFETY PRECAUTIONS ............................................................................................... 11 3.1. SAFETY PROGRAMME AND ITS IMPLEMENTATION ..................................... 11 3.2. SAFETY STANDARDS ....................................................................................... 12 3.3. PERSONAL SAFETY EQUIPMENT ................................................................... 12 3.4. RESCUE TEAM .................................................................................................. 13 3.5. ILLUMINATION AND EARTHING ....................................................................... 13 3.6. STORAGE AND TRANSPORT OF EXPLOSIVES ............................................. 14 3.7. BLASTING .......................................................................................................... 15 3.8. VENTILATION OF UNDERGROUND WORKS .................................................. 16 3.9. CONTROL OF DUST, SILICA, AND NOXIOUS GASES IN UNDERGROUND WORKS ................................................................................. 17 3.10. FIRE PRECAUTION ........................................................................................... 18 3.11. DUST ABATEMENT ........................................................................................... 18 3.12. POLLUTION OF STREAMS AND RIVERS ......................................................... 19 3.13. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ..................................................................... 19 4. SURVEYING AND SETTING-OUT WORK ..................................................................... 19 4.1. EXISTING SURVEY CONTROL POINTS ........................................................... 19 4.2. OBLIGATIONS OF THE CONTRACTOR ........................................................... 19 4.3. CHECKING OF CONTRACTOR'S WORK BY THE ENGINEER-IN- CHARGE ............................................................................................................. 21 4.4. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ..................................................................... 22 5. QUALITY ASSURANCE ................................................................................................. 22 5.1. QUALITY ASSURANCE IN EXECUTION OF WORKS ...................................... 22 5.2. CONTROL OF THE PROGRESS OF WORK ..................................................... 23 5.3. CONTRACTORS QUALITY CONTROL STAFF ................................................ 23 iii 5.4. CONTRACTORS LABORATORIES ................................................................... 24 5.5. MATERIAL DELIVERED TO SITE....................................................................... 24 5.6. MEASUREMENT FOR PAYMENT AND PAYMENT ........................................... 24 6. COMMISSIONING ........................................................................................................... 24 6.1. GENERAL ............................................................................................................ 24 6.2. HYDRO-MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT TO BE INSTALLED ................................ 25 6.3. E& M WORKS EQUIPMENT TO BE INSTALLED ............................................... 25 6.4. TESTING OF EQUIPMENT ................................................................................. 25 6.5. COMMISSIONING OF THE PROJECT AS A WHOLE ........................................ 25 6.6. MEASUREMENT FOR PAYMENT AND PAYMENT ........................................... 26
1
1. PREAMBLE TO THE TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 1.1. GENERAL (1) The following Specifications are part of the requirements for the work related to the Permanent and Temporary Works, which are to be provided by the Contractor according to the stipulations of the Contract. Hence, the instructions given herein form an integral part of, and are applicable to, all technical and Contract Documents issued for the Works. Addenda to these Specifications may be issued as required during bidding and construction phases. (2) These Specifications shall be read in conjunction with the Conditions of Contract, the Drawings and the Bill of Quantities, comprising schedule of Quantities, Rates and Amounts (hereinafter called "the Schedule"), and the Contractor shall comply with all provisions contained within the Contract Documents and Engineer-in-Charge's instructions. (3) It is the intent of these Specifications, together with other relevant documents issued as part of the Contract Documents or to follow later on, to provide the Contractor with complete and detailed information and subsequent instructions necessary to enable him to submit a well planned Tender, to carry out the design, where and when required, and to execute properly the work prescribed. (4) It is the intent of these Specifications to establish acceptable standards of quality. Minor deviations in details due to manufacturer's standard shop process will be considered for acceptance provided that, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, the proposed substitutions are equal in quality to those specified. All deviations shall be called out in writing in the Tender, and shall be specifically indicated on the shop drawings (5) All work shall be executed according to the Construction Drawings and requirements released for construction, in a professional and diligent manner, and all supplies and work shall comply with the quality requirements defined in the relevant Sections of these Specifications and other Contract Documents. The Contractor shall endeavour to provide all such necessary efforts in order to comply with the intent of these Specifications to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge. 1.2. SUBMITTALS (1) The Contractor shall provide the Engineer-in-Charge with all submittals as requested for in these Specifications and other Contract Documents. Although their extent shall be to the discretion of the Contractor, they shall be complete enough to illustrate adequately the problem of the aspect concerned for the understanding of the Engineer- in-Charge. (2) At any time the Engineer-in-Charge may call either for additional information, completion of the submittals or request the Contractor not to submit some of them. (3) The Contractor shall submit these documents to the Engineer-in-Charge so that, even if not specifically expressed, reasonable time will be given to the Engineer-in-Charge to comment or approve the submittals. 1.3. STANDARDS AND CODES 1.3.1. General (1) Indian Standards as far as possible are referred to in these Specifications. Pertinent provisions of these standards shall apply to the work, and are hereby incorporated in these Specifications. Where a manufacturer is named, other manufacturers product will also be acceptable provided the designated material or workmanship is of equivalent or better quality and do satisfy the relevant Indian Codes. (2) All standards and codes employed or referred to, shall be the latest current issue in effect at the date 28 days prior to the tender submission date. 2
(3) One complete set of standards and codes adopted for the Works shall be submitted free of charge by the Contractor to the Engineer-in-Charge, immediately after the Contract has come into force or upon the Engineer-in-Charge's request. Such copies shall also be available at the Contractor's business domicile(s) and at Site, for the use also of the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) In case of discrepancies between these Specifications and national or international standards and codes, these Specifications being part of Contract Documents shall govern, unless otherwise established by the Engineer-in-Charge in each particular case. 1.3.2. Indian Standards, Codes, Laws and Regulations (1) Throughout the duration of the Contract, the materials, equipment, services, design and workmanship shall conform to applicable Indian codes, standards, laws and regulations in force in India, if not otherwise specified. (2) It is the Contractor's duty to acquaint himself with all available Indian codes, standards, laws and regulations related to the Works in any way and he shall procure and keep at the Site a copy of each of such applicable documents. 1.3.3. International Standards and Codes (1) The following international standards/codes series may be adopted: a. International Standardisation Organisation (ISO) b. J apanese (J IS) c. US (ACI, ASTM, ANSI, USACE, USBR, AASHO) d. German (DIN, VDI) e. Swiss (SIA, SEV) f. British (BS) Provided that: a. The standards/codes proposed are at least as stringent as the equivalent national ones relevant to the Works, or if there is no applicable national standard/code for the specific item concerned. b. The Contractor states, prior to starting the work, the international standard/code he proposes to apply, giving full identification of each of them. These proposals are subject to the approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Where reference is made in the technical documents to standards/codes of the country of origin for a supply item, it shall be a recognised national standard/code of the country where the specific supply item is manufactured. To be acceptable under these Specifications, such standards/codes must comply in all respects with the quality requirements of above mentioned Indian standards/ codes In case the Indian codes are not available, other international standards as mentioned above must be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1.4. SYSTEM OF UNITS (1) The SI system of units has been used throughout these Specifications and this system of units shall be used consequently throughout the duration of Contract for all technical or contractual purposes. (2) Following abbreviations are used in these Specifications and other related Contract Documents: Unit Abbreviation Length Millimetre mm Centimetre cm Meter m Kilometre km Area : square millimetre Mm 2
square centimeter cm 2
square meter m 2
Volume : cubic meter M 3
3
Mass : Kilogram kg ton Metric ton t MT Density : ton per cubic meter t/m 3
Force : Newton N Kilo-Newton Kn Mega-Newton MN Moment : Newton meter N.m Stress : Newton per square millimeter N/mm 2
Kilo-Newton per square millimetre kN/mm 2
Pressure : Bar bar Pascal Pa Mega-Pascal Mpa Time : Second S Hour H Rate of Flow : litres per second or minute l/s, l/min cubic meters per second m 3 /s cubic meters per minute m 3 /min Velocity : meter per second kilometer per hour m/s Km/h Speed of rotation : revolutions per minute rpm Temperature : degree Celsius C luminous Intensity : Lux Lx Energy : Kilowatt hour kWh Power : Watt W Kilowatt kW Megawatt MW Slope: Vertical: horizontal v: h Gradient: Percentage (Vertical: horizontal) %
(3) The term "day" as used in these Specifications means calendar day. (4) Any other system of units utilised shall have only a descriptive value and shall in no case replace the above-mentioned SI system. 1.5. DEFINITION OF TIME AND KEY DATES The periods of time and key dates used throughout these Specifications have the meanings as assigned to them in the General Conditions of Contract and the Special Conditions of Contract. 2. SITE INSTALLATIONS, SERVICES AND ENVIRONMENTAL OBLIGATIONS 2.1. SCOPE OF WORK (1) The Contractor shall be responsible for providing plant, equipment, materials and labour for the provision of all necessary Temporary works, site installations and services required for the realisation of the Works under this Contract. (2) The Contractor shall design, furnish, set-up, maintain and operate at the Site all Temporary Works, site installations and Contractor's Equipment for his own use as specified in this Section, or required by the Contractor, including camps, workshops, warehouses, storage and assembly areas, all machinery, vehicles, scaffolding, equipment, water and power supply, etc. (3) Temporary Works and services provided and operated by the Contractor shall conform to the applicable Indian laws, regulations, standards, codes and sanitary requirements stipulated for such purpose. In addition, they shall comply fully with all Indian laws and 4
regulations relating to environmental protection, mitigating measures for reducing environmental impacts and remedial works on completion of the Works. (4) The design, construction, operation and maintenance of the Contractor's Temporary Works and services may be subject to inspection by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) All plants, camp facilities, installations and services provided by the Contractor shall at all times remain his property, except when otherwise specified hereinafter. Should, after the Completion of Contract, the Contractor wish to sell his plants, facilities and equipment in India, he shall pay all taxes and duties required by law as stipulated in the Conditions of Contract, and have to obtain relevant permission from the Government for such sale. (6) The temporary site roads which the Contractor shall construct, and maintain for the various working areas, camps, facilities and other temporary works are covered in the Section "Roadwork". 2.2. SUBMITTALS (1) Within 21 days from the date of issue of the Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge updated layout plans showing, at adequate scale, the locations and arrangement of all Temporary Works and facilities. These plans shall be consistent with the plan submitted by the Contractor with his Tender as well as with any amendments and additions subsequently agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor, and shall include: a. Camps for Contractor's employees, b. Offices, parking areas, warehouses, storage areas, and medical care services, c. Water supply, sewerage, sewage treatment and disposal, power supply and illumination, telephone service (radio and cable), d. Temporary roadwork, including public road diversions, e. Equipment pools and mechanical workshops, f. Spoil areas, borrow, quarry and stockpile areas, g. Concrete and materials processing plants, including cement storage, h. Materials testing laboratory, i. Explosives magazines, j. Underground ventilation system, k. Security and safety arrangements, (2) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge the following: a. Detailed drawings at scale 1:500 showing the camp layout, buildings, roads, recreation areas, all utilities, etc., and drawings at scale 1:50 showing typical building construction details, b. Drawings and specifications for the establishment of an infirmary and first aid stations, and details of the ambulances, c. Detailed design for industrial and potable water supply to the camps and working areas as well as sewerage systems, sewage treatment and disposal with and estimate of number of people to be supplied with water, d. Detailed layout drawings for electrical installations and distribution systems at the Site, showing voltages, outlets, and routing of power lines, e. Detailed design and drawings including manufacturer's drawings for concrete and materials processing plants in accordance with the requirements of the pertinent Sections of these Specifications, f. Detailed break-up of all equipment to be used for material testing and in the field laboratory in accordance with the requirements of the pertinent Sections of these Specifications, g. Details of the drilling and grouting equipment, h. Details of the underground ventilation system. i. Details of the dewatering system (1) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge an environmental monitoring and protection plan 5
which will describe all measures to be taken by the Contractor to comply with the requirements of 2.19 of this Section. This plan will cover all measures to be taken by the Contractor to prevent, minimise or make good all possible environmental effects of the construction work, in particular: a. Deterioration of the quality of water in rivers and streams, and of ground water. b. Accumulation of and pollution by solid and liquid waste material anywhere in the project area. c. Undesirable levels of noise, air pollution and dust both at the construction site as well as along the access road, in quarries and borrow areas. d. Occurrence amongst site workers and their families of water-borne and other communicable illnesses, and the deterioration of levels of hygiene in the camps and construction areas. This environmental plan will also describe the procedures to be adopted by the Contractor for reporting on the environmental protection programme and for informing and communicating with government institutions. The plan will also give details of arrangements made by the Contractor with local land-owners for the leasing of land for site installations, camps etc., and will include drawings detailing the areas in question. 2.3. SITE OFFICES, STORES, WAREHOUSES, MATERIALS YARDS (1) The Contractor shall provide and equip, for his own and his subcontractors' use, main and secondary offices, warehouses, materials storage areas, fuel storage areas and explosives magazines, all of which shall be maintained in good conditions until the Completion of Works. (2) Listed hereunder are the buildings, shops and warehouses expected to be constructed and equipped by the Contractor for use in the performance of the Work under this Contract, in addition to facilities explicitly specified elsewhere in these Specifications: a. Mechanical repair shop, b. Electrical repair shop, c. Metalwork and wood fabrication shop, d. Main warehouse and parts store, e. Bulk cement silo, f. Bagged cement store, g. Spare parts store, h. Gasoline and oil stations. i. Explosive Magazine. (3) The Contractor is required to have at the Site at least one month's minimum reserve of materials both for construction activity and other requirements. For the monsoon months, from may to September, when transport to and from site may be made difficult, his reserve requirements may need to be increased. 2.4. CONCRETE AND MATERIALS PROCESSING PLANTS The Contractor shall install and erect all necessary concrete and materials processing plants of sufficient capacity to meet the planned peak requirements during construction. The plants shall be subject to approval by the Engineer-in-Charge and shall be well designed and fabricated and kept in good running order to ensure compliance with the materials quality specifications. All control and measuring equipment shall be regularly serviced and calibrated. 2.5. MATERIALS TESTING LABORATORY (1) The Contractor shall build and equip an adequate field laboratory for the sampling and for testing of materials for concrete, steel reinforcement, earth, rock or any other materials as specified in the pertinent Sections of these Specifications. (2) The laboratory shall be located in a dust-free building properly equipped with electricity, water, etc., and shall have enough room for storing the samples tested as required. 6
(3) The equipment to be supplied and the methods of testing shall be in accordance with the relevant Indian Standards or with requirements of the US army corps of engineers (USACE), or USBR Concrete Manual and USBR Earth Manual. All apparatuses and equipment shall be brand new, of the latest design, manufactured by a reputed manufacturer, and properly calibrated with calibration certificate from Indian or International Authority. The proposed type and number of items of laboratory equipment shall be presented to the Engineer-in-Charge prior to purchase. (4) The Contractor shall operate and maintain the laboratory until the Completion of Works and make all facilities and services available to the Engineer-in-Charge as required. All sampling and testing to be undertaken shall be under the direct supervision of the Engineer-in-Charge. The laboratory shall be run by Contractor's personnel experienced in sampling and testing of materials, and quality control. (5) Specialised testing which may be required and which cannot be performed in the Contractor's laboratory due to lack of time or equipment shall be assigned to an independent organisation. The Contractor shall accept all results, instructions or restrictions stipulated by the Engineer-in-Charge based on such tests. (6) Upon the Completion of Works, all laboratory equipment shall remain the property of the Contractor. However, the Employer reserves the right to purchase some or all of the equipment. 2.6. COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS 2.6.1. SITE COMMUNICATION (1) The Contractor shall supply, install, operate and maintain a telephone switchboard, and wireless mode as alternative communication system, complete with standby power supply, to connect his offices with the Engineer's-in-Charge, campsite, laboratories, workshops, stores, aggregate plants, quarry/borrow areas, batching plants, ice plant, adit portals, tunnel portals, tunnel headings, dam site, infirmary and first aid stations and all other work areas within the Site. (2) The Contractor shall furnish a directory of the telephones installed at the Site and make it available to the Engineer-in-Charge. 2.7. COMMUNICATION SYSTEM IN UNDERGROUND WORKS (1) The Contractor shall install and maintain operational a communication system by telephone or preferably an underground radio system approved by the Engineer-in- Charge between each heading face and entrance to the tunnel or shaft. (2) An intermediate intercom station shall be located at least every 500 m along the tunnel. (3) This communication system shall have its source of energy independent of the main energy supply for underground. The availability of the communication with open air shall be ensured at all times throughout the whole duration of underground construction. 2.7.1. OUTSIDE COMMUNICATIONS (1) The Contractor may install, operate and maintain a radiotelephone system(s), UHF and/or microwave, at the Site to provide the access to the national and international telephone grid. (2) The Employer will endorse the necessary license applications of the Contractor. (3) Upon the Completion of Works, the Contractor shall dismantle and remove from the Site the installed outside communications. However, the Employer reserves the right to purchase some or all of the equipment. 7
2.8. SERVICE & INSPECTION VEHICLES The Contractor shall operate and maintain sufficient service vehicles for use by its own staff and employees in the management for the supervision and performance of the work. 2.9. CAMPS FOR CONTRACTOR'S EMPLOYEES (1) The Contractor shall design, construct, provide furnishings, maintain, and operate two separate construction camps; one for Contractor's Indian and expatriate staff of mid and upper level, employed at site and the other for Contractor's labour. (2) The construction camps shall provide for the housing, feeding and recreation of the Contractor's employees and those of his subcontractors as per Indian labour law and other relevant regulations. The camps shall be large enough to accommodate the anticipated peak work force. (3) The Contractor shall be responsible for the acquisition of, and the expenses for the required land. (4) The Contractor shall be responsible for the necessary topographical surveys, clearing, and work required for the landscaping and to provide satisfactory foundations for buildings, streets and auxiliary facilities. (5) Food handling, preparation and serving shall be arranged by the Contractor in properly equipped canteen buildings for all his and his subcontractors' employees. (6) The Contractor shall be responsible for keeping the camp and the buildings in good hygienic conditions. The standards and regulations presently in force in the project area with regard to personnel treatment, sanitary conditions, and fire and accident prevention shall be duly taken into account. (7) The prices charged by the Contractor for food, beverages, etc., available in the camp shall be calculated on a non-profit basis. 2.10. COMMERCIAL CONCESSIONS (1) Commercial concessions such as for laundry, catering, shops, etc., granted to a third party by the Contractor for the use of the employees and residents at the Site, shall be subject to approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. Any concession shall be revoked if the concessionaire violates the law or the provisions governing the granting of the concession. Concessions shall automatically terminate upon Completion of the Works or in the event of the termination of the Contract. (2) No concession shall be granted for activities that are contrary to statutory regulations or law of the land or are declared by the Engineer-in-Charge to be offensive to the community. (3) Concessionaires will be regarded as subcontractors of the Contractor. 2.11. MEDICAL CARE FACILITIES (1) The Contractor shall comply with laws and health standards presently in force in India. In the event of illness of an epidemic nature breaking out, the Contractor shall carry out and comply with all orders, arrangements or regulations which may be issued by the Government or local authorities. (2) The Contractor shall construct, equip, and maintain at the Site, the following medical care facilities: (3) One clinic and infirmary with ambulance and driver within his main camp, (4) One first aid station at each work site. (5) The construction of these facilities shall be such as to provide reasonable quiet, privacy, communications, adequate ventilation, heating, light, hot and cold water, toilet facilities, electrical outlets, and impervious floors, walls and roofs. 8
2.12. POWER SUPPLY AND ILLUMINATION (1) The Contractor shall provide, install and keep operational throughout the Time for Completion, own generating facilities of such capacity necessary to supply all participants at the Site and in the camps. The power generating sets shall be installed in separate concrete or steel structure buildings on concrete foundations. The power supply to the construction sites, camps etc. shall be designed for continuous operation, 24 hours a day, with sufficient capacity to satisfy peak and emergency demands. (2) The Contractor shall install, operate and maintain electrical distribution systems which shall include all other necessary transformers, circuit breakers, disconnect and safety switches, voltage regulators, transmission lines, poles, pole hardware, conductors, meters and other equipment necessary for power distribution throughout the Site and temporary facilities. (3) Local standby generating units to prevent the interruption of work during the failure of the primary power source and capable of maintaining minimum services such as illumination, water supply, dewatering, etc., safety and security shall also be provided. (4) The Contractor shall ensure adequate illumination for all his operations at the Site and at the camp, including illumination of the streets. The minimum intensities for illumination in general shall be as follows: Area or Operation Luminous Intensity a) Excavation and spoil areas, and outdoor access ways 35 Lux b) General construction areas, outdoor concrete placement, active storage areas, loading, platforms, refuelling, and field maintenance areas 55 Lux c) Indoor construction areas 110 Lux d) Tunnel and general underground work areas 55 Lux e) Tunnel and shaft headings during drilling, mucking and scaling 110 Lux f) General construction plant and shops, e.g. batching plants,mechanical and electrical, equipment rooms, carpentry shops,active storerooms, barracks or living quarters, lockers or dressing rooms, mess halls, and indoor toilets 110 Lux g) First aid stations, infirmaries, and offices 550 Lux h) General interiors warehouses, corridors, hallways and exit ways 55 Lux i) Welding 330 Lux 2.13. WATER SUPPLY (1) The Contractor shall design, install, operate and maintain two separate water supply systems at the Site: a. Industrial water: for general construction use, treated to the extent necessary to meet specified requirements. (e.g. for concrete), b. Potable water: for supply to all buildings and plants requiring high quality water meeting statutory requirements for drinking water. (2) Water shall be supplied by the Contractor from suitable natural sources available within the Project area. The water shall be free of contamination and unaffected by the Site construction work. In isolated areas with no natural sources, the Contractor shall provide sufficient number of water carts to cover the requirements on both the industrial as well as potable water. (3) The Contractor shall furnish, install, operate and maintain all pumps, piping, fittings, valves, storage tanks, purification plant and chlorination for the water supply and 9
distribution systems, adequate in quantity and pressure. Industrial water shall be used for construction purposes only if of adequate quality. There shall be no cross connections of any kind between the industrial and potable water supply systems. Only potable water shall be piped into buildings. (4) Throughout the duration of the construction, the Contractor shall take regular samples from all water supplies to examine it for suitability and treatments required, and make the bacteriological tests periodically from potable water systems. 2.14. SANITATION AND SEWERAGE (1) All offices, workshops, laboratory and other occupied work buildings shall be provided with toilets connected to properly constructed and regularly maintained septic tanks approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The campsites shall be provided with a complete, properly maintained and operated sewerage system, including septic tanks, sewage treatment and disposal facilities. Facilities for washing clothes shall also be provided and linked to the sewerage system. 2.15. WASTE AND GARBAGE DISPOSAL (1) The Contractor shall collect waste material and garbage from camp, offices and workshops on a daily basis and transport it to an area approved by the Engineer-in- Charge where it shall be incinerated and buried. (2) The Site shall be kept clean and free of refuse at all times. No waste shall be dumped in areas other than those approved by the Engineer-in-Charge for waste disposal. No waste of any kind shall be deposited in any watercourses. 2.16. FENCING AND SITE SECURITY (1) The Contractor's offices, workshops and storage compounds, campsites and all construction areas where exclusion of unauthorised personnel is necessary for safety and security, shall be adequately fenced, gated and guarded. (2) The Contractor shall employ an adequate force of properly trained security guards at the work site and at the construction camp on 24-hour duty including Sundays and holidays. Storage areas shall be fenced, lighted and regularly patrolled by security guards. Warehouse buildings and explosive magazines shall be kept locked and keys accounted for at all times. (3) All employees engaged in the execution and maintenance of the Works shall wear identification badges when at the work site. (4) The Contractor shall be responsible for the losses occurring in his installations and those of the Employer resulting from carelessness on the Contractor's part. 2.17. INSPECTION BY THE ENGINEER-IN-CHARGE The Employer and the Engineer-in-Charge have the right at any time to inspect any part of the Contractor's temporary facilities, without advance notification, and to require immediate rectification of any contravention of the specified requirements. 2.18. FINAL CLEAN UP (1) Upon the Completion of Works, or when any plant has completed its functions the Contractor shall dismantle and demobilise all temporary facilities erected by himself or his subcontractors, and remove all debris, objectionable material, and all other refuse which may have been deposited on Site during the construction period. Such materials may be deposited only in areas approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 10
(2) All excavated areas shall be filled, graded and dressed in a clean and orderly condition acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge. As far as possible, such areas should conform to the natural appearance of the landscape. (3) No demobilisation or removal of temporary facilities and equipment shall be made without prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 2.19. ENVIRONMENTAL OBLIGATIONS (1) The Contractor shall, during the whole period of the Works comply fully with all Indian laws and regulations relating to environmental protection, mitigating measures for reducing environmental impacts and remedial works on completion of the Works. This obligation shall extend to the construction sites themselves, all the Contractors site installations, and all quarries, borrow areas and spoil tips. (2) Notwithstanding any specific obligations as these may be specified in prevailing Indian laws and regulations, the Contractor shall at all times comply with the following particular requirements for the protection of the environment, the local population and the workers at the construction site: a. Collect, treat, remove from site and dispose of in accordance with the regulations and to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-charge all domestic and industrial waste and excess construction materials (both solid and liquid), fuel, chemicals and other matter. b. Make every effort to minimise the harmful effects of transport to and from the site, in particular vehicle emissions and noise and the control of dust on roads. c. Provide its work force with fuel for cooking and heating and ensure that workers on the site do not cut wood or other vegetation as firewood. d. Take measures and construct works, on the instructions of the Engineer-in-charge, to prevent soil erosion from slopes in the construction area. e. Not clear any areas of forest or woodland without the authority of the Engineer-in- charge and statutory authorities. (3) In order to reduce adverse effect on public health resulting from the influx into the project area on construction workers, the Contractor will be obliged to undertake during the whole construction period the following preventive measures: a. Ensure that all construction staff and workers, prior to being accepted to work on site, submit certificates of good health and, during the construction period, ensure that all employees are given a periodic physical examination (at least once a year and following any serious illness) by a qualified medical practitioner. b. Ensure that workers suffering from noticeable contagious illnesses are removed from the site for treatment and are not permitted to return to the site without an updated medical certificate. c. Carry out regular spraying of all parts of the site and site installations to control mosquito vector diseases, using approved insecticides. d. Implement a control programme to ensure the maintenance of satisfactory sanitary conditions on the site and in the living areas, and report to the Engineer-in-charge all cases of serious enteric and/or water-borne illness. (4) The Contractor will send representatives to constituted project environmental monitoring committees, as instructed with the Engineer-in-charge, and will at all times comply with the requests of said committees with regard to the need for environmental or health protection measures. He will also maintain close contact with local representatives and government institutions in addressing issues arising from the construction activities. Such issues needing particular attention are the following: a. Pollution caused by construction work. b. Disputes related to the leasing of land for construction activities and/or site installations etc. c. Disputes arising from traffic congestion and restrictions on the use of the main project access road and roads in the project area. 11
d. All matters relating to road safety and the reduction to a minimum of the risk of traffic accidents. (5) The Contractor will submit to the Engineer-in-charge monthly reports on environmental performance and control. These reports will give details of all environmental protection measures taken during the months, as well as: a. Any environmental problems encountered during the month. b. Details of health conditions, in particular any occurrence of contagious illness and any accidents. c. Any notices received from government or state institutions relating to environmental matters, and the action taken by the Contractor as a result. (6) In view of the limited space available for the site accommodation facilities and in order to avoid problems of assimilation with the present population of the project region, the Contractor will be obliged to keep the number of workers imported from other areas to the minimum required for him to complete the Works on time and in accordance with the specifications. The Contractor will co-operate with the local authorities at all times to prevent migration to the area, of unauthorised persons not involved directly in the construction work. To this end, he will at all times strictly control the movement of persons into and out of the construction areas and camps. 2.20. PAYMENT FOR SITE INSTALLATION AND SERVICES The initial mobilisation costs such as purchase and transport of Contractor's Equipment and materials to the Site, planning, designing, installing, operating, maintaining and removing of all Temporary Works, site installations, services and facilities specified in this Section, making submittals to the Engineer-in-Charge, recruiting and transferring staff, obtaining rights of way, statutory permits and clearances, clearing, grading and excavating in areas for temporary facilities, and any other costs involved in preparation for constructing Permanent Works will not be paid separately and the entire cost thereof shall be included in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works. No separate payment shall be made for complying with any environmental obligations required by Indian national and state laws and regulations, and/or as described in this Section, and all such costs incurred by the Contractor to this end shall be considered as being included in the Contractors Unit Prices. 3. SAFETY PRECAUTIONS 3.1. SAFETY PROGRAMME AND ITS IMPLEMENTATION (1) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit, in writing, his proposal for a comprehensive safety programme covering all aspects of the Works. (2) This safety programme shall detail policies, procedures, and plans, which the Contractor intends to implement to ensure the safety and health of his employees. It shall comply with the standards and regulations in force in India applicable to construction safety. (3) The Contractor shall designate a competent employee specially trained and experienced to act as Safety Officer, who will administer and be responsible for the implementation of the safety program. He shall carry out frequent and regular safety inspections of the working areas, materials, and equipment. The name and qualifications of the Safety Officer shall be submitted for approval to the Engineer-in- Charge prior to his appointment. (4) The Contractor shall be responsible for enforcement of the health and safety provisions for his subcontractors to be employed at the Site. (5) Prior to the start of any major construction activity or hazardous operation, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval, a specific plan for safety precautions covering such operation. 12
(6) All accidental occurrence with serious accident potential such as major equipment failures, contact with high-voltage lines, exposure to hazardous materials, slides, cave- ins, etc., shall be immediately reported to the Engineer-in-Charge. (7) All serious and fatal injuries and diseases caused by the progress of work shall be immediately investigated by the Contractor and a comprehensive report shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge. (8) In case of a fatal accident, only rescue and emergency teams and operations shall be permitted at the place of the occurrence until the Engineer-in-Charge gives permission to resume normal operations. 3.2. SAFETY STANDARDS In addition to the requirements specified herein, the Contractor shall comply fully with all applicable national and state governments safety regulations and standards in force in India, as well as with the: a. Safety manual b. Tunneling Code of Practice c. Code of Practice for Construction of Tunnels, IS: 5878 (Part II-Sec.2). d. Safety Code for Tunnelling Work IS: 4756. e. Safety standards of the U.S. Bureau of Mines, f. U.S. Army Corps of Engineers (USACE), g. U.S. Bureau of Reclamation Construction Safety Standards. 3.3. PERSONAL SAFETY EQUIPMENT 3.3.1. General (1) The Contractor shall provide his and his subcontractor's personnel as well as the Engineer's-in-Charge representatives and visitors with appropriate personal safety equipment. The use of such equipment shall be compulsory. (2) Every person entering the working area in open air or in underground shall wear a protective helmet. Every person entering into underground works shall have an electric lamp. (3) The safety-toe footwear with steel caps shall be worn by all employees engaged in work having an inherent danger to the feet. Light footwear such as sandals, canvas or tennis shoes shall not be permitted for construction work. (4) During the drilling works and in the areas where the employees are exposed to harmful noise levels, ear protectors shall be made available and required to wear. (5) Employees engaged in work having an inherent danger of eye or face injury shall be furnished and required to wear protection glasses, goggles or masks. Where irritant or toxic substances may come in contact with the skin or clothing, employees shall be wearing the protective clothing or shall be required to apply a protective ointment by a competent physician. (6) Employees working on steep slopes or otherwise subject to possible falls from levels not protected by fixed guardrails or safety nets, shall be secured by safety belts and lifelines. 3.3.2. Requirements for Underground Works (1) Emergency material shall be provided at each underground excavation heading. This equipment shall consist of the following, as a minimum: a. 3 stretchers b. 3 woollen blankets c. 2 appliances for artificial breathing d. 1 oxygen flask e. 3 explosion-proof lamps f. wound dressing and disinfecting material g. pain-killing injections 13
h. gas masks (2) At least two members of the Rescue Team as described hereinafter, properly instructed and trained in the rescue procedures, shall be in each crew working underground. 3.4. RESCUE TEAM (1) Prior to the commencement of construction, the Contractor shall organise and train a Rescue Team composed of his employees. This Rescue Team shall be capable to render help after accidents caused by fire, gas, explosion, avalanche, etc. (2) The Rescue Team shall be organised in such a way that sufficient number of members will be ready for action at any time until the Completion of Works. (3) The Rescue Team members shall be instructed and trained for their task by a qualified and experienced person. If required, the Contractor shall hire an outside specialist to perform such training. A refresher training for all members of the Rescue Team shall be conducted at least every six months. (4) Each Rescue Team member shall be skilled in giving the first aid, dealing with the appliances for artificial respiration, and fire fighting equipment and shall possess a good local knowledge. Adequate equipment for reaching even the remotest working area shall be at their disposal. 3.5. ILLUMINATION AND EARTHING 3.5.1. General All working sites in the open, transit areas, excavation sites, access to tunnels, etc., shall be adequately illuminated during night work by electrical lights as specified in the Section "Site Installations and Services". 3.5.2. Illumination of Underground Works (1) Each working face shall be brightly illuminated. (2) The vaults along the entire length of the tunnel adits and shaft shall be illuminated with electrical light throughout the duration of construction works. The lamps shall be located as follows: a. Every 25 m in unlined stretches, b. Every 50 m in lined stretches. Each lamp shall be 40W as a minimum. The lamps shall be installed in a particular area immediately after the rock supporting measures have been completed. (3) Electrical cables shall be well insulated, protected and firmly fixed to tunnel walls by means of adequate insulators. Lamps shall be well protected against damage. (4) Lighting by flame is expressly forbidden in the underground. 3.5.3. Earthing, Wet Work Areas, Control of Electric Discharges (1) All equipment and appliances, which are exposed to lightning, shall be earthed electrically, and the effectiveness of such earthing shall be periodically checked by the Contractor's specialised personnel. (2) No equipment electrically powered by more than 24 Volts shall be operated by personnel standing in water. (3) Only air, battery-powered or hydraulic tools shall be permitted in the wet areas. (4) Where electrical blasting will be used, equipment shall be installed to control possible electric discharges in the ground due to storms, electrical motors, etc. As soon as such discharges are noted, electrical blasting operations shall be suspended, or the detonator type changed. 14
3.5.4. MAINTENANCE OF TRAFFIC AND SAFETY ON PUBLIC ROADS (1) The Contractor shall be responsible for the safety along the roads related to the Site, and he shall take all necessary precautions for the protection of the work and the safety of the public on the roads affected by his activities. Where the work will be carried out at the site of, or close to an existing road, the Contractor shall maintain the vehicular and pedestrian traffic safe at all times. If his operations can cause traffic hazards, he shall repair or fence or take such other measures for ensuring safety which are satisfactory to the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Roads subject to interference by the work shall be kept open or suitable detours shall be provided and maintained by the Contractor, who shall provide, erect, and maintain all necessary barricades, suitable and sufficient flashlights, flagmen, danger signals, and signs. (3) Roads, which will be closed to traffic, shall be protected by effective barricades on which acceptable warning and detour signs shall be placed. All barricades shall be kept illuminated and all lights shall be kept on from sunset to sunrise. (4) The Contractor shall submit his weekly activities schedule and the locations of his work along the existing public roads to the authorities concerned, and obtain all necessary approvals prior to commencement of the respective work. (5) At the road crossings or in heavy traffic locations, the Contractor shall carry out the work during the working hours as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, and after the completion of the work he shall immediately make the necessary backfill and pavement at the crossings. (6) The Contractor shall provide temporary passes and bridges to give an access to the existing villages, houses, etc., to the satisfaction of the authorities concerned whenever he disturbs such existing way during the execution of the Works. 3.6. STORAGE AND TRANSPORT OF EXPLOSIVES (1) The Contractor shall at an appropriate time apply to the national and state governments, police and military or other responsible authorities for all permits needed to allow him to transport, store and use the explosives required for the Works. The Contractor must allow in his work programme for the time needed to obtain said permits. (2) The Contractor is responsible for proper care and handling of detonators and explosives and he shall strictly comply with the rules and regulations in force in India regarding transport, storage, handling and use of explosives. (3) Explosive magazines shall be reinforced concrete buildings with walls and slabs of a minimum 250 mm thickness. Doors shall be made of double sheets having a minimum thickness of 5 mm each and shall be fitted with safety type locks. (4) Explosive magazines shall be kept at a safe distance from working areas and living quarters. They shall be surrounded with barbed wire, protected by safety locks, ventilated, and fitted with lightning arrestors. An air space shall be provided between the ceiling and the roof to prevent temperatures from reaching dangerous levels. (5) Blasting caps and detonators shall not be stored in the same magazines as explosives, but shall be located in separate magazines at least 15 m away if barricaded and 30 m if not barricaded. (6) Explosives shall be stored only in their original containers and with the top side up as designated on the container. (7) Access to the magazines and permission to handle explosives shall be granted exclusively to trustworthy personnel, adequately instructed and experienced in the use and handling of explosives. (8) No explosives may be stored in the tunnels, galleries, caverns or shafts. (9) The Contractor shall provide all reasonable and adequate security measures necessary to prevent loss or theft of explosives. Storage of explosives and detonators outside of the magazines shall not be permitted. 15
(10) The Contractor shall maintain a record of storage and withdrawal of all explosives. This record shall be made available to the Engineer-in-Charge on request. The Engineer-in- Charge shall be promptly notified of any loss or theft of explosives. (11) Between the magazines and the place of use, the explosives and detonators shall be transported separately in lockable metallic containers loaded on a special wagons destined for the purpose of explosives transport only. These wagons shall be painted with striking colours for easy recognition. The inside of the containers shall be lined with wood in order to prevent a direct contact of the explosive or detonators with the metal. 3.7. BLASTING 3.7.1. General (1) All blasting shall be carried out in a workmanlike and safe manner by a competent, licensed and experienced blasting engineer or foreman. No blasting shall be done without his approval. (2) Blasting will be permitted only after adequate provisions have been made for the protection of persons, the Works, and public or private property. The Engineer-in- Charges approval of any of the Contractor's blasting operations shall not relieve the Contractor of his sole responsibility for the safety of persons and property. The Contractor shall be liable for all claims resulting from personal injury and damage to property and equipment that may result from its blasting operations. Any damage done to the Works or property by blasting shall be repaired by the Contractor. (3) Blasting in the open air shall be carried out only at certain hours of the day in accordance with a schedule mutually agreed upon by the Contractor and the Engineer- in-Charge. Barriers shall be erected and warning shall be given to the workers at the Site and to the public immediately before blasting, so that no person will enter the danger zone until blasting is finished. Any restriction imposed on the blasting schedule to ensure safety of structures, properties and lives shall not be accepted as a basis for a claim by the Contractor. (4) Upon completion of blasting, an "all clear" signal shall be given by the responsible blasting engineer after he has satisfied himself that all charges loaded have detonated and that no delay-explosions or misfiring are to be expected. (5) Such methods of blasting shall be employed that shock and vibration are minimised. (6) No blasts involving charges larger than 200 kg shall be carried without the written approval by the Engineer-in-Charge, who shall be notified at least one hour prior to the blast. (7) No blasting shall be permitted within 25 m of any concrete placed within the previous 7 days, except backfill concrete behind steel ribs. After 7 days, blasting may be performed only with the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Blasting will not be permitted within 10 m of structures or installations vulnerable to damage by blasting. (8) No charging and firing will be permitted during thunderstorms and other electrical disturbances. (9) Mats or rubber tires tied together with rope shall be used as protection from flying debris to cover the charges where blasting may expose persons or property to injury or damage. 3.7.2. Underwater Blasting (1) Only water resistant blasting caps and detonating cord shall be used in underwater blasting operations. (2) Loading tubes and casings of dissimilar metals shall not be permitted because of possible electrical transient current from galvanic action. (3) When more than one charge is placed underwater, a float device shall be attached to an element of each charge in such manner that it will be released by the firing. 16
(4) No drilling, digging or excavating shall be permitted until all misfires have detonated or the explosives are removed from the missed holes. 3.8. VENTILATION OF UNDERGROUND WORKS 3.8.1. General (1) The Contractor shall design, furnish, install and operate ventilating systems for underground construction sites, and provide a tunnel atmosphere monitoring system. Details of the proposed systems shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval within 28 days after the day of receipt of the Notification of Award. This updated design shall include all calculations of fresh air supply volume, type of ventilation scheme, duct diameters, materials and equipment and position of ventilators and dust arrestors. Description of the working cycle including number of persons employed, number and capacity of diesel-powered equipment working at one time at each tunnelling face shall also be included. The design shall be consistent with the proposal submitted by the Contractor with his Tender as well as with any subsequent amendments and additions agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor. (2) All parts of the Works shall be maintained in a state which will not be injurious to the health of the personnel. The air in underground shall contain no less than 20% oxygen and shall not contain a concentration of gases, vapours or dust greater than is safe for the health of workmen. (3) If required, the ventilating system shall be kept in operation also after break-through in tunnels, galleries and shafts in order to maintain the fresh air volume requirements stated hereafter. (4) Intermediate fans attached to the main duct line shall be provided as required to ensure satisfactory removal of contaminated air. All ventilation ducts shall be maintained in an airtight condition. (5) Ventilation ducts shall be firmly fixed to the vault in such position that a minimum clearance of 200 mm remains between the duct and the extremities of train or vehicular traffic employed in the underground. (6) The Contractor shall check the amount of fresh air at the heading face after each 200 m of progress, but at least once per month. The check of the air-tightness of joints and control of the air ducts for leaks shall be performed periodically. Any deficiency discovered or reported by the Engineer-in-Charge shall be immediately repaired by the Contractor. (7) Should the volume of fresh air at the heading face not reach the required amount and quality, the whole duct system shall be pressure-and-volume tested in portions not exceeding a few hundred meters. Measuring stations shall be located not closer than 10 times the duct diameter from any fan or other flow disturbance within the duct. 3.8.2. Ventilating System (1) The ventilating system shall be of such efficiency that the average air velocity in the largest excavated profile is not less than 0.3 m/s. In case the presence of methane gas is detected or suspected this value shall be increased to 0.5 m/s. (2) Furthermore, the main ventilating system shall ensure that both of the following minimum fresh air volume requirements are satisfied at all times: a. 3.0 m3/min for each person employed underground at one time, b. 6.0 m3/min for each metric horsepower (PS) of diesel-powered equipment at work underground at one time. This value may be reduced to 3.0 m3/min providing the equipment is using diesel oil low in sulphur content (max. 0.2% of sulphur by volume). These fresh air volumes shall be cumulative and the Contractor shall allow in his design calculations for the maximum number of persons and diesel-powered equipment working in the underground at any one time. Any estimated losses, e.g. due to the leaks in the ducts, shall be added to the figures stated above. 17
(3) The ventilating system in the underground excavation performed by drilling and blasting shall consist of two parts: a. Main ventilating system, b. Secondary ventilating system. (4) The main ventilating system shall be designed to allow the flow to be reversed and shall be operated as follows: a. Prior to the blasting, the system will be put in the exhaust mode of operation. Blasting fumes shall be extracted as close as possible to the excavation face. Exhaust air and blasting fumes shall be discharged in such a way that they can neither escape in any other working place nor be recirculated in the fresh air supply system. b. Prior to the commencement of mucking and removal of material the system will be put in the forced mode of operation which will continue till termination of mucking. (5) The secondary ventilating equipment of the forced type shall be installed to provide adequate ventilation of the area between the heading face and the air intake/outlet of the main system. This system shall be switched on prior to the blasting and shall be operating until the main system has been put into forced mode of operation. The air intake shall be located at a sufficient distance from the heading face to ensure that blasting fumes do not permeate into this area and cause a recycling of blasting fumes. The outlet of this duct shall be located so close to the heading face that the driving of the blasting fumes and dust away from the face into main system is ensured. The minimum capacity shall be at least 70% of the main system capacity. The end diameter of the duct shall be such that the air discharge velocity is not less than 20 m/s. (6) Re-entry to the heading face and resuming of the work may not occur earlier than 15 minutes following each blast. 3.9. CONTROL OF DUST, SILICA, AND NOXIOUS GASES IN UNDERGROUND WORKS 3.9.1. Dust and Silica (1) To reduce the amount of dust, only wet drilling will be allowed and during mucking, muck tips shall be kept constantly damp by sprinkling with water. The use of high- pressure water jets for this purpose will not be permitted. (2) The Contractor shall measure the concentration of fine dust and content of silicon dioxide (SiO2) in all dust-producing underground operations by an approved method. (3) Air samples shall be taken within 10 days of commencing underground excavation, and at 90-day intervals thereafter. Further, within 30 days following major changes in tunnel excavation operation, or whenever required by the Engineer-in-Charge. Samples shall be taken from actual working areas. The sampling and testing shall be performed by a qualified person or laboratory to be proposed by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. A copy of the test results shall be submitted to the Engineer-in- Charge within 2 weeks of the sampling date. (4) The concentration of fine dust (diameter less than 0.005 mm) may not in general exceed the value of 8.0 mg/m3 of air and in relation to the silicon dioxide content in the rock this value is lowered as follows: Content of SiO2 in fine Concentration of fine dust dust in percent by weight in milligrams per m of air 1 - 15% 8.0 mg/m 3
20% 6.0 mg/m 3
30% 3.0 mg/m 3
60% 2.0 mg/m 3
80% 1.5 mg/m 3
100% 1.3 mg/m 3
18
(5) Should the concentration of fine dust exceed the limits stated above, the Contractor shall undertake such necessary measures and install such additional equipment which will ensure that the dust concentrations are within the specified safe hygienic limits. 3.9.2. Noxious Gases (1) Use of internal combustion engines, other than approved mobile diesel-powered equipment will not be permitted in underground construction sites. (2) The Contractor shall provide and maintain equipment for measuring the content of noxious gases and oxygen at each heading face throughout the duration of excavation works. Tests for determining concentrations of carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide, nitrogen dioxide, methane, other flammable gases, and oxygen shall be made before and after each blasting and at the beginning of each shift by qualified personnel. A record of readings shall be maintained and be available to the Engineer-in-Charge on request. (3) Gas concentrations in underground sites may not exceed the following limits: 0.005% (fifty ppm) of carbon monoxide 0.5% (five thousand ppm) of carbon dioxide 0.0005% (five ppm) of nitrogen dioxide 0.001% (ten ppm) of hydrogen sulphide 1.0% (ten thousand ppm) of methane 0.01 milligrams per litre of nitrous oxide (4) Concentrations of other flammable gases shall not exceed 40% of the lower explosive limit at the heading face and 20% of the lower explosive limit in the general tunnel or shaft atmosphere. (5) If concentrations of noxious gases or other flammable gases exceed the permissible limits set forth above, all operations shall be interrupted immediately and personnel shall be removed to a safe area. All sources of ignition shall be extinguished or removed. All equipment, with the exception of ventilation equipment, shall be shut down. (6) The required measures will be mutually determined and agreed by the Engineer-in- Charge and the Contractor. In case of need, the Contractor shall engage the services of an independent consultant experienced in gaseous tunnelling. Re-entry and resuming of the work shall be prohibited until the Engineer-in-Charge has authorised re-entry in writing. 3.10. FIRE PRECAUTION (1) The Contractor shall organise a fire brigade equipped for the fighting of any fires, which could break out on the construction sites, in temporary structures, stores, residential quarters, etc. (2) An adequate number of fire extinguishers shall at all times be available at each construction site and in each building in camps and in offices and they shall be kept in satisfactory working order. (3) Fire fighting equipment shall be of the gas, dry powder or other suitable chemical or pumped water type. Their number, type and location will be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 3.11. DUST ABATEMENT During the performance of the work and any operations appurtenant thereto, the Contractor shall carry out proper and efficient measures, such as sprinkling with water or other means, whenever necessary to reduce the dust nuisance, and to prevent dust which has originated from his operations from damaging crops, cultivated fields, and dwellings, or causing a nuisance to persons. The Contractor will be held liable for any damage resulting from dust originating from his operations. 19
3.12. POLLUTION OF STREAMS AND RIVERS (1) The Contractor shall take all possible steps to prevent pollution of streams, rivers, and other water supplies, at or in the vicinity of the Site and shall comply with applicable laws, orders and regulations in force in India concerning the control and abatement of water pollution. (2) Under no circumstances shall the sewage from the camps, or other contaminated water, be released directly into river or other natural streams or any open areas without prior treatment. 3.13. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT (1) No extra measurement for payment or payment whatsoever will be made for the safety precautions required to be provided by the Contractor and the entire cost thereof shall be included in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works. (2) Any repair work or any indemnities required due to Contractor's non-compliance with the safety requirements shall be at the Contractor's expense. Nothing contained in these Specifications shall prevent Contractor from providing, at its own cost, such amount of rock reinforcement, steel ribs or other supports for ensuring safety of excavation performed under the Contract, as it may consider necessary, in excess of that specified by Engineer-in-Charge. 4. SURVEYING AND SETTING-OUT WORK 4.1. EXISTING SURVEY CONTROL POINTS (1) Basic survey network consisting of fixed triangulation polygon points and benchmarks exists in the project area. In addition, these data have been supplemented by surveys carried out by the Survey of India. These data will be at the Contractor's disposal to serve as a base for the setting-out and checking work. (2) Prior to commencing any construction work, the Contractor shall undertake survey for the purpose of checking these reference data and in order to satisfy himself as to their accuracy. Should he have any objections to these data and the relevant drawings, he shall inform the Engineer-in-Charge in writing within two (2) weeks of receiving them from the Engineer-in-Charge. 4.2. OBLIGATIONS OF THE CONTRACTOR 4.2.1. General (1) The Contractor shall perform all calculations, surveys and setting-out necessary to establish the accurate location of the structures as shown on the Construction Drawings and shall carry out all necessary surveys to verify the topographical data used by the Engineer-in-Charge for the project design and measuring purposes. (2) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit his proposed survey plan to the Engineer-in-Charge. The proposed plan shall indicate the order of accuracy for all surveys. (3) In advance of any setting-out work associated with all principal project features, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval a description of the method and procedures he intends to use in establishing bench marks and base lines. (4) If the Contractor chooses to use triangulation points or bench marks other than those furnished by the Engineer-in-Charge, he shall do so at his own expense and risk. (5) The Contractor shall carry out topographical surveys of the original ground surface in each sector of the Works where surface excavation will be necessary, and produce sufficient and adequate cross-sections which will permit later to evaluate the volume of excavation for the measurement purposes and payment of excavation. 20
(6) The Contractor shall entrust the surveying works only to persons who by their training and experience have sufficient qualifications and knowledge to ensure proper fulfilment of the survey tasks assigned to them. For the performance of the survey, the Contractor shall use a sufficient number of reliable and accurate instruments. 4.2.2. Bench Marks and Triangulation Stations (1) Existing survey control point bench marks and base lines shall be verified with respect to permanent control points at Dam site and corresponding bench marks and base lines established afresh as necessary to construct each portion of the Works. (2) Permanent survey control points shall be established prior to starting the work and such permanent points shall be preserved during construction. (3) If not already in existence, a minimum of 2 permanent bench marks shall be established for all adit portals and referenced to data established by survey control points. Benchmarks shall also be provided at intermediate locations between adit portals for checking and carrying purposes. The location of such points with horizontal and vertical data shall be recorded on the construction record drawings by the Contractor. (4) From the primary survey control points the construction surveys shall be performed as required to locate, layout and construct each portion of the Works. (5) Complete and adequate logs of all control and survey work shall be maintained as it progresses. Such logs shall be available for the Engineer-in-Charge's inspection at all times. (6) The Contractor shall protect, preserve and keep accessible the bench marks and triangulation stations of the basic survey and those provided by himself. Any damage or removal of benchmarks and stations, including such of other parties shall be prevented. Any accidental damage shall immediately be brought to the attention of the Engineer-in-Charge. It is expressly stated that the Contractor will be made responsible for the damage and its consequences. (7) Benchmarks shall be of stainless steel or cast iron. In softer soil, the steel bolt shall be embedded in a block of concrete of suitable size, and absolutely stable. Inscriptions shall be durable and clearly legible. Underground benchmarks shall be installed at suitable locations and adequately protected. (8) Subordinate points may be marked by steel pipes or pegs, subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Every newly fixed point shall be checked, as far as possible through other elements than those, which served to establish the point. 4.2.3. Accuracy of Surveying (1) Horizontal distances shall normally be measured with optic or electronic distance measuring instruments. Chaining with metallic tape shall be restricted to measuring of short distances and will be rejected for use in survey of traverse nets. (2) Elevations shall be determined by differential horizontal levelling. (3) Angles shall be measured by Theodolite. (4) Traverse nets shall be executed with the precision and as per Survey of India practice and as per IS codes. (5) Levelling shall be checked by closing the loop to the initial benchmark. 4.2.4. Auxiliary Works (1) The Contractor shall perform auxiliary works with regard to surveying which include, but not be limited to, the following: a. Perform all necessary calculations with clear presentation of calculations and results in order to facilitate verification, b. Expose covered bench marks, c. Provide bench marks in lieu of and/or in addition to those in existence, 21
d. Remove machinery and obstructions from the required sight-lines, e. Provide adequate ventilation in tunnels to ensure the necessary clear view, f. Provide adequate lighting or shut off sources of interfering light to ensure the necessary clear view, g. Provide adequate labour, and materials as deemed necessary and suitable by the Engineer-in-Charge for the control and auxiliary surveys, h. Remove all obstructive accumulation of water, i. Carry out additional topographical surveys in cases where the existing topographical data is, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, insufficient for accurate measurement of the Works, j. Carry out all necessary topographical surveys for the incorporation of measuring equipment and instrumentation located in the Permanent Works, k. Carry out all necessary topographical surveys for the observation of the behaviour of structures during construction. (2) All the above shall be done in close co-ordination with the Engineer-in-Charge. 4.2.5. Damage to Crops and Vegetation (1) No trees or crops of economic value existing at the Site shall be damaged or removed by the Contractor during survey and cross-sectioning works prior to their enumeration and evaluation. (2) Throughout the surveying and setting-out the Contractor shall work closely with the authorised local appraisers of crops and vegetation in question and shall provide them with facilities necessary for the expeditious performance of their duties. (3) As soon as a section of work has been defined and valued, the Contractor shall delineate the boundaries of the areas to be cleared by approved markings. 4.3. CHECKING OF CONTRACTOR'S WORK BY THE ENGINEER-IN-CHARGE 4.3.1. Regular Checking (1) All elements of the Contractor's survey work associated with the setting-out of principal project features will be regularly checked by the Engineer-in-Charge during the course of the work, and the Contractor shall provide assistance at any time as required in the performance of such control work. (2) The Contractor may be required to provide the Engineer-in-Charge with any information, readings or computations for checking. (3) The regular checks will usually be made during work breaks, but in case of urgency, the Contractor shall restrict or stop the affected work. (4) Any checks by the Engineer-in-Charge shall not relieve the Contractor of his full responsibility for the accuracy of structures and parts of them with regard to their position and dimensions. 4.3.2. Confirmation Survey of the Tunnel Alignment (1) In addition to the regular check surveys described above, the Engineer-in-Charge, or an independent survey organisation nominated by the Engineer-in-Charge, will perform confirmation survey of the Diversion tunnel alignment in the course of excavation progress. Starting from the duly surveyed fix points at the portals, a traverse net (combination of traverse and gyroscopic measurements) and a levelling will be carried out in each case. (2) The first confirmation survey is likely to be performed after the first 100 m of tunnel have been excavated. The following controls will be carried out after 200 m of excavation. Each confirmation survey will require approximate 2 days. (3) The Contractor will be notified in writing in advance about the date of such confirmation survey and of the appointment of an independent surveyor who will perform the survey. The Contractor shall co-operate with such surveyor and provide any assistance as required. 22
(4) This was left to delete in tender document inadvertently. The same is to be taken up at the time of Agreement signing. (4) Such work will have to be temporarily halted which will, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, cause excessive vibration or noise such as drilling, mucking, hauling persons, materials or rock spoil in or out of the tunnel, installing permanent or temporary support or any similar work. (5) The Engineer-in-Charge will normally give the Contractor written notice of such stoppage at least 48 hours in advance and will state the approximate time at which work must cease and the approximate duration of such stoppage. The Engineer-in- Charge will also indicate what work, if any, may continue. The Contractor must promptly acknowledge receipt of any such written notice and confirm this acknowledgement in writing. (6) Irrespective of the times given by the Engineer-in-Charge, he shall not be bound to adhere strictly to these times but will attempt to do so in so far as it is feasible. While the Engineer-in-Charge will endeavour to co-operate with the Contractor in planning such temporary stoppages, the Engineer's-in-Charge decision in all cases will be final. 4.4. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 4.4.1. Survey Work Performed by the Contractor No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for Contractor's survey and setting-out work including the assistance in check/confirmation surveys, and the entire cost thereof shall be included in the Unit Prices for relevant items of the Works. 4.4.2. Temporary Suspension of Works in Underground No extension of time for the Completion of Works will be granted to the Contractor due to temporary suspension of work required for the performance of the confirmation surveys of the tunnel alignment by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall take into account the number and time of these surveys indicated above in his construction time schedules and include all expenses, delays, disruptions, loss of production and inconvenience resulting from such temporary stoppage in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works. 5. QUALITY ASSURANCE 5.1. QUALITY ASSURANCE IN EXECUTION OF WORKS (1) The Contractor shall establish staff, equip and operate a comprehensive quality assurance set-up at the site during the full period of the Works. The principal responsibility and duty of this set-up shall be to ensure that all work carried out and materials produced or supplied by the Contractor comply fully with the Specifications. (2) With his tender, the Bidder shall submit his detailed proposal (in terms of experienced supervisory staff, trained workmen, procedures of work, equipments, obtaining support from outside agencies) for achieving quality in respect of the minimum following: a. Underground excavation particularly quality control in blasting and minimisation of overbreaks and damage to surrounding rock. b. Maintaining clean working environment inside underground work with particular reference to lighting, ventilation and dewatering. c. Rock support installations particularly the grouting of rock bolts / rock anchors / tendons in surface and underground works. d. Workmanship in shotcrete placement. e. Workmanship in concrete placement in surface and underground works. f. Grouting activities particularly the mix designs and selection of mixes for particular application. g. Final clean up. 23
The Bidders proposal shall be specific enough to assure that all works are executed in a professional manner and Bidder has included in his bid the provision of employment of the best international practices of construction in the implementation of the work. (3) At the time of award of work, the Bidders proposal at the time of tender proposal at the time of tender shall be confirmed again and shall be improved, if so required. (4) Immediately after the award of work within 90 days of issue of the Order to Commence, during mobilization phase, the Contractor will submit to the Engineer-in-Charge for review and approval a revised detailed and updated quality control manual and programme which will take into account all comments made previously by the Engineer-in-Charge and shall take systematic steps to implement all the proposals given by him for achieving the desired quality in construction. (5) During course of execution, the quality of the work in progress shall be reviewed atleast once in 3 months in the Quality Assurance meeting specifically called by the Engineer-in-Charge and participated by Contractors Project organisation. In case Engineer-in-Charge is not satisfied with the resources employed vis--vis the commitments made in the proposal, the contractor shall take additional steps to supplement his efforts. (6) The Engineer-in-charge may establish and operate his own site laboratories for materials testing, and the contractor will be required to provide at no cost to the Employer samples for testing in these laboratories. (7) Supervision and testing which may be carried out by the Engineer-in-Charge in no way relieves the Contractor of his full responsibility for the quality of the Works and for compliance with the requirements of these specifications. 5.2. CONTROL OF THE PROGRESS OF WORK (1) Close progress control, and the preparation of corresponding progress reports, shall be an important part of the Contractors quality control responsibilities. The contractor must at all times provide the Engineer-in-charge with up to date information on the progress of work and must without delay bring to the attention of the Engineer-in- charge all delays or occurrences which could lead to delay or additional costs. (2) The Contractor shall submit detailed monthly progress reports to the Engineer-in- charge, in which the contractual programme for the works is updated and information is given on the quantitative completion of civil works (in the form of tables indicating the quantities of completed work). (3) The monthly progress reports shall give full details of any delays to work in progress or planned, delays in transport to/from the site, together with detailed proposals for overcoming or preventing delays, and for regaining any lost time. (4) The Contractor shall at any time, at the request of the Engineer-in-charge, submit detailed reports on particular matters relating to the execution and progress of the works, if such reports are required in order to assess the quality or progress of specific activities or works. 5.3. CONTRACTORS QUALITY CONTROL STAFF (1) The Contractor shall assign one experienced engineer to site as full-time quality control manager, responsible with complying with all requirement of Technical Specifications. (2) The experience and qualifications of this engineer shall be given in the contractors tender/proposal and shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-charge. (3) The positions, qualifications and duties, of the contractors quality control staff shall be indicated in the QC organisation plan, and shall likewise be subject to approval by the Engineer-in-charge. As a minimum, the contractor shall appoint one qualified and experienced tunnelling engineer and geologist to be responsible for quality control of each of following the underground works as under: a. Dam Complex including Diversion cum Spillway Tunnel b. Auxiliary Spillway Tunnels Excavation 24
c. Intake Structure/ Tunnel & Desilting Chambers d. Head Race Tunnel Excavation e. Power House Cavern Excavation f. Surge shaft Excavation g. Pressure Shaft Excavation 5.4. CONTRACTORS LABORATORIES (1) The Contractor shall establish, equip and operate on site laboratories for the testing of the following principal construction materials: h. Concrete, including also the testing of sand, aggregates, cement, water and admixtures. i. Any site testing and/or calibration of monitoring instrument. (2) The numbers of samples to be tested, and the timing of testing, shall be as may be given elsewhere in these specifications, or as may be instructed by the Engineer-in- charge. (3) The staff of the Contractors laboratory shall have proven experience in similar previous work and their qualifications shall be subject to approval by the Engineer-in- charge. (4) Complete records shall be kept of all laboratory tests carried out and shall be available at any time to the Engineer-in-charge on request. (5) The Engineer-in-charge shall be permitted at any time and without notice to observe tests being carried out in any of the Contractors laboratories, to inspect equipment or to study results. 5.5. MATERIAL DELIVERED TO SITE (1) The Contractors quality control staff shall keep full records of all materials delivered to site for use in the Works, and of all tests made on such materials either prior to or following delivery to site. (2) These records shall be available at all times to the Engineer-in-charge, together with any factory testing certification. 5.6. MEASUREMENT FOR PAYMENT AND PAYMENT No measurement for payment will be made for any of the Contractors QC activities required in this Section. All costs of these activities will be included in the Unit Prices for work listed in the Schedule. 6. COMMISSIONING 6.1. GENERAL (1) The Civil Contractor for will be required to co-ordinate his work with and make due allowance for the installation, testing and commissioning of items of hydro-mechanical equipment and E& M works to be supplied under HM contract & E&M contract and will be required to co-operate with and assist the sub contractor/joint venture partner in the work. (2) The periods for the installation and testing of these items shall be the Contractual Programme or otherwise intimated to him separately. (3) During the installation, testing and commissioning of equipment the Civil Contractor will allow full access to the staff of the sub contractor/joint venture partner of HM contractor/E&M contractor, and for their equipment and materials, and must make full allowance in his work activities and programme for any delays, restrictions or changes of working methods which may result from this requirement. 25
(4) The Civil Contractor will be expected to agree with the sub contractor/joint venture partner providing him with materials, consumables and electric power as these may be needed during the installation and testing of hydro-mechanical equipment, at costs to be agreed directly between them and at no cost to Employer. (5) The Civil Contractor will be expected to make available to the sub contractor/joint venture partner as available storage space for equipment items and plant during the installation of hydro-mechanical equipment, again at costs to be agreed directly between them and at no cost to Employer. 6.2. HYDRO-MECHANICAL EQUIPMENT TO BE INSTALLED (1) The principal items of hydro-mechanical equipment constructed in the HM contract, which are to be installed in civil structures, shall include but not limited to the following: a. Spillway radial gates, including hoisting equipment. b. Spillway bulkhead/ stoplog gate. c. Desilting system gate. d. Surge shaft gate. e. Tail Race Tunnel gate. f. High-pressures penstocks and bifurcations. g. Any other installation envisaged during construction. In addition to above the contractor shall also have to coordinate his works with and make due allowances for the works being executed in the vicinity by other contractor. 6.3. E& M WORKS EQUIPMENT TO BE INSTALLED (1) The principal items of electro-mechanical which are installed in civil structures to be constructed under the E&M contract, with the co-operation and assistance of the Contractor are listed below: a. Power cavern cranes and other lifting equipment. b. Spherical valves and turbines, including draft tubes and other embedded parts. c. Generators and main unit (single-phase) transformers. d. Gas-insulated switchgear. e. Auxiliary electrical equipment. f. Auxiliary mechanical equipment. g. Control equipment 6.4. TESTING OF EQUIPMENT (1) The Civil Contractor will work together as required with the HM Contractor and E&M Contractor and any sub-contractors during the testing of all items of newly-installed hydro-mechanical equipment. (2) Should this testing reveal any defects or inadequacies of the Works carried out by the Civil Contractor, the latter will immediately act to remedy or make good these defects or inadequacies, to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-charge, in such a way that the testing by the HM Contractor and the E&M Contractor is not delayed. (3) The Civil Contractor shall contribute any data or other information needed by the HM Contractor and the E&M Contractor contractors or the Engineer-in-charge for inclusion in testing report or commissioning certificates. 6.5. COMMISSIONING OF THE PROJECT AS A WHOLE The Civil Contractor together with the HM Contractor and E&M Contractor shall fully participate (and co-operate with the Engineer-in-Charge) at the time of final commissioning of the Project which shall include reservoir filling, filling of the water conductor system and commissioning of individual units in the Power House. 26
6.6. MEASUREMENT FOR PAYMENT AND PAYMENT (1) There will be no measurement for payment for any of the activities related to equipment commissioning as well as commissioning of the Project as a whole. All costs related thereto will be covered by the Unit Prices given in the Schedule.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
i
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE- III HYDROELECTRIC PROJECT CIVIL WORKS FOR CONSTRUCTION OF DIVERSION CUM SPILLWAY TUNNEL, POWER INTAKE AND INLET TUNNEL, FLUSHING SPILLWAY TUNNELS, CONCRETE FACE ROCKFILL DAM, DESILTING COMPLEX AND ASSOCIATED WORKS
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Contents 1 DEWATERING DURING CONSTRUCTION ................................................................................... 1 1.1 SCOPE OF WORK ............................................................................................................. 1 1.2 SUBMITTALS ..................................................................................................................... 1 1.3 EXECUTION ....................................................................................................................... 2 1.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ..................................................................................... 6 2 SURFACE EXCAVATION ............................................................................................................... 8 2.1 SCOPE OF WORK ............................................................................................................. 8 2.2 SUBMITTALS ..................................................................................................................... 8 2.3 LINES AND GRADES ......................................................................................................... 9 2.4 SLOPES, SLIDES, OVERBREAK AND UNSUITABLE FOUNDATIONS ........................ 10 2.5 EXECUTION ..................................................................................................................... 10 2.6 EXCAVATED MATERIALS ............................................................................................... 15 2.7 DISPOSAL OF EXCAVATED MATERIALS ..................................................................... 16 2.8 PREPARATION AND PROTECTION OF EXCAVATION SURFACES ........................... 16 2.9 MONITORING AND PROTECTION FROM BLASTING .................................................. 17 2.10 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................... 18 3 UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION .................................................................................................. 20 3.1 SCOPE OF WORK ........................................................................................................... 20 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
ii
3.2 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................... 20 3.3 DEFINITIONS ................................................................................................................... 21 3.4 EXCAVATION LINES ....................................................................................................... 22 3.5 OVERBREAK .................................................................................................................... 23 3.6 SUPPORTS FOR UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION ....................................................... 23 3.7 CLASSIFICATION OF UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION FOR INSTALLATION OF SUPPORTS ................................................................................................................ 24 3.8 EXECUTION ..................................................................................................................... 25 3.9 EXCAVATED MATERIALS ............................................................................................... 29 3.10 EVACUATION OF WATER .............................................................................................. 30 3.11 ILLUMINATION ................................................................................................................. 30 3.12 VENTILATION AND CONTROL OF DUST, SILICA AND NOXIOUS GASES ................. 30 3.13 COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ........................................................................................... 30 3.14 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................... 30 4 ROCK SUPPORTS ........................................................................................................................ 33 4.1 SCOPE OF WORK ........................................................................................................... 33 4.2 GENERAL ......................................................................................................................... 33 4.3 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................... 34 4.4 ROCK BOLT (EXPANSION SHELL), ROCK ANCHOR, ROCK BOLT (GROUTED ANCHORAGE), WATER EXPANDABLE FRICTION ANCHORS, GROUTED ANCHOR BAR/DOWEL ................................................................................ 35 4.5 POST-TENSIONED ROCK BOLTS (TENDONS) ............................................................ 42 4.6 MESH REINFORCEMENT ............................................................................................... 48 4.7 STEEL SUPPORTS .......................................................................................................... 49 4.8 ADDITIONAL SUPPORT MEASURES IN POOR REACHES OF UNDERGROUND EXCAVATIONS .................................................................................. 50 4.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................... 51 5 SHOTCRETE ................................................................................................................................. 56 5.1 SCOPE OF WORK ........................................................................................................... 56 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
iii
5.2 DEFINITIONS ................................................................................................................... 56 5.3 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................... 57 5.4 MATERIALS ...................................................................................................................... 57 5.5 MIX DESIGN AND QUALITY REQUIREMENTS ............................................................. 59 5.6 TESTING .......................................................................................................................... 60 5.7 EQUIPMENT ..................................................................................................................... 62 5.8 PROFICIENCY OF WORKMEN ....................................................................................... 63 5.9 SURFACE PREPARATION .............................................................................................. 63 5.10 MIXING AND PLACING .................................................................................................... 64 5.11 REBOUND ........................................................................................................................ 65 5.12 PROTECTION, CURING, AND FINISHING ..................................................................... 65 5.13 REPAIR ............................................................................................................................. 65 5.14 TOLERANCES.................................................................................................................. 66 5.15 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................... 66 6 EMBANKMENT CONSTRUCTION ............................................................................................... 68 6.1 SCOPE OF WORK ........................................................................................................... 68 6.2 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................... 69 6.3 PLANT AND EQUIPMENT ............................................................................................... 69 6.4 MATERIALS PROCESSING PLANT ................................................................................ 70 6.5 CONTRACTOR'S LABORATORY AND TESTING .......................................................... 71 6.6 CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS ....................................................................................... 72 6.7 CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE AND TOLERANCES ..................................................... 74 6.8 FOUNDATION PREPARATION ....................................................................................... 76 6.9 CONCRETE FACED ROCKFILL DAM ............................................................................. 77 6.10 BACKFILL ......................................................................................................................... 79 6.11 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................... 81 MATERIALS AND CHARACTERISTICS OF DAM FILL ............................................................... 83 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
iv
7 DRILLING AND GROUTING ......................................................................................................... 89 7.1 SCOPE OF WORK ........................................................................................................... 89 7.2 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................... 90 7.3 DEFINITIONS ................................................................................................................... 92 7.4 EQUIPMENT ..................................................................................................................... 94 7.5 SITE LABORATORY ........................................................................................................ 97 7.6 GROUTING MATERIALS ................................................................................................. 97 7.7 GROUT MIXES ................................................................................................................. 98 7.8 EXECUTION ................................................................................................................... 101 7.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 108 8 CUT-OFF WALL .......................................................................................................................... 112 8.1 GENERAL ....................................................................................................................... 112 8.2 STANDARDS .................................................................................................................. 112 8.3 SUBMITTAL .................................................................................................................... 112 8.4 MATERIALS .................................................................................................................... 113 8.5 MIX DESIGN ................................................................................................................... 113 8.6 QUALITY CONTROL ...................................................................................................... 114 8.7 EXECUTION ................................................................................................................... 114 8.8 CONTROL MEASURES FOR THE CUT-OFF WALL .................................................... 117 8.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 118 9 CONCRETE ................................................................................................................................. 120 9.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 120 9.2 STANDARDS .................................................................................................................. 120 9.3 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................. 121 9.4 CONSTITUENTS OF CONCRETE ................................................................................ 123 9.5 CONCRETE MIX DESIGN ............................................................................................. 128 9.6 HIGH PERFORMANCE CONCRETE ............................................................................ 129 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
v
9.7 QUALITY CONTROL ...................................................................................................... 131 9.8 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA ............................................................................................. 134 9.9 BATCHING AND MIXING ............................................................................................... 134 9.10 CONVEYING .................................................................................................................. 137 9.11 PLACING ........................................................................................................................ 138 9.12 FINISHING OF CONCRETE .......................................................................................... 142 9.13 CONSTRUCTION JOINTS IN CONCRETE STRUCTURES ......................................... 145 9.14 CURING AND PROTECTION OF CONCRETE ............................................................. 146 9.15 REPAIR OF CONCRETE ............................................................................................... 147 9.16 PARTICULAR REQUIREMENTS FOR INDIVIDUAL CONCRETE STRUCTURES ............................................................................................................... 148 9.17 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 154 10 FORMWORK ............................................................................................................................... 159 10.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 159 10.2 DEFINITIONS ................................................................................................................. 159 10.3 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................. 159 10.4 MATERIALS .................................................................................................................... 159 10.5 FORM TIES .................................................................................................................... 160 10.6 DESIGN .......................................................................................................................... 160 10.7 ERECTION OF FORMWORK ........................................................................................ 161 10.8 TUNNEL FORMWORK ................................................................................................... 162 10.9 DAM FACE-SLAB FORMWORK .................................................................................... 162 10.10 FINISHED TOLERANCES .............................................................................................. 163 10.11 REMOVAL OF FORMWORK ......................................................................................... 163 10.12 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 163 11 REINFORCING STEEL ............................................................................................................... 164 11.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 164 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
vi
11.2 STANDARDS .................................................................................................................. 164 11.3 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................. 164 11.4 MATERIALS .................................................................................................................... 164 11.5 TESTING ........................................................................................................................ 165 11.6 STORAGE ...................................................................................................................... 165 11.7 FABRICATION ................................................................................................................ 165 11.8 PLACING ........................................................................................................................ 166 11.9 TOLERANCE ON PLACING OF REINFORCEMENT .................................................... 166 11.10 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 166 12 WATERSTOPS AND JOINTS ..................................................................................................... 168 12.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 168 12.2 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................. 168 12.3 JOINT TYPES ................................................................................................................. 168 12.4 MATERIALS .................................................................................................................... 170 12.5 EXECUTION ................................................................................................................... 173 12.6 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 174 13 MONITORING INSTRUMENTS .................................................................................................. 176 13.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 176 13.2 SUBMITTALS ................................................................................................................. 177 13.3 SKILLED PERSONNEL .................................................................................................. 178 13.4 INSTALLATION .............................................................................................................. 178 13.5 CARE OF INSTRUMENTATION .................................................................................... 179 13.6 READING INSTRUMENTS ............................................................................................ 179 13.7 SURFACE SETTLEMENT POINTS ............................................................................... 179 13.8 HYDROSTATIC SETTLEMENT GAUGES ..................................................................... 179 13.9 JOINTMETERS, TEMPERATURE GAUGES, PORE PRESSURE GAUGES, CABLES, SWITCHBOXES AND PORTABLE READOUT UNITS ................................. 180 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
vii
13.10 PERIMETRIC JOINTMETERS (3-DIRECTIONAL) ........................................................ 181 13.11 BOREHOLE STANDPIPE PIEZOMETERS ................................................................... 183 13.12 SETTLEMENT TUBES CUM INCLINOMETER ............................................................. 183 13.13 INCLINED INCLINOMETERS ........................................................................................ 184 13.14 UPLIFT MEASURING DEVICES .................................................................................... 184 13.15 TERMINAL STRUCTURES FOR HYDRAULIC SETTLEMENT GAUGES .................... 184 13.16 COMPUTER HARD- AND SOFTWARE ......................................................................... 185 13.17 AUTOMATIC WEATHER STATION ............................................................................... 185 13.18 WATER LEVEL MEASURING GAUGE .......................................................................... 186 13.19 SEEPAGE MEASURING WEIR ..................................................................................... 186 13.20 MONITORING OF SPILLWAY EXCAVATION FACES AND UNDERGROUND OPENINGS ..................................................................................................................... 186 13.21 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 189 14 SLOPE PROTECTION ................................................................................................................ 193 14.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 193 14.2 RIP RAP .......................................................................................................................... 193 14.3 GABIONS (WIRE CRATES) ........................................................................................... 194 14.4 RANDOM RUBBLE MASONRY ..................................................................................... 195 14.5 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 195 15 ROAD WORKS ............................................................................................................................ 197 15.1 SCOPE OF WORK ......................................................................................................... 197 15.2 PRINCIPAL ACCESS ROAD TO THE SITE .................................................................. 197 15.3 ACCESS ROADS WITHIN THE PROJECT AREA ........................................................ 197 15.4 TEMPORARY SITE ROADS .......................................................................................... 198 15.5 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT ................................................................................. 198 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 1
1 DEWATERING DURING CONSTRUCTION 1.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) The Contractor shall provide all labour, material, and equipment necessary to design, build, operate, maintain, and remove the temporary dewatering facilities for protecting the Works under construction against flood flows in the rivers and creeks, and to design, build, install, operate, maintain and dismantle the temporary dewatering facilities required to remove service water and natural surface flow or groundwater seepage from the working areas on surface as well as from underground. (2) The Contractor shall be responsible for maintaining work sites free of water at all times. Contractor shall make good any damage whatsoever caused by flooding of the work sites due to failure of equipment, improper maintenance of protective works, and acts of negligence in his performance of the Work. The Contractor shall indemnify Owner against claims arising out of any such failure, made by other contractors, land holders or other persons. (3) The work shall be executed in accordance with the Contractor's design and specifications, and sequences as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) Temporary dewatering facilities shall be removed upon Completion of Works. 1.2 SUBMITTALS (1) Within 56 days after the date of issue of the Notification of Award, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge the detail planning of all diversion, protection and dewatering systems and the necessary flow measurements. (2) This design shall be consistent with the outline description submitted by the Contractor with his Tender, and shall include the following: a) Design assumptions and calculations, b) Layouts of diversion and drainage facilities, c) Layout and capacity of pumps and pipes, sumps, drains, both open and covered, well points, etc., including efficiency and heads, piping arrangement and discharge points, d) Details of standby dewatering arrangements, e) Proposal for treating polluted water either by settling basins, filters, traps for separating silt or any other suitable method, f) Any other arrangements or installations the Contractor may propose for temporary protection of the Works and dewatering of the working areas both in the open air and underground. (3) At least 27 days prior to scheduled construction of the particular work the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge full details of equipment to be installed and all necessary construction details required for the dewatering purposes. (4) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to require any additional information deemed necessary to be included in submitted documents. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 2
1.3 EXECUTION 1.3.1 General (1) Dewatering systems of adequate capacity shall be provided by the Contractor for carrying out dewatering of surface as well as the underground construction sites. The Contractor shall supply, install, maintain, and operate all dewatering pumps, pipes, supports, channels, troughs, electrical installations, and necessary accessories, and other consumables required to maintain the different work sites free of water during construction. (2) The Contractor shall provide standby power supply unit commensurate with the capacity of the pumps as to cope with the water inflow into construction sites during periods of breakdown and maintenance of his main power supply units. (3) Dewatering of the surface as well as the underground sites shall be undertaken by gravity whenever possible. Only where dewatering by gravity is not practical, pumping shall be resorted to after this mode has been approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) The Contractor shall propose the permanent sumps locations for approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. The energy meters for the purpose of measuring energy consumed in dewatering for payment shall be installed at those locations. (5) Where, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge existing or potential water inflows into excavations can be reduced or controlled by grouting, the Contractor shall perform grouting in accordance with Section "Drilling and Grouting". (6) The pumped water carried in pipes or flumes shall be discharged at point sufficiently away from the edge of the excavation. Care shall be taken to ensure that there is no seepage or backflow to the working areas. (7) The Contractor shall ensure that all drainage water will be disposed of without causing interference to his own or other contractors operations elsewhere at the Site and that no drainage water runs into adjacent Works. Water discharged from work areas shall not be polluted or endanger the environment. Any polluted water coming from the working sites shall be treated prior to its discharge from the Site. Particular attention shall be paid to possible pollution from oil or solvents coming into contact with the water prior to its discharge from the Site. Oil separators shall be provided within the drainage system as necessary. (8) The dewatering systems shall not adversely affect any of other project activities and structures or works of other agencies. Where more than one agency are working in the same or adjacent area, the Contractor who has already provided the drainage facility, shall extend this facility to other agencies also. In case of dispute the apportioning of such expenditure shall be decided by the Engineer-in-Charge, whose decision shall be final. In no case shall the Contractor stop the drainage activity. (9) In case the flow from the Contractor's site is passing through the site of other contractors or agencies, the drainage shall be attended by the Contractor in whose site the origin of the water is located. (10) If at any time during construction, in the opinion of Engineer-in-Charge, dewatering pumps in addition to the installed dewatering capacities are required in any working area, the Contractor shall provide and install such additional capacity of dewatering system as necessary. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 3
1.3.2 Dewatering of Surface Construction Sites (1) The Contractor shall perform all works necessary to keep the surfaces of construction sites free from rain, groundwater and service water. The contractor shall use suitable de-watering system in order to control any excess water for keeping the construction areas dry. The work shall include, but not be limited to the following: a) Design and construction of drainage system, ditches, pits, pump sumps and settlement ponds with oil separators, b) Design, furnishing, operation and maintenance of dewatering equipment, c) Relocation of dewatering facilities required for the performance of other works, d) All auxiliary works required for safe and continuous dewatering of the construction sites. (2) The Contractor shall design and install complete facilities at the surface of construction sites. All the components of the dewatering systems shall be installed and operated in accordance with the agreed method and the construction time schedule, or approved modification thereof. (3) Dewatering near the river or stream shall be done to lower the natural downstream water level by gravity. Suitable drainage shall be made joining the course downstream of the construction site to provide required gradient to facilitate proper and efficient dewatering. Below the natural water table, dewatering shall be done by pumping water collected in the sumps and discharging the same in to the river course downstream of the construction site. (4) The Contractor shall provide, install, maintain, and operate adequate pumping and other equipment, including standby units, to drain all water entering into any of surface construction sites. In addition, he shall provide sumps and pumps and/or multiple well point system in the immediate vicinity of foundations of structure using such water conductors as are necessary to conduct the water away from the excavation and concrete placement operations in an approved manner. (5) The Contractor shall provide the necessary power and energy for operating the pumps and well points, if any, system. The standby power supply shall undergo weekly trial runs lasting at least 30 minutes. (6) The dewatering systems shall be designed and installed in such a way that modifications and extensions to the systems are possible while they are in full operation. (7) Drainage ditches shall be excavated along the top of excavated slopes and on the berms. Such ditches shall be kept well back from the excavation edges in order to prevent saturating the upper part of the slopes. The ditches shall have sufficient longitudinal gradient and shall be regularly cleaned by the Contractor out of all accumulated silt and other matter so that water may flow freely at all times. (8) The Contractor shall take measures to ensure that the foundation surfaces remain free of standing water and undamaged by the passage of construction traffic. All ditches shall be outside the foundation areas. (9) Where excavation is to be made below the groundwater table in loose material, the Contractor shall lower the water table sufficiently below the working surface in advance of the excavation by means of properly screened wells and pumps. Where excavation extends below the water table in rock, the Contractor shall drill holes 6m deep below 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 4
the final grade, not further than 100 m apart, and measure the piezometric head in the hole for 2 days prior to blasting any rock. Excess hydrostatic pressure in the rock shall be relieved in approved manner to prevent upheaval of, or any other damage to the foundation. (10) Where concrete is to be placed, the water table shall be maintained below the lowest part of the finished excavation for minimum one day following the raising of structure above the natural groundwater table, and for such additional time as may be necessary to preclude damages to structure foundation. (11) Upon completion of dewatering, temporary pipes and pump sumps beneath permanent structures shall be closed off and completely filled with grout, mortar or concrete as required by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1.3.3 Dewatering of Underground Construction Sites (1) The Contractor shall perform all work necessary to collect and drain service and infiltrating groundwater, convey it to main conduits, and dispose it out from underground Works such as tunnels, caverns, adits or shafts either by using de- watering pumps or by gravity based on the infiltrating water. (2) The work shall include, but not be limited to, the following: a) Design and construction of pits and trenches, b) Design, supply, operation, and maintenance of dewatering equipment, c) Relocation of dewatering facilities required for the performance of other tunnelling work, d) Design construction and operation of settlement ponds with oil separators at the portals, e) All auxiliary work required for the safe and continuous dewatering of the underground sites. (3) Pilot holes will be drilled if required by the Engineer-in-Charge, to provide information on the inflow of water into the tunnel or shaft as the excavation proceeds. Where the indications are that flows are likely to be large, grouting to seal off the water flows and drilling of drainage holes may be ordered. (4) The Contractor shall design and provide a complete dewatering system for both the descending and the ascending headings. Dewatering of the ascending heading shall in general be by gravity. Only where dewatering by gravity is not practical, pumping shall be resorted to in ascending heading after special approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall design and construct corresponding drainage trenches in the tunnel inverts with or without lining as appropriate. (5) After break-through in the tunnel and shaft, the drainage water from the descending heading shall be taken over by the upgrade drainage system of the ascending heading (dewatering by gravity). (6) All excavated areas shall be drained of all service and groundwater. In order to keep the construction areas free from water, the dewatering systems must be able to operate at any time during the whole construction period in any part of the Works at the required capacity. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 5
(7) The Contractor shall provide adequate pumping capacity, including a sufficient number of standby pumping units, to handle all water entering into any portion of underground Works. These units shall be connected to the dewatering systems in such a way that proper and uninterrupted drainage will be guaranteed throughout the entire construction period. (8) The Contractor shall provide the necessary power and energy for operating the dewatering system. The standby power supply shall undergo weekly trial runs lasting at least 30 minutes. (9) All components of the systems shall always be maintained in ready-for-service condition and all access to pumps and other equipment shall be kept in good condition under the most adverse conditions. (10) The dewatering systems shall be designed and installed in such a way that modifications and extensions to the systems are possible while they are in full operation. (11) All components of the dewatering system shall be installed and operated in accordance with the agreed method and the construction time schedule, or approved modifications thereof. (12) After the excavated profile has been checked, the ground water which runs or drips into the excavated space shall be diverted into the drainage trench by means of water collectors, plastic foils, and pipes for collecting the seepage water from rock surfaces or steel lagging. Damp surfaces or seepage areas with low volume in flows can be sealed off with a quick-setting sealing compound. (13) Particular care shall be exercised where excavation passes through material which is liable to soften or swell when it comes into contact with water. In such locations the water entering the excavated space shall be collected as soon as possible and conveyed away in a pipe or other impervious channel in such a way that the water cannot come into contact with such material. Should the Contractor neglect to observe this requirement and a deterioration of the tunnel invert results from water being allowed to flow over or stand upon the sensitive or swelling material, the Engineer-in- Charge may order the removal of the affected material and it replacement with concrete. The Engineer-in-Charge may order installation of additional rock supports in connection with such remedial work. (14) If any water from another portion of the tunnel or shaft flows into a lower section where concreting is being done, either for the invert or for drainage trench or any other concreting likely to be affected by water, all such water shall be diverted past this area in such a way that no damage occur to the concrete. The length of the affected sections over which water has to be diverted shall be ordered by the Engineer-in- Charge. (15) The Contractor shall perform regular checking and cleaning of the drainage trench and all dewatering equipment and accessories during the whole construction period. (16) The dewatering facilities shall be kept in operation according to the agreed schedule which shall be related to the progress of the work. No pumps may be stopped, no pipes, ducts, trenches, etc., shall be taken out of service without the permission of the Engineer-in-Charge. (17) Any openings such as pipes, boreholes, ducts, pump sumps etc., used for temporary drainage purposes in any part of the Works shall be completely sealed by filling with grout, mortar or concrete when no longer required, unless the contrary is directed by 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 6
the Engineer-in-Charge in writing. The Contractor shall notify the Engineer-in-Charge in writing before any such openings are permanently closed. 1.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 1.4.1 Dewatering of Surface Construction Sites (1) No measurement and payment will be made for dewatering of surface construction sites. This is deemed to have included in the Unit Prices of open excavation items. 1.4.2 Dewatering of Underground Construction Sites (1) No measurement and payment will be made for dewatering of underground construction sites under normal conditions. This is deemed to have included in the Unit Prices of underground excavation items. Measurement for payment for dewatering underground construction sites will only be made in extraordinary conditions defined in the Special Conditions of Contract and measurement shall be of the energy consumed in pumping water. (2) Payment for dewatering in underground construction sites will be made at the Unit Price per kilowatt-hour (kWh) entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of: a) Supply, transportation, installation, operations, maintenance, testing, and removal of pumps, pipelines with all accessories, and other dewatering equipment for pumping water, regardless of the amount of water, b) Design of all dewatering systems, c) All costs and labour for excavation, construction and protection of drainage ditches, wells, pits, pump sumps, and settlement ponds, d) Multistage pumping, e) Capturing and conveying the water into the drainage system, f) Moving of the pumps and pipes as necessary between different locations, g) All auxiliary work required. (3) The stipulated Unit Price for dewatering will be payable to the Contractor for the measured actual energy consumed in dewatering. This Unit Price shall hold good for any quantity of dewatering required to be done by Contractor without any variation/deviation limit up to the approved construction period of the underground works except as stipulated below. a) The Contractor shall ensure that dewatering pumps provided shall perform in accordance with the manufacturer's specifications and at maximum efficiency. In the event of any of dewatering pumps provided by Contractor consume energy in excess of the values specified by manufacturer, the same shall be repaired and replaced by Contractor at his own cost, without delay and to the entire satisfaction of Engineer-in-Charge. b) Each pump installed shall undergo a weekly trial testing to demonstrate that it is actually discharging the water at its rated capacity and head. If significant deviations (more than 10% below) are discovered the Unit Price for pumping through that pump will be proportionally reduced for the period of the past 7 days, or until the time of the last pump testing, whichever may apply? Where several 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 7
pumps are installed at the same site, the weighted average of the capacity of all installed pumps shall be calculated and the Unit Price proportionally reduced. The pump capacity will be measured at the outlet of the installed pipeline. c) The meters and other electrical connections shall be installed by the Contractor at his own expense. Meters shall be calibrated and tested before installation and the test reports shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge prior to installation. d) The Contractor shall not be entitled to any claim or compensation due to failure or interruptions in electric supply. e) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for dealing with water and dewatering of underground construction sites by gravity, and the entire cost thereof shall be included in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works. (4) Payment for grouting and other treatment of seepage and fill grouting of drainage system will be made as stipulated in Section "Drilling and Grouting". (5) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following, and the cost thereof shall be deemed to be included in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works: a) Excavation of drains and sumps required for dewatering purpose, b) Piping arrangement, consumables, maintenance and repairs/replacement of dewatering system, c) Caulking or plugging, d) Construction, operation and maintenance of the settlement ponds, or other devices for treatment of polluted water, e) Any dewatering done by pumping in contravention of the instructions given by the Engineer-in-Charge.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 8
2 SURFACE EXCAVATION 2.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) This Section covers all surface excavation work to be performed under this Contract, which shall consist of removing all existing material of whatever nature to the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings or as otherwise directed by the Engineer- in-Charge. This work shall include drilling and blasting, loading, hauling and disposal of materials in designated spoil, stockpile areas or directly as construction materials. (2) The Contractor shall also be responsible for excavation which is not specifically required for the construction of Permanent Works, but incidental to the installation of temporary facilities such as site roads, office buildings, campsite, construction plants, etc. (3) Slope protection and stabilisation measures, which may be needed in conjunction with surface excavation work are covered in other Sections of these Specifications. (4) The approval given by the Engineer-in-Charge to the Contractors methods and equipment shall not relieve the Contractor of his full responsibility for the proper and safe execution of surface excavations, or of liability for injuries to, or death of persons, or any obligations under this Contract. 2.2 SUBMITTALS (1) At least 42 days prior to the commencement of any surface excavation, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge an updated method statement and programme giving full details of the proposed excavation methods and sequences, including necessary site drainage and safety precautions. Any variations from the corresponding data submitted with the Contractors tender will be explained and justified to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-charge. The data shall include the following: a) Location and area of blasts. b) Diameter, spacing, depth, pattern and orientation of blasting holes c) Type, strength, amount, column load and distribution of explosives to be used per hole, per delay and per blast. d) The type of detonators, powder factor, and sequence and pattern of delays to be used per blast. e) Description and purpose of any special methods or equipment to be adopted by the Contractor. (2) Within 14 days of receipt of the overall, updated excavation method statement and programme, Engineer-in-Charge will advise the Contractor in writing of his acceptance of, or comments on the submitted plans. The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to reject the proposed plan if in his opinion undesirable damage to permanent rock surfaces or existing structures would result from performing the blasting as proposed. If acceptance is withheld, a new plan in whole or in part shall be submitted. Drilling and blasting shall only be carried out in areas for which the plan has been accepted by Engineer-in-Charge. (3) In addition to preparing a detailed blasting plan, the Contractor shall submit, not later than 24 hours prior to each blast, a detailed proposal showing the final details of the 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 9
proposed blast. The Contractor shall not proceed with the blast until permission to load holes with explosives has been given by Engineer-in-Charge. (4) At least 21 days prior to dumping or stockpiling any material, the Contractor shall submit the layout of spoil or stockpile areas, which will be within the areas designated on the Tender Drawings or as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. All pertinent data of working methods and provisions for the security, stability and temporary and permanent drainage of the areas shall be included. Details of volumes, material types, heights and grades shall be provided. (5) Prior to starting any excavation in any particular area, the Contractor shall confirm in writing his agreement with the existing surveys and topographical data showing the original ground surface for the area in question which will be used for measurement purposes. Should the Contractor have any doubts as to the correctness, or sufficiency, of such data, he shall carry out an independent survey on his own and submit his survey to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval. In case of disagreement, the Engineer- in-Charge and Contractor shall mutually review the existing data. The agreement concerning the location of the original ground surface must be reached before commencing excavation work. Contractor's failure to follow the procedure outlined above will forfeit his right to claim any other locations of the original ground surface than that established by the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) To enable the Engineer-in-Charge to verify all necessary elevations and cross-sections of the original ground surface, prepared by the Contractor, the latter shall notify the Engineer-in-Charge in writing, giving at least 7 days notice before the commencement of any excavation. The Contractor shall clear, in advance, all vegetation that may interfere with this survey work. (7) The Contractor shall submit and agree with the Engineer-in-charge a monitoring plan for the excavation to observe potential or actual movement of the slopes excavated in the rock. This plan shall also give details of the procedures and equipment to be employed by the Contractor to stabilise or protect as quickly as possible any areas in which it is determined that untoward movement or deformation is occurring or is threatened. 2.3 LINES AND GRADES (1) The Contractor shall be responsible for setting-out all the structures and slopes as shown on the Construction Drawings, in accordance with the Section "Surveying and Setting-out Work". All extra work and over excavation caused by improper setting-out by the Contractor shall be corrected by himself immediately upon the request of the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The final excavation grades shall in general be rock of required quality. However, where the final excavation grades are defined by line and grade, the Contractor shall take every precaution, and use the most appropriate method of excavation, to avoid the loosening of material or the breaking of rock beyond the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings. (3) The bottoms of all excavations shall be trimmed to line and grade. Upon request of the Engineer-in-Charge, the final 200 mm of any loose geological formation in excavations where concrete is to be placed, shall be excavated by hand to avoid disturbance of the bottom. (4) If, for any reason, excavation is carried out beyond the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings, the Contractor shall remove the excess material and take the necessary measures to restore the required lines and grades with approved backfill or concrete, as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 10
(5) Should the Contractor wish to excavate beyond the limits given on the Drawings for his own convenience, he may do so only with the prior consent of the Engineer-in-Charge. 2.4 SLOPES, SLIDES, OVERBREAK AND UNSUITABLE FOUNDATIONS (1) If geological conditions during the performance of the work do not permit excavation of slopes as shown on the Construction Drawings, or where the material is unsuited to from a firm foundation for the structures, the Engineer-in-Charge will modify the drawings accordingly or issue direct order to change the slopes and grades. (2) If overbreak, slides or rockfalls occur, which, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge are due to improper working methods or negligence by the Contractor, and the effective excavated surfaces are beyond the excavation lines shown on the Construction Drawings, the Contractor shall remove all excessive material and, if required, place approved backfill in the excavated voids. 2.5 EXECUTION 2.5.1 General (1) The Contractor shall conduct all excavation procedures and operations so as to produce the required lines and grades. (2) The surface excavation shall be performed by any approved method using any excavating and hauling equipment suitable for the work in accordance with the submitted detailed plans and time schedule, or approved modifications thereof. (3) All excavated areas shall be drained to the satisfaction of Engineer-in-Charge. Any surface or subsurface water shall be satisfactorily controlled by methods acceptable to Engineer-in-Charge. (4) At all times during construction, Contractor shall adopt excavation procedures such that at no time shall the stability of any slope be impaired. The acceptance by Engineer-in-Charge of excavation procedures or equipment shall in no way relieve Contractor of his sole responsibility for safeguarding the stability of all the rock faces and slopes excavated under this Contract. (5) The Contractor shall carry out periodic cleaning to ensure that no hazardous accumulation of loose material occur on the slopes or on any berm or ledges forming part of the excavation profile. The removal of mud and slush resulting from rain or flooding of the sites shall be performed by the Contractor when, in the opinion of Engineer-in- Charge, it is considered necessary to ensure the safe and effective performance of the work. (6) Excavation for dam and structure foundations shall be performed in the dry. Final surfaces shall be protected against damage by erosion and movement of construction equipment. Any damage caused shall be repaired by the Contractor. (7) Rock faces and surfaces at sensitive excavations such as the spillway cut, at structures and tunnel portals, shall be carefully excavated and preserved during construction. Appropriate smooth blasting techniques shall be generally used there. Line-drilling may be applied at certain locations. Rock supports shall be installed where indicated on the Construction Drawings, or directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, to suit the actual geologic conditions encountered. (8) The Contractor shall exercise particular care when excavating in the vicinity of existing structures or those under construction. He shall be liable for any damage to structures 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 11
or equipment caused by his operations. Acceleration due to the blasting shall be monitored as specified hereinafter. (9) The Contractor shall protect the subsoil and particularly the ground water from contamination by fuel or oil from his equipment. (10) Water shall be sprinkled on work sites by the Contractor to ensure dust free atmosphere 2.5.2 Classification of Excavation Open excavation includes Common Excavation, Rock Excavation by Blasting, Dental Excavation, Minor Excavation by various methods detailed below in including by excavation of rock by ripping. 2.5.3 Common Excavation (1) Common excavation comprises clearing, stripping, and all kind of loose excavation other than solid mass of rock. (2) Clearing shall consist of cutting and disposing of all shrubs, stumps, debris and any other vegetation and organic topsoil, existing structures, foundations of structures (except concrete or masonry in mortar), fences and other materials on the surface of the ground within the areas to be cleared as indicated on the Construction Drawings, or as required by Engineer-in-Charge. (3) All flammable material resulting from clearing shall be either burnt or disposed of by the Contractor in a manner acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall be responsible for taking all safety measures required for burning of the materials, and he shall be responsible for any damage done by fire resulting from his work. The fire shall at no time be left unattended, until it has been fully extinguished. The Contractor shall have suitable equipment and supplies for fighting fire during the burning of material and shall take all necessary precautions to prevent fire from spreading. None of the disposed material shall be piled in stream of river or in a location where in the opinion of Engineer-in-Charge it is liable to be washed away by floods. (4) Stripping consists of removing all rubbish, humus, vegetable material and all or part of the organic topsoil in the areas and to the depth as indicated on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) Loose excavation means general excavation of material such as organic topsoil, clay, silt, sand, gravel, and boulders of up to 2 m 3 in volume and soft or disintegrated rock, which can be removed by common earth moving equipment without ripping or blasting. (6) Stripping and loose excavation shall be accomplished by proper excavation and hauling equipment suitable for the work which allows for an efficient work progress adopted to the soil conditions encountered. (7) When the bottom of excavation as indicated on the Construction Drawings is not rock and the natural foundation material is disturbed or loosened, for any reason, the Contractor shall improve it by compaction or replace it with approved fill and compact as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 12
2.5.4 Rock Excavation 2.5.4.1 General (1) Rock excavation by blasting includes all solid rock in place which cannot be removed until loosened by blasting, barring or wedging, removal of all boulders or detached pieces of solid rock, as well as any existing structural foundation made of concrete or masonry placed in mortar which cannot be removed during common excavation or by ripping. (2) Lines shown on the Tender or Construction Drawings such as "sound rock", "top of rock" etc., are approximate and for information only. They will not be used for measurement purpose. (3) All excavation shall be performed using methods and techniques that will produce smooth and sound rock surfaces with minimum overbreak and fracturing beyond the lines and grades or limits of excavation shown on the Construction Drawings, or as required by Engineer-in-Charge, and will preserve the structural integrity of the excavated openings. All precautions shall be taken by the Contractor to achieve this result and also preserve, in a soundest possible and undisturbed condition all the materials beyond the limits of the excavation of lines and grades shown on the drawings. Particular care shall be exercised where vertical or near vertical faces are required. (4) Drilling and blasting shall be done in such a manner as to ensure that the rock will break along the desired lines and grades. Rock shattered by blasting operations outside the established limits of excavation shall be removed and replaced by concrete if necessary. Rock faces and slopes shall be scaled or cleaned of loose or overhanging rock immediately after excavation. Rock surfaces, both temporary and permanent, shall be regularly inspected by the Contractor and rectified whenever necessary. (5) The diameter and the spacing of the blast holes shall be constantly adapted to the actual conditions at the Site. The Contractor shall develop the blasting techniques as the work progresses to obtain the best possible excavation surface after blasting. The techniques used shall be at all times subject to the agreement of the Engineer-in- Charge, who may order blasting tests to be undertaken by the Contractor to substantiate his proposed methods of blasting. The Contractor shall engage a qualified professional blasting consultant to assist in establishing satisfactory techniques (6) Rock excavation close to the final excavated surfaces shall be performed using controlled blasting methods such as "pre-splitting", "cushion blasting", "smooth blasting" as defined hereinafter. Line-drilling and broaching shall be used to limit the overbreak and damage of surrounding rock. (7) Shattering or splitting of rock, or the opening up of seams and joints in the rock, beyond the limits of excavation, shall be avoided. If in the opinion of Engineer-in- Charge such damage occurs due to Contractor's negligence, then additional rock support shall be installed and any resultant shattered material beyond such lines shall be removed and replaced with rockfill or concrete as required by Engineer-in-Charge. (8) Immediately following the blasting, and at any time throughout the duration of the Contract, the Contractor shall scale and remove from the excavations all loose material which appears to be unsafe or to endanger persons, work or property. The fact that such scaling and removal may enlarge the excavation beyond the required excavation lines shall not relieve the Contractor from the necessity of performing such scaling and removal. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 13
(9) After scaling and prior to excavation of the next bench or round, the Contractor shall install rock stabilisation and reinforcement, and provide any surface treatment need, as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (10) All blasted rock shall be removed from the bench toe before the succeeding bench is shot. The maximum bench height shall be as indicated on the Drawings and may be changed only with approval of Engineer-In-Charge. (11) The excavation shall be made to sufficient depths to secure foundations of structures on sound rock free from weathered materials or other objectionable defects, as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. The exploratory investigations of the foundations are not sufficiently complete to disclose all seams, defects, and other irregularities that may exist in the foundation rock. The lines of excavation shown on the Construction Drawings shall therefore not be interpreted as indicating the final or actual lines of excavation or that no defects exist. The excavations at all elevations shall be so shaped as to produce as uniform and regular a profile as is practicable to obtain using excavation methods described herein. (12) The final excavated surfaces shall have no abrupt changes in slope and sharp projections greater than 500 mm. Projections in excess of 500 mm shall be treated where necessary by supplementary excavation as determined by the Engineer-in- Charge, to produce the desired surface of contact between concrete and rock. (13) Whenever, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, further blasting may injure the rock upon or against which concrete is to be placed, or is otherwise undesirable, the use of explosives shall be limited to light charges or discontinued, and the excavation shall be completed by wedging, barring, line-drilling or other suitable methods approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (14) Should the presence of rock appear to make excavation for the foundations of any structures unnecessary to the extent which is shown on the Construction Drawings, the Contractor shall consult the Engineer-in-Charge before proceeding with such work. The Engineer-in-Charge will issue a direct order in writing on whether to proceed with the work as shown or to define the how the work shall be modified. (15) When the excavation has been completed to the approximate grade, as shown on the Construction Drawings or established by the Engineer-in-Charge, the surface shall be cleaned off by barring, wedging, picking or other approved methods, and with an air and/or water jet under high pressure for purpose of inspection. If the foundation is found to be not satisfactory, as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge, supplementary excavation shall be made as directed, and the surface again cleaned for inspection. This procedure shall be repeated until a satisfactory foundation is obtained. J ust prior to placing the concrete, a final cleanup of the rock surface shall be made. All loose, shattered, or disintegrated material shall be removed, and the final surface cleaned with jets of air and/or water under high pressure. (16) Contractor shall regularly monitor and inspect all excavations made under this Contract, and shall forthwith promptly remove and dispose of any rock which Engineer-in-Charge deems loose, unsound or disintegrated, or in any other way unsafe. 2.5.4.2 Control Perimeter Blasting (1) Bench or open-cut excavation of permanent rock slopes shall be carried out using the cushion blasting or presplitting techniques. However, depending upon the detailed geometry of rock slopes, other techniques, such as line-drilling, may be used with written approval of Engineer-in-Charge. Production holes within 3 m of the perimeter row of holes shall be drilled at a reduced spacing and charged with a reduced load. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 14
Perimeter holes shall be drilled in such a manner to meet the following tolerances with respect to length, collar, locations and alignment: a) The collar of perimeter holes shall be located within 75 mm of the perimeter line, b) Perimeter holes shall not be longer than 6.0 m unless agreed otherwise by Engineer-in-Charge, c) All perimeter holes shall be aligned so that each hole terminates within 200 mm of the line to which the holes are being drilled, d) Within 1 m of corners, the hole spacing shall be reduced by drilling intermediate holes so that satisfactory and high-quality excavation lines are maintained. The intermediate guide holes may or may not be loaded, depending on the results obtained and as required by Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Holes for perimeter blasting technique shall be at spacing of 450 mm, 600 mm or 750 mm. The selection of center-to-center spacing of holes for perimeter blasting shall be developed by trial. In initial stages of excavation, perimeter holes shall be assumed, drilled at 450 mm spacing and based on results this spacing may be varied. (3) Contractor's controlled perimeter drilling and blasting techniques shall be considered acceptable and in conformity with these Specifications for controlling the completed rock surfaces if : a) At least 50% of the drill hole traces of each round are visible in the final rock surface, distributed uniformly, after the scaling down of all loose and shattered rock that is liable to fall before or during rock reinforcement installation and if all drill hole traces are close to the lines shown in the Construction Drawings, b) Engineer-in-Charge may modify the above criteria if, in its opinion, the achievement of such results is not reasonably possible because of adverse rock conditions. (4) Drill holes for controlled perimeter blasting shall be loaded in a manner and detonated in a sequence so as to ensure a minimum of damage to the rock beyond the excavation lines. 2.5.5 Line-drilling (1) Line-drilling shall be used where control perimeter blasting may cause excessive damage to the surrounding rock or where there are structures adjacent to the excavation. (2) Line-drilling is defined as a single row of unloaded holes drilled along the neat excavation line, spaced no more than two to four times the hole diameter on centres. These will form a surface of weakness to which the primary blast can break. Light blasting with well-distributed charges fired after the main excavation is removed may be permitted in the holes. If, however, in the opinion of the Engineer the blasting may injure the rock, the use of explosives shall be discontinued and the excavation shall be completed by broaching, wedging, or barring. 2.5.6 Dental Excavation (1) Dental excavation shall include the removal of unsuitable material from shear zones, clay seams, pockets, joints, caverns, or from spaces between boulders beyond the lines of excavation shown on the Construction Drawings or established in the field, which are too small to be excavated by common earth moving equipment. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 15
(2) Dental excavation, depending on its extent, will require the use of a back-hoe, hand tools, or other small excavating equipment, as well as the use of a high velocity air- water jet. The methods employed shall be such as to avoid fracturing of the rock adjacent to the material being removed. (3) Dental excavation shall be performed where directed. The extent to which such material shall be removed, including the depth, direction, and dimensions of the work, will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. In general, however, excavation into cracks or seams shall be to the depth that is a minimum of three times the seam width, and such excavation shall be backfilled with concrete or shotcrete. No blasting will be permitted. 2.5.7 Minor Excavation Work (1) Minor excavation work consists of excavation, in all materials, of trenches or holes of less then, or equal to, 2 m of width, and in other small or restricted areas, which will be carried out manually or using small items of equipment. (2) The Contractor shall excavate to the limits, lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings. (3) Bracing, shoring or other methods of supporting the excavation shall be carried out as necessary. (4) Mechanical excavation of trenches, except those in rock, shall be stopped not less than 100 mm above final bottom level. The remainder of the excavation shall be removed, shaped, and graded manually. (5) In rock, the trenches shall be excavated to such depth than space for placing of compacted sand bedding at least 10 cm thick shall be provided between the rock and the underside of any equipment or pipe. 2.5.8 Additional Excavation (1) The Contractor may be directed by the Engineer-in-Charge to perform excavation beyond the lines and grades of already completed work. Such excavation shall be defined as additional excavation. (2) Additional excavation may consist of any or all classes of excavation stipulated in this Section. (3) Excavation outside the excavation limits, which is required by the Contractor for his own convenience, may be performed only with agreement by the Engineer-in-Charge, who may direct the Contractor to refill it with concrete or rockfill in a satisfactory manner. 2.6 EXCAVATED MATERIALS (1) All suitable materials from the excavations shall be utilised to the fullest extent practicable as construction materials in Permanent Works. (2) The Contractor's blasting and excavating techniques shall be such that, as far as practical, construction materials of satisfactory quality will be obtained. Wherever possible, such materials shall be excavated separately from materials needing to be disposed off to spoil tip. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 16
(3) Whenever possible, excavated material which is suitable for construction purposes shall be transported directly from the excavation area to the designated final locations for its use. (4) If the immediate placement in the final location is not possible, the materials shall be stockpiled. If the moisture content of excavated materials which would be suitable for embankments or backfill is too high after excavation, such material shall be drained and dried in the stockpile until the moisture content is sufficiently reduced to allow for placement. (5) The Contractor shall remove any cobbles, boulders or rock fragments found in otherwise approved materials which are greater or smaller than permitted for specific embankment zones and place them in other zones or dispose of them appropriately. 2.7 DISPOSAL OF EXCAVATED MATERIALS (1) Excavated materials which are not suitable for, or are in excess of the construction requirements shall be disposed of in the spoil area shown on the Tender Drawings, or in areas designated as such by the Engineer-in-Charge in the course of the work. The Contractor shall be responsible for the stability of all fills, embankments and stockpiles created by the disposal of excavated materials. (2) The spoil tips shall be located where they will not interfere with the natural flow of streams or rivers, with construction operations in the borrow and quarry areas, with reservoir operation, with flow of water to or from spillway or outlet works, or with accessibility to the Site. (3) Excavated materials shall be transported to the disposal areas in such a way that spillage onto roads etc. is avoided. Any materials which, despite the Contractor taking reasonable care, does fall onto roads etc. shall be promptly cleared and removed by the Contractor. (4) No rock material shall be dumped into any rivers or creeks. (5) The surfaces of all disposed excavated materials which are to remain permanently exposed shall be finished to prescribed lines and to stable slopes approved by Engineer-in-Charge. Adequate diversion of water courses in such areas and drains shall be constructed to prevent the undesirable accumulation of water in or around the disposal or stockpile areas. (6) The Contractor shall be liable for any damage to Temporary or Permanent Works or to third parties and their property caused by inadequate drainage of the spoil or stockpile areas. 2.8 PREPARATION AND PROTECTION OF EXCAVATION SURFACES (1) Excavation surfaces against or upon which concrete, embankment fill, or backfill will be placed shall be prepared and protected as specified herein and in combination with specifications contained in the pertinent Sections of these Specifications or as shown on the Construction Drawings. (2) If, during excavation work, material beyond the limits of excavation shown on the Construction Drawings is loosened or disturbed, the Contractor shall recompact the loosened material or remove it altogether and replace it with other compacted fill as directed. (3) If, during excavation in rock for concrete structures or linings, the rock beyond the limits of excavation shown on the Construction Drawings becomes broken or shattered, the 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 17
Contractor shall remove all loose material and replace it with concrete or shotcrete as directed. (4) Foundation excavation shall be kept well drained and free of standing water. The Contractor shall provide all necessary drains, ditches and sumps, and use pumps when necessary, in order to ensure that foundation surfaces are not harmed by water. When foundations are thus affected, the affected material shall be removed and replaced with approved backfill. (5) Shotcrete shall be applied to finished excavation surfaces where, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, it is deemed necessary to prevent air slaking, erosion or other deterioration of the surface. The protective coating shall be applied to excavated surfaces either with or without steel wire mesh reinforcement in accordance with the provisions of the Section "Shotcrete". 2.9 MONITORING AND PROTECTION FROM BLASTING (1) The Contractor shall adequately protect existing structures from the effects of blasting, both from impact with rock or debris and from excessive shock. Structures at risk shall be inspected both before and after blasting, and shall be monitored during the blasting operations by appropriate means, if so directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Engineer-in-Charge may monitor part or all of the blasting operations utilising velocity transducers, vibrographs or other equipment. The Contractor shall cooperate with Engineer-in- Charge in placing, operating and recording of monitoring equipment. (3) In case of concrete structures and cement grout maximum particle velocities that result from blasting operations shall not exceed the following limits: a) For concrete and grout in place for more than 60 hours, the maximum particle velocities shall not exceed 5 cm/s, b) For concrete or grout in place for less than 60 hours, the maximum particle velocity shall not exceed 1 cm/s, c) For complete or partially complete portions of platforms in fill, peak particle velocity shall not exceed 5 cm/sec and the maximum particle acceleration shall not exceed 1.0 g, (4) Blasting within 25 m of concrete or grout will be permitted only after concrete or grout is 7 days old and only after submission by Contractor, and approval by Engineer-in- Charge, of a plan showing the relative positions of structures or grouted area and the area to be blasted, Contractor's proposed drilling and blasting plan, together with outline of precautions to be taken. All concrete and other completed work within 25 m of blasting shall be protected by limiting the size of blasts. Blasting will not be permitted within 10 m of structures or installations vulnerable to damage by blasting. Replacement or repair of work damaged by blasting shall be carried out by the Contractor at no expense to Owner, unless otherwise instructed by Engineer-in- Charge. (5) The blasting restrictions stated above are given as a guide only and may be revised by Engineer-in-Charge on the basis of seismic measurements and observations during the progress of the work. If results of blast monitoring indicate that Contractor's blasting methods endanger excavation, grout or concrete work, Contractor shall be required to alter its blasting methods accordingly at no expense to Owner. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 18
2.10 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 2.10.1 Clearing (1) Measurement for clearing shall be made for the actual area of ground cleared as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per hectare entered in the Schedule and shall include cutting and disposing of all trees, stumps, roots, rubbish, bushes, any other vegetation and existing structures, foundations of structures, fences or any other objectionable materials 2.10.2 Open Excavation (1) Measurement for payment for open excavation for any class of excavation specified herein (including stripping, line drilling, perimeter/smooth blasting, dental excavation, minor and loose excavation) will be of the in-situ volume as measured from a survey performed by the Contractor prior to any excavation work and the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings or established at the Site by the Engineer-in- Charge. (2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of the following: a) Provision of all labour, equipment and materials required for excavation, including any hand work necessary for trimming excavated surfaces; preparation, protection and maintaining excavated surfaces in satisfactory conditions until concrete or fill is placed; all additional excavation for Contractor's convenience; any temporary supports necessary to support the sides of the excavations, b) Loading, hauling and dumping of the excavated material on stockpiles, spoil tips or points of incorporation in Permanent Works or to the locations shown by the Engineer-in-charge; clearing of the spoil areas and formation of spoil tips as specified; clearing of the stockpile areas, formation and maintenance of stockpiles and spoil tips, drainage and dealing with water in stockpiles and spoil tips, re- handling of suitable materials including segregating, grading, draining and drying of materials suitable for use in embankment construction or as backfill, c) All delays during excavation work resulting from installation of rock supports, stabilisation and protection works required by the geotechnical conditions of the material encountered, d) Complying with all requirements of statutory laws and regulations relating to blasting work and any restrictions resulting therefrom; obtaining all necessary permits and licenses for the purchase, use, storage and transport of explosives or any other material and equipment, e) Surveying, setting-out, checking of excavated profile and alignment, and any subsequent rectification works resulting from undue or incorrect surveys; provision of suitable equipment for, and delays due to carrying out this work. (3) Measurement for payment of additional volumes of excavation resulting from modification of slopes and grades shown on the Construction Drawings, which may be necessary in the course of the work, will be of the in-situ volume as measured between the original and the modified lines and grades. 2.10.3 Exclusions (1) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 19
a) Extra work caused by the Contractor's negligence in setting-out the structures and slopes. b) Surveys to verify the original ground surface, or for recording the top of the rock surface. c) Any change or delays to excavation works resulting from the need to install rock supports, or stabilising or protection works, in excavation areas. d) Provision and cleaning of drain ditches on the berms, e) Removal of the materials resulting from any slides or overbreak caused by Contractor's inappropriate working methods and for the additional materials required to fill the voids so created. f) Additional work of removing material, backfilling voids with approved material, and installing additional rock supports in over break. g) Excess excavation required for Contractor's convenience and the resulting additional backfilling with approved materials. h) Additional work resulting from the Contractor changing slopes without prior approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. In such event, payment will be made only to the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings. i) Excavation which is incidental to the Contractors installations. j) Shoring, bracing, and supporting of excavation surfaces except as specified in the Sections "Rock Supports" and "Slope Protection". k) Clearing, grubbing and stripping in the borrow and quarry areas, and spoil and stockpile areas. l) Draining, shaping, and trimming the dumped material in the spoil tips to the lines and grades as directed or approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. m) Preparation and protection of foundation and slopes with the exception of concrete protective coating, which will be measured and paid for in accordance with the provisions of the Section "Shotcrete". n) Stockpiling of construction materials from required excavations materials which cannot be incorporated directly into Permanent Works. o) Work or materials required when foundation surfaces have been allowed to become unsuitable due to the action of ground or surface water. p) Extra work or material required to repair damages to the final excavation surfaces caused by the erosion or travel of the construction equipment. q) Monitoring of existing structures during blasting operations. r) Surface Dewatering and keeping the surface excavation sites dry (2) Any additional excavation in areas where surface excavation has already been completed, which the Contractor may be directed by the Engineer-in-Charge to carry out, will be measured and paid for at the same Unit Prices entered in the Schedule as for the original excavation. No increase in Unit Prices will be allowed for such additional excavation. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 20
3 UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION 3.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) This Section covers all excavation work for underground structures to be constructed under this Contract performed by conventional tunnelling and shaft driving methods using drilling and blasting or in exceptional cases by manual means. The work shall include all drilling and blasting, loading, transporting, and disposal of materials in spoil or stockpile areas, as well as the removal of all loose material and cleaning of excavated surfaces. (2) Excavation shall be made to the lines, grades and dimensions shown on the Construction Drawings or as otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) The Contractor shall comply with all safety procedures and requirements as stipulated in the Section "Safety Precautions". (4) Rock supports, Shotcrete and dewatering are works covered in other Sections of these Specifications. (5) Devices for monitoring the excavation and rock-mechanics tests to be supplied and performed by the Contractor are specified in other Section of these Specifications. (6) The Contractor may be required to perform exploratory drilling during excavation of the tunnels and shafts to ascertain the geological conditions. (7) The approval given by the Engineer-in-Charge to the Contractor's methods and equipment shall not relieve the Contractor of his full responsibility for a proper and safe execution of underground excavations, or of liability for injuries to, or death of persons, or any obligations under this Contract. 3.2 SUBMITTALS (1) At least 42 days prior to the commencement of excavation, the Contractor shall submit details of his excavating methods and sequences for portal excavation and all underground works, including equipment, ventilation, rock support, and safety. (2) The description of drilling and blasting procedures shall include the following: a) Diameter, spacing, depth, pattern and orientation of blast holes, b) Type, strength, amount, column load, and distribution of explosives to be used per hole, per delay, and per blast, c) Type of detonators, and sequence and pattern of delays to be used per blast, d) Description and purpose of any special method to be adopted by the Contractor, e) Sequence of various activities of the excavation work in different headings with an indication of corresponding time requirements for each of the stipulated excavation classes. (3) At least 21 days prior to dumping or stockpiling any material, the Contractor shall submit the layout of spoil and stockpile areas, which will be within the areas designated on the Tender Drawings or as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. All pertinent data of working methods and provisions for the security, stability, and temporary or 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 21
permanent drainage of the areas shall be included. Details of volumes, material types, heights and grades shall be provided. (4) To enable the Engineer-in-Charge to verify all necessary setting-out and elevations carried out by the Contractor, the latter shall notify the Engineer-in-Charge in writing, giving at least 7 days notice, of his intention to start excavation. (5) During the advance of underground excavations, the Contractor shall record and submit weekly to the Engineer-in-Charge 3 copies of the following: a) Advance of each face and the chainage of face before the blasting of each round, b) Type and number of drillholes, and length of each round, c) Pattern of drillholes, their diameters and length, d) Type, quality and location of explosives in each drillhole, and blasting scheme (direct or retarded), e) Theoretical volume of solid material excavated according to typical sections, shown on the Construction Drawings, f) Geology, competence of the rock formations, rock falls, zones of instability, and information obtained from any pilot holes, g) Surface of shotcrete, and wire mesh installed, h) Numbers, lengths, and types of rockbolts / rockanchors installed, i) Amount, location, spacing, and type of steel ribs and lagging installed, j) Water inflows at the face and the rate of discharge of water from the Dewatering systems, and the temperature of the water, k) Occurrence of gas, l) Personnel employed during various stages of the operation and their qualification, m) Time required and detailed for each activity, n) Unusual occurrences, all delays and the reasons for delays, o) Volume of fresh air in the heading zone. (6) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to require any additional information deemed necessary to be included in the documents to be submitted. 3.3 DEFINITIONS CONVENTIONAL EXCAVATION is the excavation performed by conventional tunnelling and shaft driving methods using drilling and blasting or by manual means. FACE is the advance end or wall of a tunnel, shaft or other excavation at which the work is progressing. HEADING ZONE refers to tunnels (ascending and descending headings) and shafts (vertical or inclined) with upward heading, excavated by conventional method (drilling and blasting) and is 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 22
defined as the zone between newly established face and the distance equal to 1 m plus the length of the previous round behind that face, measured along the tunnel or shaft centreline. BOTTOM RANGE ZONE is the zone in the vertical shafts excavated by downward sinking, or by reaming of the raise-bored shafts between the newly established floor and 1 m plus the length of the previous round above it, regardless of shaft diameter. REAR ZONE is the whole length of tunnel or shaft between the heading zone and the portal or the top. ROUND is defined as a single cycle of drilling, loading and blasting to excavate rock, scaling, mucking and moving construction equipment in and out. HEADING AND BENCHING EXCAVATION is tunnel excavation carried out in two or more steps "Heading" is defined as the crown portion of underground tunnel excavation, which is undertaken as the first blast in each round; blast holes are generally horizontal for this purpose of excavation. "Benching" excavation is defined as the excavation of platform left after the 'Heading' excavation. Blast holes other than perimeter holes are generally vertical in such an excavation. PILOT TUNNEL is defined as an initial excavation of limited cross section performed within the proposed tunnel limits, located as required anywhere within the proposed tunnel cross section. FOREPOLING is defined as the placement of near horizontal steel bars / pipes / sections around the periphery of the heading to form a rock support cage, in areas of weak rock. SHAFT, in general, means an underground excavation that is inclined at a grade greater than 40 0 to the horizontal. 3.4 EXCAVATION LINES (1) Typical cross sections, excavation lines, and dimensions of excavations and thickness of lining, where appropriate, are shown on the Tender Drawings. (2) The "A"-line (Minimum Excavation Line) shown on the drawings is the line within which no rock and no support, other than permanent support systems will be permitted to remain. (3) The "B"-line (Pay Line or Theoretical Excavation Line) shown on the drawings (which is 100 mm away from the A-line around in all underground excavations i.e. tunnels, shafts and caverns) is the line to which payment for the excavation will be made. Measurement for payment of excavation will in all cases be made to the "B"-line regardless of whether the limits of the actual excavation fall inside or outside the "B"- line. (4) The Contractor is required to perform the excavation works in such a way that the final excavation surface is located between the "B" and "A"-lines and he shall take into account the imprecision of grade and alignment of the excavation by his excavating equipment, and guarantee that the theoretical thickness of the concrete lining is never reduced. All out-of-line excavations shall be rectified so that the "A"-line as defined above is maintained. (5) Immediately behind the face, the Contractor shall measure the excavated profile by means of a profile template or another method approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) Excavation not shown on the Construction Drawings and not included in the Schedule, but which the Contractor considers necessary for this own purposes, such as excavation for passing and turning niches / train switches or stations, rail foundations, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 23
mucking pits, pump sumps, drain ditches other than those shown on the Construction Drawings, adits, spaces for supply facilities, may only be carried out with the prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. All such excavations shall be backfilled with appropriate Class of concrete up to the "B"-line prior to commencement of the final tunnel or shaft lining. (7) The location of the tunnel portals shown on the Construction Drawings is only approximate. The actual position will depend on the ground conditions and will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge during the progress of the work. 3.5 OVERBREAK (1) Excavation beyond the "B"-line (Pay Line or Theoretical Excavation Line) is defined as Over break. In case cavity or chimney formation occurs during the excavation works, they shall be deemed to be covered by this definition of the "Over break". (2) Geologically accepted Over breaks in underground excavation is defined as a locally originated Over break which occurs while each of the following three conditions are simultaneously fulfilled: a) Over breaks occur above the tunnel invert level, i.e. Over break at invert will not be recognised, b) The Engineer-in-Charge is immediately informed and given an opportunity for inspection while both the cause and the extent of the Over breaks are clearly visible, c) Over break was, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, not result of Contractor's using improper or improperly applied working methods or his otherwise negligence, and could not have been prevented by prompt and appropriate installation of supports. (3) The Contractor shall survey and plot cross sections at sufficient intervals (say 2 m) to allow for a reasonably accurate estimate of the volume of Overbreak, which he claims to be due to geological conditions. (4) All voids created by Over break extending beyond the "B"-line shall be filled up to the "B"-line with concrete or shotcrete. The class of concrete and time of placing of the concrete shall be as directed by the Engineer-in-charge. (5) If, for any reason other than accepted geological reasons, excavation is carried out beyond the "B line or the neat line (for example due to the Contractor's careless blasting), the Contractor shall remove the excess material and backfill the voids as described above without any measurement thereof. 3.6 SUPPORTS FOR UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION (1) The provisional or permanent supports for the underground excavation shall principally consist of the shotcrete with or without wiremesh as primary element and supplemented as needed by individual or pattern rockbolts. Structural steel supports shall be used only when required by the rock conditions as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Engineer-in-Charge, after having consulted with the Contractor, will determine the rock support system, which shall be used during the excavation advance. The decision of Engineer-in-charge shall be final in this regard. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 24
(3) The Contractor shall employ supervising engineers, who by their schooling and knowledge are experienced in supporting work. These supervisors shall examine the rock conditions after each excavation advance and shall verify that the rock support system is installed as ordered. These supervisors shall be continuously present and inspect each face throughout the duration of underground excavation work. (4) The required supports shall be installed without delay during the process of excavation within the heading zone, without which further advance shall not be allowed. In the rear zone, additional supports shall be installed immediately after it is observed that the natural material or the supporting system previously installed is not sufficient to prevent further loosening of the material surrounding the excavation. (5) Shotcrete, with or without steel wire mesh, SFRS shall be applied to excavated surfaces in accordance with the provisions of the Section "Shotcrete". The Contractor shall take into account in his construction planning that placing of shotcrete support may be required immediately after blasting a round but before mucking-out is started. (6) Rockbolts, rock anchors, wire mesh and structural steel supports shall be installed in accordance with the provisions of the Section "Rock Supports". (7) The use of timber will not be permitted for tunnel supports in any form, not even for temporary purpose. (8) The Contractor shall keep on the Site all necessary plant and equipment for installing rockbolts and shotcrete ready for operation in the heading zone during the whole excavation period. (9) Even though it is the Engineer-in-Charge who determines the type and amount of rock supports to be installed (which might be complemented or objected by the Contractor), it is the Contractor who shall bear the whole responsibility for the proper and safe execution of the works, including the provision of extra supports and special protection for the personnel when the conditions so require. 3.7 CLASSIFICATION OF UNDERGROUND EXCAVATION FOR INSTALLATION OF SUPPORTS (1) Underground excavation is divided into different classes in order to differentiate the difficulties and hindrance during excavation work, which the Contractor has to cope with, due to the properties of material encountered. (2) The class of excavation is defined in relation to the hindrance in the progress of the excavation works caused by the type and amount of rock supports installed, and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, during excavation within the tunnel heading zone. Typical sections showing the rock supports for different classes of rock have been provided in the tender drawings. (3) No excavation classes shall be applicable for the excavation of caverns. (4) No excavation classes shall be applicable for the excavation of shafts by any method. (5) Subsequent or supplementary installation of supports behind the heading or bottom range zones shall have no influence on the designation of the excavation classes. (6) The definition of each excavation class is based only on the supporting measures installed and shall be valid irrespective of the excavation method used, i.e. full-face or partial excavation (e.g. top heading and benching). 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 25
(7) The assignment of an individual excavation class shall always apply to the whole of the theoretical excavation cross section as defined by the "B"-line, even if the partial excavation method is being used. (8) The underground excavation classes are specified as follows: Class I Definition: Installation of rock supports does not cause any hindrance to the excavation work. Measures: The excavated section remains basically unsupported and individual rockbolts or anchors and shotcreting in localised areas, which may be applied, will not be taken into consideration for classification purposes. Class II Definition: The installation of supports causes minor hindrance of the excavation work, but basically it does not influence or delay the progress of excavation. Measures: Support system consists of shotcrete which is applied to the ordered thickness possibly with some rockbolts or anchors, or pattern rock-bolting or anchoring. Class III Definition: Installation of supports causes some hindrance and slowing down of the excavation work. Measures: Support system consists of shotcrete in one or more layers and pattern rock-bolting or anchoring, possibly combined with wire mesh as shotcrete reinforcement. Class IV Definition: Installation of supports causes a heavy hindrance of the excavation work, such that support installation becomes a part of the work cycle. Measures: Support system consists of steel ribs, with or without invert bracing, and steel or pre-cast concrete lagging (backfilled with concrete) may be required; the steel rib supports must be complemented with rockbolts or anchors and shotcrete, and with wire mesh between or encasing the steel ribs. Class V Definition: Excavation is only possible by heading and benching with the simultaneous installation of supports, and under their protection. Measures: Support system consists of steel ribs, wall plates and lagging placed continuously at the face immediately after excavating any part of the cross- section; steel ribs and lagging shall be complemented with systematic rock bolting or anchoring and the steel ribs may have to be completely encased in shotcrete, with wire mesh reinforcement as required, when lagging is not used. (9) No classes will be attributed within the portion where multi-drift / multi-segmental excavation has been performed. 3.8 EXECUTION 3.8.1 Excavation Procedures (1) Prior to the commencement of underground excavations for tunnels the Contractor shall construct a portal of sufficient rigidity in order to provide a good abutment for the forces created in the rock due to the first opening. The portal shall be of reinforced 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 26
concrete or steel ribs-shotcrete-wire mesh construction, or excavated surface supported with shotcrete wiremesh and rockbolts depending on the rock conditions. (2) Forepoling and advance probing may also be required as directed by the Engineer-in- charge. (3) The Contractor shall use drilling and blasting techniques which will produce a smooth final profile, a minimum of Overbreak and a minimum of fracturing of the rock beyond the required excavation lines. The techniques used shall be at all times subject to the Engineer-in-Charge's consent, who may order several blasting tests to be undertaken by the Contractor to substantiate his proposed methods of blasting. (4) When deemed necessary and ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge, the Contractor shall carry out exploratory drillings as described in the Section "Drilling and Grouting". (5) The blasting pattern proposed to be adopted shall be submitted by the contractor well in advance to the Engineer-in-charge for approval. No excavation shall be undertaken until the permission in writing has been given by the Engineer-in-charge. However, during the progress of excavation the drilling and blasting pattern, specifically the number and depth of holes, quantity, quality, and distribution of explosives, shall be varied as necessary to suit the rock conditions encountered, taking into consideration the information obtained from the pilot holes and actual drilling work (velocity, colour of rinsing water, etc.), as well as of the previous blasting results. (6) Only wet drilling will be permitted in order to reduce dust in the underground excavations. (7) Perimeter drillholes shall be placed such that the over excavation beyond the "A"-line is minimised. The Contractor shall pay the utmost attention to obtain a smooth and uniform excavation surface. (8) Should the entire length of most of the perimeter drillholes not be visible after each round of blasting, the Contractor shall make an adequate adaptation in the blasting pattern used, and submit it to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval. (9) The depth of a new round shall never exceed that which was determined and approved prior to commencement of blasting. The Engineer-in-Charge may order a reduction of the adopted round depth if the actual rock condition requires it. (10) Blasting of a new round will not be permitted if insufficient personnel are available to perform the mucking and support work afterwards. In particular this applies to work before holidays, non-working weekends, etc. (11) Blasting that may damage the rock beyond the required excavation lines or the tunnel installations will not be permitted. Any damage to, or displacement of the supports, and any damage to any part of the Works caused by blasting or any other of the Contractor's operations shall be repaired by the Contractor in a manner satisfactory to the Engineer-in-Charge, at no cost to Owner. (12) No new round shall be blasted until the support work required within or behind the heading zone has been installed. (13) Immediately following blasting, at frequent intervals during the progress of the work, and finally during clean-up prior to placing the final tunnel lining, all loosened material that is likely to fall shall be removed. (14) All rock material projecting inside the "A"-line shall be removed. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 27
(15) All loose rock shall be removed from the underground construction sites and disposed of in the approved spoil areas. (16) The Contractor shall constantly check the progress of excavation by means of Laser survey in order to avoid any substantial rectification of the already opened profile and eventual rearranging of the installed rock supports. (17) Where excessive inflows of water occur at the face, the Contractor shall take all appropriate measures to execute the excavation work safely and properly, including provision of extra supports and protection for workmen, and any special equipment necessary for working in waterlogged conditions. 3.8.2 Blasting All tunnels and shafts excavations shall be performed by controlled blasting techniques as described below. a) Smooth blasting: consists of drilling a number of closely spaced holes along the final excavation perimeter, placing light charges in the holes and detonating the charges at the end of round. The outer line of drill holes for the main blast is set at an approved distance inside the final perimeter leaving an annulus of rock to be peeled off the damaged final excavation perimeter by the smooth blast. The smooth blast holes are drilled, charged and blasted in the same tunneling cycle as the main blast. b) Presplitting: Consists of drilling a single row of closely spaced holes along the final excavation perimeter. These holes are lightly charged and detonated before the main blast, to produce a presplit crack which limits the propagation of cracks from the subsequent main blast, and in such a way reduces damage in the rock beyond it. The blasting of the main excavation zone requires a reduced explosive charge in the line of holes nearest to the presplit line, and a limit on the distance between the presplit line and the nearest line of main blast holes. The presplit holes shall be drilled deeper than the depth of the round. c) Line drilling shall be used where control perimeter blasting may cause excessive damage to the surrounding rock or where there are structures adjacent to the excavation. Line-drilling is defined as a single row of unloaded holes drilled along the neat excavation line, spaced no more than two to four times the hole diameter on centres. These will form a surface of weakness to which the primary blast can break. Light blasting with well-distributed charges fired after the main excavation is removed may be permitted in the holes. If, however, in the opinion of the Engineer the blasting may injure the rock, the use of explosives shall be discontinued and the excavation shall be completed by broaching, wedging, or barring. d) Cushion blasting: A special case of blasting in which considerable air space or stemming surrounds charges in the holes and serves to reduce undesired blast effect on the final excavation perimeter. Contractors controlled blasting techniques shall be considered acceptable and in conformity with these Specifications for Controlling the completed rock surfaces if : a) At least 50% of the drill hole traces of each round are visible in the final rock surface, distributed uniformly, after the scaling down of all loose and shattered rock that is liable to fall before or during rock reinforcement installation and if all drilling hole traces are between A & B lines. b) Engineer-in-Charge may modify the above criteria if, in its opinion, the achievement of such results is not reasonably possible because of adverse rock conditions. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 28
3.8.2.1 Blasting Personnel a) The contractor shall engage a full time professional blasting expert to assist in establishing satisfactory blasting techniques subject to the approval of Engineer-in- charge, at no additional cost to the Employer. b) The contractor shall provide licensed Blaster and inspectors capable of inspecting freshly blasted faces, deal with misfires, evaluate air and dust conditions and direct scaling operations in accordance with the safety requirements as envisaged in Safety Precautions. All blasting operations including handling of explosives shall be done by the licensed blasters only. 3.8.3 Cleaning of Excavated Surfaces (1) Even prior to the removal of the bulk of the material loosened by blasting, the Contractor shall clean the newly exposed rock surface from rock fragments, dust and debris to permit, if required, the application of the first layer of shotcrete. Windows in this shotcrete layer shall be left open for geological mapping and inspection. (2) Cleaning shall be done by directing a jet of water or air at the rock surface. Compact, washable rock shall be cleaned with compressed air-water jets. Rock, which tends to a quick disintegration, or is interspersed with clay filled fissures, shall be cleaned with compressed air only. The cleaning shall be carried out to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) This cleaning is separate from clean up of the excavated surfaces required immediately prior to placing of the final tunnel lining described in the Section "Concrete". 3.8.4 Protection of Tunnel Invert In case small grain or broken excavation material is used for invert protection, it shall be removed prior to placing of invert concrete or the final tunnel lining. No vehicular traffic shall be permitted over the tunnel invert after removal of the protective material. 3.8.5 Excavation of Caverns/Chambers Initially a central heading along the longer axis shall be excavated and supported with the primary supports as envisaged in the construction drawings. The either side of the heading shall be excavated by slashing and shall be supported simultaneously as shown on the drawings. The contractor shall furnish the excavation sequence proposed to be carried out by him for the approval of Engineer-in-charge. The excavation sequence shall clearly indicate the line, levels and sequence numbers of the excavation methodology proposed to be followed. It should be specifically understood that the contractor shall be allowed to carry out benching only when the entire primary rock support as envisaged in the construction drawings has been fully placed in entire width of the chambers and accepted by the Engineer-in-charge. 3.8.6 Excavation of Shafts (1) The shafts shall be in general excavated by full sinking method. (2) In case the Contractor prefers to excavate any of the shaft by first driving a Pilot shaft followed by slashing, then the cost of the rock support and ground treatment (like grouting) during the course of pilot excavation shall be borne by the Contractor. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 29
3.9 EXCAVATED MATERIALS 3.9.1 Use of excavated materials (1) All suitable materials from the excavations shall be utilised to the fullest extent practicable as construction materials in Permanent Works. (2) The Contractor's blasting and excavating techniques shall be such that, as far as practical, construction materials of satisfactory quality will be obtained. (3) Whenever possible, excavated material which is suitable for construction purposes shall be transported directly from the excavation area to the designated final locations for its use. (4) If the immediate placement in the final location is not possible, the materials shall be stockpiled. If the moisture content of excavated materials which would be suitable for embankments or backfill is too high after excavation, such material shall be drained and dried in the stockpile until the moisture content is sufficiently reduced to allow for placement. (5) The Contractor shall remove any cobbles, boulders or rock fragments found in otherwise approved materials which are greater or smaller than permitted for specific embankment zones and place them in other zones or dispose of them appropriately. 3.9.2 Disposal of excavated materials (1) Excavated materials which are not suitable for, or are in excess of the construction requirements shall be disposed of in the spoil area shown on the Tender Drawings, or in areas designated as such by the Engineer-in-Charge in the course of the work. The Contractor shall be responsible for the stability of all fills, embankments and stockpiles created by the disposal of excavated materials. (2) The spoil tips shall be located where they will not interfere with the natural flow of streams or rivers, with construction operations in the borrow and quarry areas, with reservoir operation, with flow of water to or from spillway or outlet works, or with accessibility to the Site. Where required, the Contractor shall permanently divert (stage-wise if necessary) the present courses of the streams. (3) Excavated materials shall be transported to the disposal areas in such a way that spillage onto roads etc. is avoided. Any materials which, despite the Contractor taking reasonable care, does fall onto roads etc. shall be promptly cleared and removed by the Contractor. (4) No material shall be dumped into any rivers or creeks. (5) The surfaces of all disposed excavated materials which are to remain permanently exposed shall be finished to prescribed lines and to stable slopes approved by Engineer-in-Charge. Adequate diversion of watercourses in such areas and drains shall be constructed to prevent the undesirable accumulation of water in or around the disposal or stockpile areas. (6) The Contractor shall be liable for any damage to Temporary or Permanent Works or to third parties and their property caused by inadequate drainage of the spoil or stockpile areas. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 30
3.10 EVACUATION OF WATER The Contractor shall carry out all work required to capture and drain service and infiltrated groundwater during the construction as stipulated in the Section "Dewatering During Construction". 3.11 ILLUMINATION The Contractor shall install an adequate illumination system in the underground works as stipulated in the Section "Safety Precautions". 3.12 VENTILATION AND CONTROL OF DUST, SILICA AND NOXIOUS GASES The Contractor shall install and operate equipment and carry out all works required for the ventilation and control of dust, silica and noxious gases as stipulated in the Section "Safety Precautions" 3.13 COMMUNICATION SYSTEM The Contractor shall install and operate the communication system between each face and entrance to the tunnel or shaft as stipulated in the Section "Site Installations". 3.14 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 3.14.1 General (1) Measurement for payment and payment for underground excavation shall be made only when the excavation along with the associated rock reinforcement as shown on drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge has been completed in all respects. (2) The definitions of the excavation classes are only relevant for the purpose of installation of rock supports. (3) Measurement for payment for underground excavation will be of the in-situ volume defined by the "B-line (Pay Line or Theoretical Excavation Line) as specified in these specifications. (4) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of the following: a) Provision of all labour, equipment and materials required for the excavation by tunnelling and shaft driving methods including drilling for pilot holes and holes for blasting; developing and improving controlled blasting methods, blasting tests and performance of blasting; cleaning, washing, protection, and maintaining excavated surfaces in satisfactory conditions, and protection of tunnel invert until the concrete lining is placed; all enlargements and additional excavations required by the Contractor for his construction methods; all temporary supports required for the safety of working crews, b) Provisions for, and operation of, the train as well as vehicular traffic; loading, hauling, and dumping the excavated material on stockpiles, spoil tips, or points of incorporation into the Permanent Works or to the locations as directed by Engineer-in-charge; clearing of the spoil areas and formation of spoil tips as specified; clearing of the stockpile areas, formation and maintenance of stockpiles, re-handling of suitable materials including segregating, grading, drainage and drying of materials suitable for use in embankment construction or as backfill, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 31
c) All delays during excavation work resulting from installation of rock supports required by the geotechnical conditions of the material encountered, irrespective of the distance from the face, d) Complying with all requirements of statutory laws and regulations relating to underground works and any restrictions resulting therefrom; obtaining all necessary permits and licences for the purchase, use, storage, and transport of explosives and other materials, e) Surveying, setting-out, checking of excavated profile and alignment, and any subsequent rectification works resulting from undue or incorrect surveys; provision of suitable equipment for, and delays due, to carrying out this work, f) Furnishing, installation, operation, maintenance, and removal of communication, illumination, and ventilating systems; safety precautions and measurement of dust, silica, and noxious and flammable gases, g) Recording and preparation of reports related to excavation progress and procedures h) All work involved with, and any partial or short interruptions or inconveniences caused by, the check surveys and performance of rock mechanics test, for which no separate payment is provided elsewhere in these Specifications. 3.14.2 Overbreak and Backfilling (1) No payment will be made for the removal of material or for backfilling with cast-in-place concrete or shotcrete or grout, for excavation beyond the "B"-line (Pay Line or Theoretical Excavation Line) except in case of a geologically accepted over break. (2) Measurement for payment for the disposal/removal of material and backfilling of voids arising from over break accepted by the Engineer-in-Charge as occurring entirely for geological reasons, will only be made if the Contractor requests measurement directly after excavation, or as long as the overbreak can clearly be determined as being due to adverse geological conditions. (3) For approved over break due to geological conditions, all excavated material outside the "B"-line shall be measured. No payment will be made for excavation, but measurement for payment and payment will be made both for the removal of excavated material, including cleaning of surfaces, and for the additional concrete required. (4) Payment for the disposal/removal of excavated material will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule for loading, hauling and dumping of material and cleaning of the surface created by the geologically approved over break. (5) Payment for backfilling of voids created by an approved geological over break with concrete, shotcrete will be made as provided in respective sections. (6) No measurement for payment or payment will be made for voids outside the "B"-line which are not accepted by the Engineer-in-charge as being due to geological reasons. 3.14.3 Exclusions (1) Costs for Dewatering of underground sites and overcoming difficulties due to the ingress of water shall be covered as specified in the Section "Dewatering During Construction". 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 32
(2) Construction of drainage trenches proposed by the Contractor in the tunnel inverts is included in the measurement for underground excavation. No separate measurement for payment and payment will be made for it. (3) All costs for exploratory drillings will be covered by the applicable Unit Prices as specified in the Section "Drilling and Grouting". (4) All costs for supply and installation of rock supports will be covered by the applicable Unit Prices as specified in the Section "Rock Supports". (5) Rock supports required due to the Contractor's not adhering to approved drilling and blasting techniques will not be included for payment. (6) No extra payment will be made for the following: a) Over-excavation, removal of material or backfilling with concrete, shotcrete or grout beyond the "B"-line, except that due to an accepted geological overbreak. This applies also to any rectification work resulting from incorrect surveys and/or blasting, b) Additional work of removing material and backfilling voids with approved material where overbreak due to adverse geological conditions coincides with that due to Contractor's poor working methods or negligence, c) Over-excavation required for Contractor's convenience. The concrete and grout required to fill such excavation shall also be at the Contractor's expense, d) Overbreak in additional excavation required by the Engineer-in-Charge, e) Extra work or material required to repair damage to the tunnel invert caused by the construction equipment, f) Clearing and grubbing in the spoil and stockpile areas, g) Draining, shaping and trimming of the dumped material in spoil tips to the lines and grades as directed or approved by the Engineer-in-Charge.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 33
4 ROCK SUPPORTS 4.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) Works under this Section include all labour, materials, tests, equipment and services required to protect, stabilize or support rock faces, cuts, slopes and masses exposed in the course of surface and underground excavation works, as well as the anchoring of any concrete structures into surrounding or underlying rock. (2) This Section covers the following items: a) Rock bolt (Expansion shell), rock anchor, rock bolt (Grouted anchorage), water expandable friction anchors and grouted anchor bar b) Post-tensioned rock bolts (tendons) c) Mesh Reinforcement d) Steel supports (Ribs and Lattice Girders) e) Pre-grouting, Fore poling (Spiling) and Pipe roofing etc. (3) Shotcrete, grouting and drainage work, which may also be required for rock support purposes, are specified in other Sections. (4) Principal works required are as follows: a) Stabilizing of surface slopes and cuts: b) Rock supports in tunnels, shafts and caverns c) Anchorage of concrete structures. 4.2 GENERAL (1) The rock stabilizing and supporting measures to be undertaken during or after the excavation work for constructing the Works in a safe manner will be as determined or approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, based on the known or presumed behavior of the rock or ground. (2) In case of emergency or unforeseen exigency, the Contractor is authorized and obliged to undertake independently such supporting measures, as he deems necessary without prior consent of the Engineer-in-Charge. In such cases the Contractor shall inform the Engineer-in-Charge immediately. (3) The Engineer-in-Charge retains the right to order the Contractor to change the method or system of rock supports being used, if he considers that the Contractor's method of work is unsafe. (4) In underground works the installation of the rock supports shall follow closely the excavation heading and they shall be installed before the next round of excavation advance. The Contractor is responsible for the timely and proper installation of the rock supports and for checking and maintaining it until the final lining or structure is placed. (5) Rock stabilization measures required, as the permanent feature of the Works shall be installed as shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 34
(6) Nothing contained in this Section shall be construed to relieve the Contractor from sole responsibility either for the safety of the Works or for liability for injuries to, or death of persons or damage to property, or of any of his obligations under this Contract. (7) An adequate quantity of rock support materials and equipment, shall be stored by the Contractor at the construction sites and be kept ready for immediate use at any time during the whole construction period. (8) The quantities of all rock support items listed in the Schedule and the support systems shown on the Tender Drawings are only tentative. The actual measures to be taken shall be dictated by the rock conditions encountered. (9) Grouting of rock bolts of various types and rock anchors is an important and critical requirement. Contractor shall ensure grout pumps of appropriate type are available at site in sufficient number to achieve the grouting of bolts in a proper manner. (10) Since installations of bolts require considerable skill, the contractor shall get professional advice from such specialized agencies/experts who shall assist him to achieve the required quality in carrying out the installation. (11) Works of rock bolt (grouted anchorage), prestressed rock bolt (tendon), and pipe roofing shall be allowed to be executed only by an agency having both experience and technology for execution of these works. 4.3 SUBMITTALS (1) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, but before procuring or shipping the materials to the Site, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in- Charge the following: a) Full details of the type and quality of rock reinforcement which is proposed to used together with manufacturer's instructions and certificates, methods of installations and testing (including details of testing equipment). b) Complete details concerning type, and materials of the post-tensioned rock bolts (tendons), together with manufacturer's instructions and certifications, methods of installation, corrosion protection, stressing equipment, grouting method and equipment, proposal for suitability and stressing tests and equipment. c) Fabrication details of steel ribs, lagging and lattice girders. (2) Not later than 28 days prior to ordering any of the above materials, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval his proposed materials delivery schedule. Any amendments to the delivery schedule, proposed by the Contractor as the work proceeds, will also have to be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, and none of the above materials shall be called to the Site without Engineer-in-Charge's consent. (3) Contractor's shop drawings of steel supports and precast concrete lagging shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge not later than 42 days prior to their installation. (4) A detailed test program for all rock reinforcing elements shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for his approval before the start of the work. (5) The test certificate for the wires/strands for each lot of tendons shall be submitted by the Contractor as obtained from the supplier to the Engineer-in-Charge for the approval prior to shipment. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 35
(6) The Contractor shall record the results of all tests performed on the rock bolts and post-tensioned rock bolts (tendons) prior, during and after their installation, register the readings taken at the load cells installed and submit these documents to the Engineer- in-Charge. 4.4 ROCK BOLT (EXPANSION SHELL), ROCK ANCHOR, ROCK BOLT (GROUTED ANCHORAGE), WATER EXPANDABLE FRICTION ANCHORS, GROUTED ANCHOR BAR/DOWEL 4.4.1 Rock Bolt (Expansion Shell) (1) Rock bolt (Expansion Shell) is a stressed (i.e. post-tensioned) reinforcing element consisting of a rod, an expansion shell anchorage, a plate and a nut for stressing by tightening the nut. (2) Expansion shell rock bolts shall be of 25 mm , 32 mm or 36 mm dia. and shall be of various lengths as specified in Schedule (for longer lengths, couplers may be required). (3) The Rock bolts shall be manufactured from reinforcing bar with Yield strength not less than 500 N/mm 2 (The reinforcing bar shall comply with IS 1786). When coupler is used, the threading in the bar shall not reduce the effective diameter of bar. Coupler itself should be able to transfer at least 125 % of the yield load of the bar. (4) Rock bolts shall be furnished complete with all accessories and other materials necessary for their installation, fixing, stressing and grouting. Expansion shell shall be manufactured by a reputed agency only. (5) Bearing plates shall be flat steel plates of following minimum dimensions: 36mm dia. rock bolt 1 no. plate of 200x200x16mm 32mm dia. rock bolt 1 no. plate of 200x200x12mm 25mm dia. rock bolt 1 no. plate of 150x150x10 mm The plate shall conform to IS 2062 for Structural Steel. The nuts shall be heavy hexagonal type. Additional plate of size 150 x 150 x 10 mm shall be used for fixing of mesh reinforcement. (6) The threads on the projecting ends of bolts shall be protected and lubricated with rust preventive compound. (7) Expansion shell rock bolts shall generally be tensioned at the following maximum values 36 mm dia. rock bolt 30 t 32 mm dia. rock bolt 24 t 25 mm dia. rock bolt 15 t (8) Approximate diameter of hole drilled for installation of rock bolt shall be as under or as recommended by the manufacturer of the shell 36 mm dia. rock bolt 76 mm dia. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 36
32 mm dia. rock bolt 64 mm dia. 25 mm dia. rock bolt 45 mm dia. (9) Spacers (centralizer) shall be used for 32 mm dia. and 36 mm dia. rock bolts for length greater than 4 m for equal grout annulus all around the bolt. (10) The length of drill hole shall be such as to receive the specified rock bolt and to provide for its satisfactory anchorage, and sufficient protrusion of the threaded portion out of hole to fix plate, nut, and coupling for any kind of extension piece. (11) After drilling each hole in sound rock, the drill hole shall be washed with clean water and cleaned by blowing out all drill cuttings and debris with compressed air. The holes in rock, which tends to swell or is interspersed with clay filled fissures, shall be cleaned with compressed air only. The compressed air shall not contain oil or any other material which could prevent the bond between rock and grout. (12) Prior to installing the rock bolt, which will be stressed, the rock surface around the hole shall be prepared for the bearing plate. When the surface is not perpendicular to the hole axis, beveled washer shall be placed between the bearing plate and the nut, or dished bearing plate and hemispherical washer used, to ensure uniform bearing. (13) The method and equipment used for installation, to effectively seat, and to stress the expansion-shell rock bolts shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions and subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. (14) The rock bolts shall be stressed, immediately after installation in the hole, by torquing or jacking, by means of an approved and regularly calibrated stressing device, to an extent specified by the manufacturer or directed by the Engineer-in-Charge on the basis of values established during pullout tests. (15) After initial installation, the Contractor shall ensure that the rock bolts continue to act as effective supports by periodically testing the rock bolts and, if necessary, re -tightening to the directed torque or tension, till grouted. (16) Grouting of the expansion-shell rock bolts shall be performed without destressing the bolt. Grouting shall be performed as soon as practicable after, but in any case not later than 7 days, of rock bolt installation. The bearing plate shall be caulked around its perimeter and grout shall be introduced into the hole through a plastic tube fixed to the shaft and extended to outside through a hole provided in the bearing plate, at a pressure sufficient to fill completely the space around each bolt for the full length without any air-pockets remaining inside the hole. A grout return tube through another hole in the plate shall be provided to ensure full column grouting. (17) Grout mix used shall have a water cement ratio of not more than of 0.4. The grout mix shall contain an expanding plasticizer admixture (allowing upto 3.5% expansion in neat cement), from a reputed manufacturer which has a long past proven record of use for such applications. The dosage of admixture shall be as per the manufacturers recommendation. For additional workability, a compatible superplasticizer may also be required. The grout mix shall have strength of 35 N/mm at 28 days. (18) Cracks and fissures adjacent to the rock bolt which the grout is found to be flowing from, during the grouting operation, shall be plugged or caulked at the excavation surfaces. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 37
(19) Prior to the installation of rock bolts in the Works, a series of pull-out tests shall be carried out in different rock types designated by the Engineer-in-Charge and which will be representative of the rock expected to be encountered during the excavation. During the pull-out test both, the load applied and movement undergone shall be measured. At least 5 tests shall be required for each combination of the type of the rock bolts/installation condition to be able to assess the suitability of expansion shells. The pull-out tests shall be carried out sufficiently in advance of the installation of the rock bolts in the Works. The Contractor shall maintain detailed records of the pull-out tests, the results of which will be used to establish relation between rock quality and type of expansion shell and tensioning. (20) During progress of the Works the Contractor shall, in general, perform pull-out tests, in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge on at least 2 per 100 Rock bolts installed. In case of failure, additional testing shall be performed on selected rock bolts installed in the vicinity of the failed one and the rock bolts shall be replaced free of cost as directed by Engineer-in -Charge. If large scale failure is reported, the effectiveness of whole lot of bolts installed shall be decided by Engineer-in-Charge. (21) As a part of monitoring program during the progress of the work, and when directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, rock bolts shall be fitted with load cells. The Contractor shall measure the deformation undergone and record the loads registered on each load cell installed twice a month and submit the results to the Engineer-in-Charge within 48 hours of taking such readings. Such load cells shall be installed on the ungrouted rock bolts only. 4.4.2 Rock Anchor (1) Rock Anchor is an untensioned reinforcing element consisting of a rod embedded in a cement grout filled hole. The rock anchor shall have a plate and a nut. (2) The rock anchors will either be stressed nominally or not be stressed. The rods shall be fully grouted with cement grout. (3) Rock anchors shall be of 25 mm, 32 mm or 36 mm dia. and shall be of various lengths as specified in Schedule (for longer lengths, couplers may be required). (4) The Rock anchors shall be manufactured from reinforcing bar with Yield strength not less than 500 N/mm 2 . (The reinforcing bar shall comply with IS 1786.) When coupler is used, the threading in the bar shall not reduce the effective diameter of bar. Coupler itself should be able to transfer at least 125 % of the yield load of the bar. (5) Rock anchors shall be furnished complete with all accessories and other materials necessary for their installation, fixing and grouting. (6) Bearing plates shall be flat or dished steel plates of following minimum dimensions: 36mm dia. rock anchor 1 no. plate of 200x200x16mm 32mm dia. rock anchor 1 no. plate of 200x200x12mm 25mm dia. rock anchor 1 no. plate of 150x150x10 mm The plate shall conform to IS 2062 for Structural Steel. The nuts shall be heavy hexagonal type. Additional plate of size 150 x 150 x 10 mm shall be used for fixing of mesh reinforcement. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 38
(7) The threads on the projecting ends of anchors shall be protected and lubricated with rust preventive compound. (8) The surface of the rock anchors shall be clean of rust, scale, dirt or other foreign matter. (9) Diameter of hole drilled for installation of rock anchor shall be as under 36 mm dia. rock anchor 76 mm dia. 32 mm dia. rock anchor 64 mm dia. 25 mm dia. rock anchor 45 mm dia. (10) Spacers (centralizer) shall be used for both 25 mm, 32 mm and 36 mm dia. rock anchors longer than 4 m for equal grout annulus all around the bolt. (11) The length of drill hole shall be such as to receive the specified rock anchor and to provide for its satisfactory anchorage, and sufficient provision of the threaded portion out of hole to fix plate, nut, and coupling for any kind of extension piece. The holes shall extend 150 to 200 mm beyond the length of the rock anchor. (12) After drilling each hole in sound rock, the drill hole shall be washed with clean water and cleaned by blowing out all drill cuttings and debris with compressed air. The holes in rock, which tends to swell or is interspersed with clay filled fissures, shall be cleaned with compressed air only. The compressed air shall not contain oil or any other material which could prevent the bond between rock and grout. (13) Prior to installing the rock anchor, the rock surface around the hole shall be prepared for the bearing plate. When the surface is not perpendicular to the hole axis, beveled washer shall be placed between the bearing plate and the nut, or dished bearing plate and hemispherical washer used, to ensure uniform bearing. (14) Both for overhead application and horizontal (slightly downward) application, the grout shall be introduced into the end of the hole through a pipe. The pipe will be gradually withdrawn as the hole is filled. (15) Grout shall have a water to cement ratio of 0.25-0.28. An admixture containing an efficient water reducing agent, a shrinkage compensating component and thixotropizing agent shall be used. The grout mix shall have strength development of min 25 MPa at 24 hours. Doses of the admixture shall be as per the manufacturers recommendation to achieve the required properties. (16) The anchor bar shall be forced into the grout-filled hole before the initial set of the grout and good contact between steel surface and grout ensured. (17) Anchors bars shall be protected after installations in such a manner as to prevent any movement until the grout has hardened. The Contractor shall replace any bars found to be loose after the grout has set. (18) During progress of the Works the Contractor shall, in general, perform pull-out tests, in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge on at least 2 per 100 Rock anchors installed. In case of failure, additional testing shall be performed on selected rock anchors installed in the vicinity of the failed one and the rock anchors shall be replaced free of cost as directed by Engineer-in-Charge. If large scale failure is reported, the effectiveness of whole lot of bolts installed shall be decided by Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 39
4.4.3 Rock Bolt (Grouted Anchorage) (1) ROCK BOLT (GROUTED ANCHORAGE) is a stressed (i.e. post-tensioned) reinforcing element consisting of a rod, a grouted anchorage in the form of fixed length, a plate and a nut for stressing by tightening the nut. (2) Grouted anchorage rock bolts shall be of 32 mm or 36 mm dia. and shall be of various lengths as specified in Schedule. (3) The Rock bolts shall be manufactured from reinforcing bar with Yield strength not less than 500 N/mm 2 . (The reinforcing bar shall comply with IS 1786.) Couplers may be required for the bolts. When coupler is used, the threading in the bar shall not reduce the effective diameter of bar. Coupler itself should be able to transfer at least 125 % of the yield load of the bar. (4) Rock bolts shall be furnished complete with all accessories and other materials necessary for their installation, fixing, stressing and grouting. (5) Bearing plates shall be flat steel plates of following minimum dimensions: 36mm dia. rock bolt 1 no. plate of 200x200x16mm 32mm dia. rock bolt 1 no. plate of 200x200x12mm The plate shall conform to IS 2062 for Structural Steel. The nuts shall be heavy hexagonal type. Additional plate of size 150 x 150 x 10 mm shall be used for fixing of mesh reinforcement. (6) The threads on the projecting ends of bolts shall be protected and lubricated with rust preventive compound. (7) Rock bolts (Rock anchorage) shall generally be tensioned at the following maximum values 36 mm dia. rock bolt 30 t 32 mm dia. rock bolt 24 t (8) Diameter of hole drilled for installation of rock bolt shall be as under 36 mm dia. rock bolt 76 mm dia. 32 mm dia. rock bolt 64 mm dia (9) Spacers shall be required for equal grout annulus all around the bolt. (10) The length of drill hole shall be such as to receive the specified rock bolt and to provide for its satisfactory anchorage, and sufficient provision of the threaded portion out of hole to fix plate, nut, and coupling for any kind of extension piece. The holes shall extend 150 to 200 mm beyond the length of the rock bolt or anchor. (11) After drilling each hole in sound rock, the drill hole shall be washed with clean water and cleaned by blowing out all drill cuttings and debris with compressed air. The holes in rock, which tends to swell or is interspersed with clay filled fissures, shall be cleaned with compressed air only. The compressed air shall not contain oil or any other material, which could prevent the bond between rock and grout. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 40
(12) Grouting of the drilled hole is done to provide permanent bonding in the fixed length of the rock bolt and also to provide corrosion protection in the free length portion. (13) Grout shall have a water to cement ratio of 0.25-0.28. An admixture containing an efficient water reducing agent, a shrinkage compensating component and thixotropizing agent shall be used. The grout mix shall have strength development of min 25 MPa at 24 hours. Doses of the admixture shall be as per the manufacturers recommendation to achieve the required properties. (14) The rock bolts shall be stressed, within 36 hours of completion of grouting operation, by jacking, by means of an approved and regularly calibrated stressing device, to an extent specified. (15) Prior to the installation of rock bolts in the Works, a series of pull-out tests shall be carried out, to optimize the fixed length. During the pull-out test for 32 mm dia rock bolt, the load applied shall be 35t and for 36 mm dia rock bolt, the load applied shall be 42 t. (16) During progress of the Works the Contractor shall, in general, perform pull-out tests, in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge on at least 2 per 100 Rock bolts installed. In case of failure, additional testing shall be performed on selected rock bolts installed in the vicinity of the failed one. If large scale failure is reported, the effectiveness of whole lot of bolts installed shall be decided by Engineer-in-Charge. (17) As a part of monitoring program during the progress of the work, and when directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, rock bolts shall be fitted with load cells. Approved load cells which allow to measure the increase or decrease in load in the bolt to an accuracy of 2% shall be supplied by the Contractor, who shall measure the deformation undergone and record the loads registered on each load cell installed twice a month and submit the results to the Engineer-in-Charge within 48 hours of taking such readings. 4.4.4 Water expandable friction anchors (1) Water expandable friction anchors shall be of a reputed make. These shall be of lengths varying between 3m 6 m and installed as a temporary support at the locations determined by Engineer in charge in the underground excavations. These anchors shall be used generally at places where in the opinion of the Engineer in charge, the strata is such that an immediate temporary support is required and it is not possible to provide other types of rock support within a reasonable time. (2) The anchor consists of a 41 mm diameter, steel tube of 2 mm thickness which is folded during manufacturing to create a 25-28 mm diameter unit to be inserted in a hole of 32- 39 mm diameter. The anchors shall be provided with a dome-shaped face plate, as per the manufacturers recommendations. The material of steel tube shall confirm to EN 10025-S355J R or equivalent. (3) The anchor shall have a minimum breaking load of 100 KN and a minimum elongation of 15%. The anchor shall be activated by injection of high water pressure at 30 MPa which inflates the folded tube into intimate contact with the wall of borehole. (4) Water expandable friction anchors shall be supplied, installed and tested as per recommended procedure of the manufacturer. Additional testing, if required, shall be carried out as determined by Engineer in charge depending on site conditions. 4.4.5 Grouted Anchor Bar / Dowel (1) GROUTED ANCHOR BAR is a reinforcing element consisting of a reinforcing bar embedded in a cement grout filled hole. It shall extend into structural concrete to provide anchorage of concrete structures. (2) The grouted anchor bars will not be stressed. The rods shall be fully grouted with cement grout. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 41
(3) Grouted anchor bars shall be of 25 mm , 32 mm or 36 mm dia. and shall be of various lengths as specified in Schedule (for longer lengths, couplers may be required). (4) The Grouted anchor bars shall be manufactured from reinforcing bar with Yield strength not less than 500 N/mm 2 . (The reinforcing bar shall comply with IS 1786.) When coupler is used, the threading in the bar shall not reduce the effective diameter of bar. Coupler itself should be able to transfer at least 125 % of the yield load of the bar. (5) Grouted anchor bars shall be furnished complete with all accessories and other materials necessary for their installation, fixing and grouting. (6) The surface of the grouted anchor bars shall be clean of rust, scale, dirt or other foreign matter. (7) Diameter of hole drilled for installation of grouted anchor bar shall be as under 36 mm dia. grouted anchor bar 76 mm dia. 32 mm dia. grouted anchor bar 64 mm dia. 25 mm dia. grouted anchor bar 45 mm dia. (8) Spacers (centralizer) shall be used for both 25 mm, 32 mm and 36 mm dia. grouted anchor bars longer than 4 m for equal annulus of grout all around the anchor. (9) After drilling each hole in sound rock, the drill hole shall be washed with clean water and cleaned by blowing out all drill cuttings and debris with compressed air. The holes in rock, which tends to swell or is interspersed with clay filled fissures, shall be cleaned with compressed air only. The compressed air shall not contain oil or any other material, which could prevent the bond between the rock and grout. (10) The grout shall be introduced into the end of the hole through a pipe. The pipe will be gradually withdrawn as the hole is filled. (11) Grout mix used shall have a water cement ratio of not more than of 0.32. The grout mix shall contain an expanding plasticizer admixture (allowing upto 3.5% expansion in neat cement), from a reputed manufacturer which has a long past proven record of use for such applications. The dosage of admixture shall be as per the manufacturers recommendation. For additional workability, a compatible superplasticizer may also be required. The grout mix shall have a strength of 35 N/mm at 28 days. (12) The anchor bar shall be forced into the grout-filled hole before the initial set of the grout and good contact between steel surface and grout ensured. (13) Bar ends to be embedded in the concrete structure shall be provided with hooks welded to the bar to provide a good anchorage. In order to facilitate the inserting of the bars into the holes, the hooks can be welded to the anchor bar after installing. The welding and the overlap of the bar end with the hook(s) shall be as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (14) Anchors bars shall be protected after installations in such a manner as to prevent any movement until the grout has hardened. The Contractor shall replace any bars found to be loose after the grout has set. (15) The depth of holes indicated on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge shall be measured from the effective excavation surface. Should the anchor bars be connected to the reinforcement steel of the concrete structure to be anchored, longer bars shall be provided in case of over excavation, to maintain the required position in the structure. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 42
4.4.6 Rock Bolt / Rock Anchor Extensions into Concrete (1) Threaded portion of Rock Bolts and Rock Anchor, where required to be extended into structural concrete, shall be protected during excavation and shotcreting operations and shall protrude sufficiently beyond the shotcrete. The extension shall consist of an L-shaped reinforcing bar of similar size (as that of the bolt/anchor) and shall be welded to the bolt. The welding and the overlap of the bolt with extension piece shall be as approved by Engineer-in-Charge. 4.5 POST-TENSIONED ROCK BOLTS (TENDONS) 4.5.1 General (1) Post-tensioned rock bolts (tendons) are tensioned reinforcing elements of higher capacity than the other reinforcing elements, consisting of high strength steel tendon fitted with a stressing anchorage (fixed length) at the inner end, a means permitting force to be transferred, and a head on the rock surface at the outer end. (2) The Contractor shall furnish and install post-tensioned rock bolts of 1,200 kN ultimate strength and 700 kN working load in area and to the extent shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The work shall be executed in stages, in step with the progress of the excavation, or after the excavation has proceeded downwards. (3) Installation of post-tensioned rock bolts includes excavation for concrete bases, placing of concrete bases, drilling and testing of holes, furnishing of rock bolts with all accessories, load cells, permanent corrosion protection of all elements of the rock bolt, primary grouting, stressing, testing, re-stressing, secondary grouting and finishing, and all other auxiliary and supporting works. (4) The entire work of drilling, grouting, fabrication, installation and testing of Post tension rock bolts (tendons) shall be carried out by a specialist agency having experience, equipment and technology for execution of these works and under strict quality control. 4.5.2 Definitions The following terms are used in the text to conform to the international standards: Lock-off load is the load transferred to the head immediately after lock-off, before long-term losses start to occur. Proof Load is the maximum test load to which a rock bolt is subjected. Datum load is the level of load from which the rock bolt head displacement is measured during a stress test. In general, a value of 10% test load is adopted. Suitability test is a load test to confirm that a particular rock bolt design will be adequate in particular ground conditions. Acceptance test is the load test to confirm that the rock bolt conforms to the acceptance criteria. Each working rock bolt will undergo the Acceptance Test. 4.5.3 Suitability Tests (1) The rock bolts for Suitability Tests (or test rock bolts) will be executed in accordance with the requirements of the relevant Indian Standards and where not covered by these standards to the applicable International Standards or as directed by the Engineer-in- Charge in order to find out suitable procedure for drill hole - rock treatment prior to rock bolt installation and to determine the following: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 43
a) To ascertain external rock bolt resistance in the actual ground conditions, in particular bond between grout and rock b) To derive the optimum bond length and verify the adequacy of the fixed length of rock bolts as specified in the relevant Drawings in relation to their working capacities, ground conditions and locations so as to ensure a minimum factor of safety equal or bigger than that of the tendons, as specified by the manufacturer c) To check the adequacy of the foreseen working procedures (drilling, consolidation grouting and rock reinforcing work) and design details of working rock bolts d) To determine the apparent tendon free length e) To establish acceptance criteria including creep criteria for testing of working rock bolts (2) Test rock bolts shall be installed and tested in some typical ground conditions expected in excavation prior to commencement of any installations of the permanent rock bolts. The Suitability Test rock bolts shall be used only for testing and not as a part of the permanent rock bolting system. (3) An accurate drilling and grouting record shall be kept for each test to allow a comparison of the test rock bolts with the permanent rock bolts (which have not undergone any tests). If too large deviations occur during the installation of rock bolts, the Engineer-in-Charge may order a new series of tests to be performed in different conditions. (4) The number of test rock bolts shall correspond to 2% of total rock bolts to be installed, but a minimum of 6 extra pieces shall be carried out. (5) The measuring equipment shall be able to measure displacement of 0.01 mm when creep is being measured. (6) The measurement of loads in rock bolts shall be by load measuring device able to measure to an accuracy of better than 2% of the maximum applied load during each test. Any load measuring device used for load loss tests shall be able to measure loads to 0.5 % of the maximum applied load. (7) All Suitability Tests shall be carried out in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge. 4.5.4 Drilling of Holes (1) Holes shall be drilled as specified herein and in accordance with applicable provisions of the Section "Drilling and Grouting" at the locations and to the depths and inclination shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The drilling method shall be suited to the type of ground and the necessary drill hole diameter. (2) Diameter of the holes shall be 125 mm minimum. Depth of the hole shall exceed the total rock bolt length (including the fixed length) by 500 mm or by such additional amount as required in case drill cuttings cannot be removed from the bottom of the hole. (3) Holes shall be either drilled by rotary method with water flush or pneumatic percussion method with air and/or water flush or any other type such that the disturbances to the adjoining rock is minimal. Use of bentonite, rod grease or other lubricants on drill rods will not be permitted. (4) Drilling of the holes shall conform to the least of the following tolerances: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 44
a. Initial alignment when setting up the drilling rig shall not deviate by more than 2 from the specified axis of the drill hole b. Deviation of the hole during drilling shall be limited to 1/30 of the overall hole length. (5) The sequence of drilling of holes shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before starting the work. (6) During the drilling operations, all changes in rock type should be recorded together with notes on drilling rates, flushing losses or gains, and stoppages. (7) After completion of the drilling in rock the entire length of the hole shall be washed out with clean water, as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (8) Upon completion, the drill hole shall be tightly plugged in suitable manner to prevent contamination by foreign matter. The hole shall be washed clean prior to inserting the rock bolt. In loose material the walls of the drill hole shall be supported by casing until the rock bolt has been installed. In earth or rock liable to swell the rock bolt shall be installed and grouted immediately. (9) Any hole that becomes clogged or otherwise obstructed before the completion of rock bolting operation shall be cleaned or redrilled. If not possible another hole shall be provided by the Contractor. 4.5.5 Materials 1) The tendon shall be composed of uncoated stress relieved low relaxation 7-ply strands conforming to IS 14268. Wires/strands, which do not conform to IS 14268 will be rejected by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The wires/strands shall be continuous without splices or couplers and shall be free of dirt, oil, rust and without mechanical damage. Strands shall be delivered in coils of suitable diameter to prevent kink, properly protected against abrasion and corrosion by a factory applied method. 3) The head assembly shall allow the tendon to be stressed, test loaded and locked-off, and, if required, restressed. It shall distribute the tendon load to the main structure in accordance with the overall design of the structure through designed or tested components. The structural failure load of the head shall not be less than the sum of the ultimate load of the tendon. The stressing mechanism shall be such that the measurement of the loads and deformations is guaranteed during stressing tests. 4) Construction of the rock bolt shall be such as to ensure the extent of the tendon bond length to be exact as required, independent of quantity of primary grout injected or pumped into the hole, and shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before the work is started. 5) The tendons shall be shop fabricated and shall be free from dirt, dust or any other deleterious material. The parts such as spreade, rings, sheaths, wire caps, clamping rings, anchor base plates, heads, etc., shall be either shop fabricated or field fabricated in accordance with the approved method. 6) Sheathing material shall be durable, rust and corrosion proof, flexible and watertight. Grout tube shall be made of PVC and re-injection tube shall be perforated at regular intervals with holes covered with rubber sleeves. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 45
4.5.6 Corrosion Protection 1) Corrosion protection of fixed length of tendons shall be as below: a) Corrugated HDPE (1.25 mm thick or more) with end caps is used in fixed length for corrosion protection. b) The fixed length shall be treated with epoxy formulation as follows: i) The high tensile steel wires or strands are first pre-treated by sand blasting or grit blasting process. Thereafter, the wires/strands are cleaned thoroughly by using the thinner. ii) The first coat of epoxy formulation is applied uniformly on the wires/strands and it is allowed to dry for a period of 2 to 3 hours. The second coat is applied thereafter and the same is allowed to dry for 24 hours. This is then roughened by sand paper and the third coat is then applied uniformly. While the third coat is still tacky, quartz sand is sprinkled over it to increase the bond. 2) Corrosion protection of free length of rock bolts shall be as follows : a) Tendon comprising of several high tensile wires/strands enclosed in a suitable diameter (as per manufacturers recommendation) polyethylene (PE) pipe at least 2 mm thick; the diameter of the PE pipe shall be greater than the enclosed wires/strands b) The annular space between the PE pipe and the hole shall be filled with neat cement grout c) The strands shall be coated with grease and HDPE. d) The space between the HDPE coated strands and the PE pipe shall be filled with neat cement grout. 3) Properties and quality of the epoxy formulation to be used for treatment of free and fixed lengths of the anchors shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before its use. 4) The following shall be adopted for protecting the head against corrosion: a) The bearing plate of all the rock bolts, which would be stressed according to procedure described under the heading "Stressing of Rock Bolts and Acceptance Tests" shall be painted with a primer paint. This material conforming to the relevant Indian Standards shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. b) Corrosion protection of the heads of rock bolts which have been accepted shall be protected as follows: i) Minimum 3 mm thick steel/PVC cap containing upper vent pipe and a lower injection pipe shall be provided to protect the head, ii) The size of the cap shall be such that it shall have a minimum clearance of 50 mm from the head mechanism, iii) The steel/PVC cap shall be bolted to the bearing plate after providing suitable gasket, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 46
iv) After the steel/PVC cap has been bolted to the bearing plate, the cement grout shall be filled in through lower injection pipe to fill completely the inner side with cement grout; cement grout shall be the same mix as used for grouting the fixed and free anchor length, v) Suitable caps approved by the Engineer-in-Charge for both the injection pipe and vent pipe shall be provided, vi) Two coats of suitable anti-corrosion paint, approved by the Engineer-in-Charge shall be applied to all exposed steel after the steel cap has been bolted to the bearing plate. 4.5.7 Installation and Rock Bolt Grouting (1) A reinforced concrete pad shall be constructed on the prepared excavated ground in accordance with provision of the Section "Concrete". Concrete shall be of Class M30/A20. No stressing of the rock bolt may be performed until the cube compressible strength of the base concrete has reached 20N/mm 2 . Such admixtures shall be added in concrete, which allow the required strength to be developed within 72 hours. (2) The tendon shall be slowly inserted into the hole in such a manner as to prevent damage and tangling of the individual wires/strands. At the bottom of tendon sleeve or nose cone shall be used to minimize the risk of tendon or borehole damage during homing. Special care shall be taken to ensure that existing corrosion protection (epoxy coating) remains undamaged during insertion into the hole. (3) After being inserted, the rock bolt shall be fixed in position so that no displacement can occur during the grouting work. The tendon shall be centered in the hole by spacers so that adequate covering with the grouting material is ensured as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) Immediately following installation of the rock bolt into the hole, the primary grouting of the anchorage zone and outside of sheathing shall be carried out. The grouting equipment must permit grout pressure up to 20 bars. (5) Grout shall have a water to cement ratio of 0.25-0.28. An admixture containing an efficient water reducing agent, a shrinkage compensating component and thixotropizing agent shall be used. The grout mix shall have strength development of min 25 MPa at 24 hours. Doses of the admixture shall be as per the manufacturers recommendation to achieve the required properties. (6) Proper grout pipes shall be used to ensure grouting from bottom to top and achieve complete filling with neat cement grout. This requirement applies to all rock bolt grouting operations including end cap filling. (7) As soon as possible, after stressing or re-stressing have been completed and rock bolt has been accepted by the Engineer-in-Charge, the secondary grouting inside and outside of the sheathing shall be performed to encase completely the strands/wires for the full length of the hole and to fill all voids. (8) The recess left in the concrete pad for accommodating the head shall be filled with concrete if not otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4.5.8 Stressing of Rock Bolts and Acceptance Tests (1) Stressing of the rock bolts shall be performed only when the grout has achieved a minimum cube strength of 30 N/mm 2 and only after the end anchorage/fixed length 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 47
has acquired the required strength. The time between grouting of anchorage zone or concreting the pad, and stressing shall generally be 3 days. (2) The stressing shall follow a program submitted by the Contractor which shall include the sequence in which the rock bolts are to be stressed up to the test loads, the lock-off loads (Lock-off load = Design or Working load + Allowance of 10% for long term losses), any eventual stressing modifications to be made subsequently and tests to be carried out, and shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) All rock bolts shall be checked by means of an Acceptance Test (or simple stressing test) and at least 5% of the total number of rock bolts installed shall undergo the comprehensive stressing tests. (4) During the Acceptance Test, behaviour of the rock bolt at the test load and the deformation shall be observed for a period of time in accordance with procedures established by the Suitability Tests. After reaching the test load the rock bolt shall be detensioned to zero or datum load (i.e. about 10% of test load) and thereafter stressed to lock-off load and further by the amount necessary to compensate for seating loss. Seating losses shall be restricted to 6 mm. (5) During the comprehensive stressing test, the rock bolt shall be tensioned in steps. Behaviour of the rock bolts shall be observed during the intermediate steps, the unloading periods and at the test load. The load shall be maintained at each step for a period of time in accordance with procedures established by the Suitability Tests. The load/deformation curve shall be recorded for loading and unloading. After reaching the test load, the rock bolt shall be detensioned to zero or datum load (i.e. about 10% of test load). Thereafter, the rock bolt shall be restressed to lock-off load and stressed further by the amount necessary to compensate for seating loss. Seating losses shall be restricted to 6 mm. (6) The Contractor shall record and compare, jointly with the Engineer-in-Charge, with the acceptance criteria all the important conditions and observations during the stressing procedure, the loads applied and the elongation of the tendon with each load increment. The values measured during the simple and comprehensive stressing tests shall be plotted and all records and graphs submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge. (7) The test load to which rock bolts shall be subjected during various tests shall be 80% of the guaranteed ultimate tensile strength (GUTS) of the tendon, if not otherwise specified by the Engineer-in-Charge. Lock-off load shall be 60% of GUTS of the tendon, if not otherwise specified by the Engineer-in-Charge. (8) Stressing shall be made by applying a single jack to all strands/wires. J ack shall be actuated by a hydraulic pack. In all stressing operations all wires/strands of a tendon shall be stressed simultaneously. (9) The measuring equipment shall be able to measure displacement of 0.01 mm when creep is being measured. (10) The measurement of loads in rock bolts shall be by load measuring device able to measure to an accuracy of better than 2% of the maximum applied load during each test. Any load measuring device used for load loss tests shall be able to measure loads to 0.5 % of the maximum applied load. (11) All Acceptance Tests shall be carried out in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge. Rock bolts which do not fulfill the acceptance criteria will be rejected by the Engineer- in-Charge and replaced by the Contractor. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 48
(12) After the rock bolt has been tensioned, the stressing shall not be relaxed for any purpose, unless directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4.5.9 Monitoring (1) All rock bolts which have been stressed according to the Acceptance Test (simple stressing test) shall be load checked by lift-off test immediately after stressing and again 3-5 days later. Rock bolt shall be accepted only if the residual rock bolt load is more than 98% of the lock-off load, if the loss is more the rock bolt will be restressed and an additional load check shall be performed again after 3-5 days. (2) All rock bolts which will be tested according to the comprehensive stressing test shall be short term monitored during the time of installation of the working rock bolts by means of measuring the residual load with a load cell so as to ensure that the residual rock bolt load is more than 98% of the lock-off load. If the loss is more, the rock bolt shall be re-stressed as described. The measuring Intervals shall be as follows: First week after stressing Daily Up to 3 weeks after stressing Each 3 rd day Up to 6 weeks after stressing Weekly After 6 weeks to six months Each 2 nd week or till the rock bolt is accepted by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) Acceptance shall be subject to the condition that the loss in stress is less than 2% of the lock-off load. 4.6 MESH REINFORCEMENT 4.6.1 Welded wire Mesh (1) Wire mesh shall consist of welded wires in a fabric. Wire mesh shall be installed in surface and underground excavation as reinforcement for shotcrete usually in combination with rock reinforcement. It may also be used with steel ribs, when it shall be laid over the outer flange of the rib and pinned or fixed to the excavated surface between the ribs where necessary. (2) Wire mesh shall conform to the requirements of IS 4948 (Welded Steel Wire Fabric for general use). The wire mesh shall have a square mesh of 100x100 mm spacing made of mild steel wires having yield strength not less than 275N/mm 2 . The diameter of the wires shall be between 3 and 5 mm. (3) Where possible, the wire mesh shall be placed at the same time as the rock reinforcement is installed. It shall not be placed between the rock surface and bearing plates, but shall be placed over the heads of rock reinforcement, and fastened to them by separate plates and nuts. It shall be ensured that the fabric is drawn close to the excavated surface so that when shotcrete is applied subsequently, the mesh neither sag nor vibrate excessively and impair the effectiveness of the shotcrete. (4) Welded wire mesh shall be fixed to rock with suitable mesh anchor (in addition to rock reinforcement near by, if any) of minimum 5 KN capacity at minimum spacing of 1m x 1 m. Usage of wooden pegs for fastening of the wire mesh to the rock surface will not be permitted. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 49
(5) Wire mesh shall be firmly stretched between mesh anchors and drawn close to the excavated surface (6) Overlap of wire mesh shall be at least 3 times the mesh spacing with the clearance between parallel bars but not less than 300 mm. 4.7 STEEL SUPPORTS 4.7.1 General (1) The Contractor shall install the steel supports consisting of lattice girder and / or steel ribs in underground excavation to the shape as shown on the Drawings. (2) Steel supports shall be installed in conjunction with rock reinforcement and shotcrete as immediate support after excavation. (3) Steel supports shall be furnished complete with bracing, bolts, nuts, washers, plates, tie rods, and other accessories necessary for installation of the supports. 4.7.2 Lattice girders Lattice girders shall be installed where shown on the drawings Lattice girders shall consist of 3 no., 25 mm or greater dia reinforcing bars forming an equilateral triangle (or square) of 150 mm or greater depth, laced together by 12 mm dia reinforcing bars. The lattice girders shall be installed in similar manner as steel ribs. The accessories of lattice girders, like plates, bolts, nuts washers welding electrodes etc shall be similar to that of the steel ribs. Lattice girders shall be fully encased in shotcrete. 4.7.3 Steel Ribs (1) All steel section and plates used for ribs and accessories shall conform to IS 2062. "Structural Steel" (Standard Quality). (2) Steel for bolts, nuts and washers shall conform to IS 8500. "Specification for High Tensile Strength Structural Steel". (3) Material used in splices shall conform to the specification of the material being spliced. (4) All steel and fabrication thereof shall conform to the requirements of IS 800 "Code of Practice for use of structural steel in General Building Construction". (5) All welding, welding electrodes and workmanship shall conform to IS 814 and IS 816. (6) Latest revisions of the IS Codes where referred shall be applicable for this Contract. 4.7.4 Lagging (1) Steel lagging shall be used only with the prior approval of Engineer-in-charge. (2) Lagging with backfilling are the longitudinal supporting members placed behind the steel ribs, where necessary, to support the walls and crown of the excavation. (3) Two different types of steel lagging is envisioned: a) 2 to 3 mm thick to be used behind the steel ribs in profiles already excavated 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 50
b) 4 to 5 mm thick when they are to be pressed or hammered ahead of the heading face for protection (4) Precast reinforced concrete panels of 7.5 cm thickness may be used as lagging instead of the steel profiles. Type of lagging used must be approved by the Engineer- in-Charge before the Contractor starts with the manufacture thereof. Concrete grade used shall be M20/A20 and reinforcement at the rate of 60 Kg/m minimum shall be provided. 4.8 ADDITIONAL SUPPORT MEASURES IN POOR REACHES OF UNDERGROUND EXCAVATIONS In general all poor reaches shall be a supported by regular supporting measures (rock reinforcement, shotcrete, lattice girders, steel ribs, etc). However, certain ground conditions may require additional support measures as well. For such situations the additional support measures as described below shall be implemented at site as per directions of Engineer-in- Charge. 4.8.1 Pre-grouting and fore poling (Spiling) Poor ground condition in underground excavation may require, ahead of face stabilization/ support using pre-grouting and / or forepoling. Pre-grouting shall consist of drilling of 45 60 mm dia. holes (up to 10 m long) at an inclination of 5 to 10 degrees outgoing along the periphery at an approximate spacing of 1.5 m. These holes shall be grouted using a neat cement grout mix with w/c ratio varying from 0.8 to 0.4, bentonite shall be added as necessary and as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Fore poling (Spiling) shall consist of installing ungrouted 32 mm dia. reinforcing bars (up to 6 m long) at a close interval of 150 to 500 mm along the periphery of the tunnel inclined 5 to 10 degrees outwards from the periphery by hammering (or by drilling and grouting). 4.8.2 Pipe roofing When ground conditions in tunneling are such that face cannot be supported by pre-grouting and / or fore poling, the special technique of pipe roofing shall be required to be implemented. The pipe roofing work shall be carried out by a specialized agency. Pipe roofing consists of high tensile seamless pipe casing(maximum 21 m long) driven into the medium using a Symmetrix drilling system or equivalent, using sacrificial drill bits. The pipe diameter shall be of 89 mm with minimum thickness as 4 mm. Alternate perforated pipes and plane pipes each of 3 m length are connected to each other either through a weld connection (fully butt) or through threading system, to create a positive connection. The pipes are spaced at 300 to 500 mm center to center along the periphery of the tunnel. The pipes are inclined 5 degrees outward from the periphery. The perforated pipes are then grouted in stages of 3 to 6 m using packer in each stage, using cement grout (w/c ratio varying between 0.8 to 0.4), at a pressure of 3 to 4 Kg/cm 2 . The entire system is required to form an umbrella ahead of face so that safe further excavation can be carried out. 4.8.3 Self Drilling Hollow Core Anchors Where necessary and when authorised by the Engineer-in-Charge, self-drilling hollow core anchors shall be used for rock support as shown on the drawings. Self-drilling hollow core anchors shall be of dia. 32/36 mm hollow core bars with a sacrificial drill bit at the end. The bars shall be capable of being injected with cement grout and capable of bonding with rock. The spacing of the anchors is variable and shall be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge in response to the geological conditions encountered. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 51
4.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 4.9.1 Rock Bolt (Expansion shell), Rock Anchor, Rock bolt (Grouted anchorage), Water expandable friction anchors and Grouted Anchor Bar/Dowel (1) Measurement for payment for supply and installation of Rock bolt (Expansion shell) / Rock bolt (grouted anchor) / Rock Anchor / Grouted anchor bar /Water expandable friction anchors of various diameters shall be the length of reinforcing element installed including the length of threaded portion projecting beyond rock surface. (2) Payment at the Unit price per linear meter entered in the schedule shall include entire cost of a) Delivery to the site with all necessary accessories b) Storage and protection at site c) Drilling of hole and washing & cleaning d) Installation complete e) Stressing where required f) Grouting including furnishing of grout materials with admixtures (except in case of Water expandable friction anchors) (3) Payment will be made for the supply and installation of all rock reinforcing elements used in pull-out tests for tests undertaken prior to works. (4) Measurement for payment for supplying and installing load cells shall be covered under section Monitoring Instruments. (5) No extra payment will be made for the testing equipment, carrying out tests, nor for taking and recording the loads registered on the load cells and the cost there of shall be included in the Unit Prices for other items of the Works. (6) When a rock bolt/rock anchor is extended into concrete through welding, such extension shall be paid as weight of extension piece at the Unit Price for steel reinforcement entered in the schedule. (7) No extra payment will be made for the following: a) Loose and rejected elements, elements which fall out during trimming, slashing or widening, elements which are otherwise damaged or displaced as a result of Contractor's operations. The Contractor shall replace such elements at his own expense. If the rock conditions in the underground excavation require an immediate installation of the elements in the heading face, which will be destroyed later as the excavation advances, deviation from this rule may be granted after a mutual agreement between the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor. b) Reinforcing elements which had to be installed as a consequence of Contractor's non-compliance with the approved drilling and blasting methods as specified in the Section "Underground Excavation". 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 52
4.9.2 POST-TENSIONED ROCK BOLTS (TENDONS) 4.9.2.1 Supply and Installation of Rock Bolts (Tendons) Measurement for payment for the supply and installation of post-tensioned rock bolts will be of the total length in linear meters of rock bolts (Tendons) installed, measured from the outer face of head to far end of the strands/wires. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of drilling of the holes, supply of the rock bolts complete with all accessories including heads, storage and protection at Site, corrosion protection, installation, furnishing of grout materials and grouting, stressing, testing, re-stressing and monitoring. Equipment and materials used for enabling works like erection of working platforms shall be included in the Unit Price in linear metres of the rock bolts entered in the Schedule. 4.9.2.2 Test Rock Bolts (1) Payment will be made for the supply and installation of post-tensioned rock bolts used in Suitability Tests. Measurement for payment and payment will be as for the post- tensioned rock bolts. (2) No extra payment will be made for the testing equipment for performing the Suitability Tests and simple and comprehensive stressing tests, nor for plotting and submitting the stressing records. Load cells used for comprehensive monitoring shall however be paid under section monitoring instruments. 4.9.3 MESH REINFORCEMENT 4.9.3.1 Welded wire Mesh (1) Measurement for payment for welded wire mesh will be of the weight of welded wire mesh placed. The weight of the wire mesh will be calculated from the payment area of wire mesh multiplied by the weight per unit area of the wire mesh. (2) No separate measurement will be made for mesh anchor, plates, washers and nuts used for installing welded wire mesh. (3) The payment area for wire mesh in surface excavation works is defined as the projected area over the plane parallel to the plane of average excavation. (4) The payment area for wire mesh in underground excavation works is defined as follows: a) When excavated profile does not extend beyond B Line (Theoretical Excavation Line) as defined in the Section "Underground Excavation", the payment area will be the radial projection of irregular area covered by wire mesh on to the excavation pay-line (i.e. B-line perimeter multiplied by length along the underground opening), b) When excavated profile extends in the portions of geologically accepted overbreak as defined in the Section "Underground Excavation", an imaginary line parallel to B-line will be drawn in such a way that it depicts average line of the actual excavation. In case perimeter of such an imaginary line is less than or equal to the perimeter of a line parallel to and 300 mm beyond B-line, the payment area will be calculated by considering perimeter of pay-line (B-line) only, as described in (a) above. However, in case perimeter of such an imaginary line is more than the perimeter of a line parallel to and 300 mm beyond B-Line, the payment area will be calculated by multiplying the perimeter of such an imaginary line with length along the underground opening. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 53
4.9.4 STEEL SUPPORTS 4.9.4.1 Steel Ribs and lattice girders (1) Separate Unit Prices are provided in the Schedule for Steel Ribs and lattice girders. (2) Measurement for payment for supply and installation of steel ribs and lattice girders will be of the weight installed and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) Measurement for payment for steel ribs will be made for the joist and integrally welded base plates, joint plates and stiffeners. But no separate measurement will be made for tie rods, runners, spreaders, cross-bracings, washers, nuts and bolts. (4) Measurement for payment for lattice girders will be made for the TOR steel rods and integrally welded base plates, joint plates and stiffeners. But no separate measurement will be made for tie rods, runners, spreaders, cross-bracings, washers, nuts and bolts (5) The weight of the steel joist, plates and TOR steel rods will be based on the following For joists - Unit weight as specified in IS:808 For Plates and TOR steel rods - Specific weight of 7.85 t/m 3
(6) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per metric ton entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of: a) Delivery to the Site with all necessary accessories required for installation. b) Storage and protection at the Site c) Transport to the place of erection and erection d) Installation of all foot blocks, ties, bolts, nuts, cross-bracing and all other accessories, including all permanent or temporary welding 4.9.4.2 Lagging (1) Separate Unit Prices are provided in the Schedule for steel lagging and concrete lagging. (2) Measurement for payment for steel lagging will be of the weight of lagging. (3) For the measurement and payment purposes, the weight of the steel lagging will be based on the unit weight of the steel profile (without any accessories). (4) Payment for supply and installation of steel lagging will be of the weight of lagging actually installed and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per metric ton as entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of: a) Delivery to the Site with all necessary accessories required for installation b) Storage and protection at the Site c) Transport to the place of installation and installation (5) Measurement and payment for furnishing and installation of precast RCC lagging will be of the volume of lagging actually installed and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 54
Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of: a) Manufacture of concrete lagging including supply of cement, additives and steel reinforcement and shuttering. b) Storage, transport to the place of installation and installation 4.9.4.3 Exclusions (1) Shotcrete applied between, or encasing the lattice girder/steel ribs will be measured for payment and paid for as stipulated in the Section "Shotcrete". (2) No extra payment will be made for the following: a) Steel supports, which have to be replaced, repaired or re-erected as a result of Contractor's operation. The Contractor shall rectify or replace such steel support at his own expense b) Steel supports which have to be installed as a consequence of the Contractor's non-compliance with the approved drilling and blasting methods as specified in the Section "Underground Excavation" c) Weight difference in case the Contractor prefers installation of heavier or stronger steel supports or for additional ribs due to closer spacing than those ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge d) Transport from the underground working zone back to the storage site, of any unused steel supports, and further storage to and/or removal from the Site. e) Unused concrete lagging. 4.9.5 Pre-grouting and fore poling 4.9.5.1 Payment for pre-grouting in tunnels shall be made as under (a) Drilling of hole of 45 mm dia per meter length of hole (b) Cost of cement/microfine cement per bags/kg respectively. 4.9.5.2 Payment for fore poling shall be made as under a) Drilling and installation/driving of fore pole (32 mm dia TOR steel) per meter. 4.9.5.3 Payment for pipe roofing shall be made as under (a) Drilling (min 100 mm dia), supply, fixing, fabrication, Installation of pipes roof per meter length of pipe installed (b) Cost of cement per bag. 4.9.5.4 Payment for self drilling hollow core anchors shall be made as under (a) Installation of self drilling hollow core anchors complete in all respects shall be made at the Unit Price entered in Schedule per meter of anchors installed (b) Cost of cement per bag. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 55
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 56
5 SHOTCRETE 5.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) The work under this Section includes all labour, materials, equipment and services required for the execution of Shotcrete (plain and steel fibre reinforced) work to be carried out by the Contractor under this Contract. Shotcrete shall be applied to excavated surfaces both in underground and surface excavations, where shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed or approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Contractor shall design the mix, furnish materials, place, cure and test shotcrete as necessary to provide temporary or permanent protection and/or support of excavated surfaces either in surface or underground excavations. (3) The Contractor shall furnish all materials, labour and equipment for preparing test panels, both for trial mixes and during the course of the work, and for testing cores from panels or from in-situ shotcrete. (4) When the shotcrete is applied as a temporary rock supporting or protection measure, the number and thickness of layers to be applied shall be governed by the prevailing rock conditions and will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) When the shotcrete is intended to remain as a permanent lining or protection of rock surfaces, the thickness of such lining shall be as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) Shotcrete shall be placed with or without steel wire mesh reinforcement, as directed, and may be used in conjunction with rockbolts, steel ribs and other rock supporting measures. (7) The Contractor shall maintain adequate stockpiles of materials for shotcrete for immediate use in cases of emergency. Any damage or delay resulting from shortage of such materials shall be the Contractor's entire responsibility. (8) Methods and workmanship in the application of shotcrete shall be in accordance with IS: 9012 or BS 882. 5.2 DEFINITIONS (1) Plain Shotcrete or Steel fibre reinforced Shotcrete (SFRS) is defined as a mixture of cement, aggregate, water, steel fibres (for SFRS) and accelerators in correct proportions, with maximum size of aggregate less than 10 mm projected at high velocity from a spray nozzle on to a surface to form a layer of pneumatically applied concrete on that surface. Shotcrete can be either wet or dry mix. It will be used for protection and supporting rock surfaces after excavation, to fill the cavities caused by overbreak or weathering. (2) Dry-Mix Process: The cement, aggregates batched by weight, are thoroughly mixed dry (with enough moisture to prevent dusting) and fed into a purpose-made machine wherein the mixture is pressurised, metered into a dry air stream and conveyed through hoses or pipes to a nozzle in which water and accelerator as a spray is introduced to hydrate the mix which is projected without interruption into place. (3) Wet-Mix Process: All materials including cement, aggregates weigh batched and mixed together with water, but without accelerators, to produce mortar or concrete. The mixture is then conveyed by positive displacement or compressed air to a nozzle where air, and accelerator, is injected to increase velocity, and projected without interruption into place. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 57
(4) Layer is a term used for a discrete thickness of shotcrete built up from a number of passes of the nozzle and allowed to set. (5) Rebound is a term used for all material, which, having passed through the nozzle does not adhere to the target surface. 5.3 SUBMITTALS (1) At least 56 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, the following submittals shall be made for approval: a) Details, including numbers and type of equipment proposed for mixing and applying the shotcrete, b) Qualifications and experience of the proposed personnel (foremen, nozzlemen and delivery equipment operators), c) Manufacturers' certificates giving full details of any proposed admixture, and the Contractor's proposal regarding the use of such admixtures, including certification of harmlessness to operators, d) The Contractor's proposed mix proportions prior to the commencement of testing and work, e) Details of methods to be employed for controlling the thickness of the layers of shotcrete applied (e.g. plug gauges or boreholes). (2) The selection of method, i.e. dry-mix or wet-mix process as defined above is Contractor's option. Should the Contractor intend to apply the dry-mix process, he shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge all relevant documents and references to prove that such method will in no way impair the quality and efficiency of the work and will not cause any increase in cost. 5.4 MATERIALS 5.4.1 General (1) Cement used in shotcrete shall be OPC conforming to IS: 8112 (2) Cement, aggregates, water, admixtures, shall conform to the requirements of the Section "Concrete", except as specifically amended hereafter. (3) The water content of aggregate at the time of incorporating into the mix shall be less than 2% by weight of oven dry aggregate. (4) Air used to apply shotcrete shall be clean and free of oil and other contamination. 5.4.2 Aggregates (1) Aggregate gradation used in shotcrete shall conform to those established by the preconstruction trial mix tests. The gradation shall not be changed without the prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The following aggregate gradation shall be taken as a guide for mix design purposes, but may be modified, subject to the results of the trial mix tests specified hereinafter: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 58
(3) Should the nature of the aggregates used during the course of the work change (e.g. source, rock type, shape) from that used in the trial mix tests, the Contractor shall produce new trial mixes, using the new aggregates. 5.4.3 Steel Fibres The steel fibre used in SFRS shall be produced from high tensile steel, either cold rolled or cold drawn wires and confirm to ASTM A820. Fibres shall be dry and free from oil, grease and chlorides. The supplier shall furnish evidence of an officially approved quality control system according to ISO 9000. The fibres shall satisfy the following parameters: Length of steel fibres 25 mm to 40 mm Geometric shape The steel fibres shall have suitably deformed profile to ensure proper matrix of SFRS mix and to develop better end anchorage with no fibre balling Aspect Ratio (Length /Diameter) 50-60 Fibre tensile strength <1000 Mpa Quantity of steel fibres Not less than 50 Kg / cum (Subject to mix design / field trials) Mixing procedure adopted by the contractor should be such that there is no fibre balling. 5.4.4 Admixtures Admixtures shall be used to develop fast setting and high early strength of shotcrete, to ensure good workability, low pumping pressure, adequate slump retention and low rebound, as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, conforming to requirements of relevant standards. Only proven admixtures which meet the requirements of the specifications on field trials and long- term satisfactory performance on other projects already constructed shall be approved. The consumption of admixtures shall be recorded daily. (1) Superplasticisers: Shall meet the requirements of ASTM C 494 type F shall be compatible with cement & accelerator. Superplasticisers shall be added at the batching plant to keep the shotcrete mix workable during transportation and to ensure good pump ability at an acceptable low water cement ratio. The Superplasticisers shall be free of chlorides.
Square Mesh Sieve Opening
% Passing (by weight) 9.50 mm 90-100 4.75 mm 73-100 2.36 mm 55-90 1.18 mm 37-72 0.60 mm 22-50 0.30 mm 11-26 0.15 mm 4-12 0.075 mm 2 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 59
(2) Accelerators: Only liquid accelerators shall be used. The accelerator shall be added at the nozzle. -The maximum dosage shall not exceed 6 % (by mass of cement) Testing of accelerators in accordance with this specification with regard to setting time and early strength gain shall be in accordance with the following a) Initial set of cement/admixture paste 3 min Final set of cement/admixture paste 12 min b) 3-hour strength of shotcrete 0.7 N/mm 2
8-hour strength of shotcrete 4.0 N/mm 2
24-hour strength of shotcrete 10.0 N/mm 2
(3) Micro -Silica or silica fume: Micro silica shall be added in the mix at the batching plant for facilitating the mixing and distribution of fibres to reduce fibre rebound and improve bond between cement matrix and fibres. The dose of silica fumes shall be 5- 7% (of cement weight) subject to site trials. Silica fume shall have a bulk density between 500 -700 kg / cum. Test certificates from approved and reputed testing laboratory shall be produced to satisfy that the silica fume complies with IS-15388 (latest edition). 5.5 MIX DESIGN AND QUALITY REQUIREMENTS 5.5.1 Plain Shotcrete: (1) Shotcrete mix shall be designed by the Contractor such that they achieve the strengths specified. The mixes shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The cube compressive strength at 28 days for structural or permanent shotcrete shall be 35 N/mm 2 and compressive cylinder strength shall be 28 N/mm 2 . The compressive strength after 7 days shall reach 70% of the specified strength at 28 days. (3) To determine that the shotcrete meets the requirements to the compressive strength, the in-situ strength requirements given below shall be met, which are based on a 50 mm diameter by 100 mm long core and include a 0.85 reduction factor to allow for effects of in-situ coring. Minimum compressive strength (Mpa) Strength class C28/35 Core 24 (4) Mixes shall be such that the aggregate gradation and cement content after placing are as those obtained from samples taken from test panels produced using approved trial mixes. All constituents shall be uniformly dispersed throughout the mix, and the assumed cement content shall be 500 kg/m 3 . (5) The water content of the mixes shall be limited to prevent sloughing. The water-cement ratio of fresh shotcrete in place shall be between 0.32 and 0.40. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 60
(6) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right at any time during the progress of the work to instruct the Contractor to vary the proportions of the constituents of the shotcrete or order further trial applications to ensure that adequate strengths are maintained. 5.5.2 Steel Fibre Reinforced Shotcrete (SFRS): (1) The type / class of shotcrete to be used in a particular location shall be as per drawings and as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge (2) The mix proportions of cement aggregates, steel fibres, micro silica and permitted admixtures in each class shall be determined by the Contractor and shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-charge. The mixes shall be such as to permit placement without excessive rebound and segregation (subjected to minimum quantity requirements of ingradients). (3) The Contractor shall submit his mix design for SFRS to meet the strength requirements specified hereunder for prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. The quantities of super plasticizer may be adjusted to compensate the slump loss because of steel fibre. The mix design shall provide the following details for one cubic metre of SFRS Ordinary Portland Cement Kg Aggregate Natural fine aggregate Size Kg Natural coarse aggregate Size Kg Crushed fine aggregate Size Kg Crushed coarse aggregate Size Kg Steel fibres Lengh(mm)..dia(mm) Kg Super Plasticizer Kg Accelerator Kg Microsilica Kg W/C Ratio Slump Density (Wet) (4) The cube compressive strength of SFRS at 28 days shall be 35 N/mm 2 . (5) Moisture content of the combined aggregate at the time of mixing with cement shall not exceed 6% (six per cent) by weight of the oven dry aggregate (6) The quoted rate for SFRS shall include the cost of all materials, labour, machinery, all leads and lifts etc. complete. The quoted rate shall include payment towards variation in the quantities, if any, of all material during mix design/ execution stage. 5.6 TESTING 5.6.1 General (1) For the purpose of approving mix design by Engineer-in-Charge, Contractor shall prepare initially not less than a set of three test panels for each mix for testing at least 42 days before any shotcreting work is started. For any subsequent change in additive or equipment the Engineer-in-Charge may order fresh testing. All tests shall be done as per IS: 516 and IS: 9012. (2) For the purpose of routine quality control, the number of panels to be supplied shall generally consist of 3 for every 50 m 3 of shotcrete to be placed. (3) A set of three test panels for mix design approval and for routine quality control shall consist of one shot downward onto a horizontal surface, one shot onto an inclined or vertical surface and one shot overhead onto a horizontal surface. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 61
(4) Test panels for shotcrete quality control and to determine the suitability of additives shall be made as specified herein and in accordance with the requirement of Engineer- in-Charge. (5) The Contractor shall furnish all plant, materials and assistance necessary and carry out all work to obtain representative tests panels of shotcrete. (6) Test panels shall be obtained by securely attaching an approved 1 m x 1 m by 100 mm deep timber box to an area of rock similar to that to be shotcreted or an approved alternative surface arrangement, wetting the box and applying shotcrete to the area contained by the box in the manner specified herein and using the same mixing and placing equipment to be used for the works. (7) All test panels shall be of a minimum thickness of 100 mm, and shall be made in the presence of Engineer-in-Charge. The panels shall be left undisturbed at the point of placement until the final set has taken place. (8) Test panels and specimens shall be transported by the Contractor to the site laboratory immediately after final set has taken place, not sooner than two hours and not later than eight hours after manufacture, and in such a manner as to prevent them from being damaged in any way. (9) Compressive strength tests shall be performed on drilled cores from the sprayed concrete structure or from the sprayed test panels. Their minimum diameter shall be 50 mm and the height/diameter ratio shell be in the range of 1.0 to 2.0. Test results from cores with height/diameter ratio different from 2.0 shall be converted to equivalent cylinder strength using the values given in table below. Conversion factors to equivalent cube and cylinder strengths. Height/diameter ratio of core Cube factor Cylinder factor 2.00 1.15 1.00 1.75 1.12 0.97 1.50 1.10 0.95 1.25 1.07 0.93 1.10 1.03 0.89 1.00 1.00 0.87 0.75 0.88 0.76 (10) Core test results will be statistically analysed in accordance with the recommendations of IS: 456. Test results shall meet all the acceptance criteria specified in IS: 456. (11) If tests performed on cored specimens indicate that the shotcrete fails to meet the specified requirements of insitu strengths then Contractor shall carry out such remedial works as Engineer-in-Charge may require, including placement of additional shotcrete, and if deemed necessary repair and/or removal and replacement of shotcrete. 5.6.2 Steel Fibres (1) The Steel fibres shall meet the requirement given in ASTM A 820 (latest edition). 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 62
(2) Fibres shall withstand bending around 3.18 mm inside diameter to an angle of 90 degree at temperature not less than 16 degree Celsius without breaking. (3) Measurement of dimensions shall be performed on not less than 10 randomly selected specimens for each test to establish the average for conforming to the specified tolerances. At least 90% of the specimens in each test shall meet the specified tolerances for length, diameter and aspect ratio. Atleast one test shall be performed for each 5 tonnes of material or each shipment, if less than 5 tonnes. (4) Material test certificate is to be submitted for each lot. At least one tensile test consisting of 10 randomly selected finished fibres shall be performed for each 5 tonne of material supplied or each shipment if less than 5 tonnes. The average value of this test must not be less than the specified minimum. (5) An evaluation of fibre content shall be carried out on a 5 kg specimen of fresh SFRS sampled from the works immediately after spraying. After washing out, the steel fibres shall be collected, dried and weighed. The weight shall be compared to the volume of the specimen, which shall be determined as approved by the engineer-in-Charge. The frequency of testing for fibres content shall be one test, comprising of 3 specimens for each 200 cubic metre of SFRS applied in the works. 5.6.3 SFRS (1) The equipment and procedure for compressive strength shall be in accordance with J SCE -SF5. The specimen cylindrical cores measuring 100 mm / 150 mm, as the case may be, in diameter shall be drilled out of the prepared test panels. Panels for testing shall be at least 1000 mm x 1000 mm in size and shall be 200 mm thick. The panels shall be prepared by shotcreting into vertical moulds, which shall be constructed of steel or other non-water absorbing rigid materials, and shall have side splayed outwards at 45 degree to prevent the entrapment of rebound. Cores shall be tested for every 100 cum of SFRS or as directed by Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Flexural strength and toughness properties shall be measured in accordance with J apanese Standards J SECE - SF4. The beam shall be cut out from splayed panels. The beams shall be stored in water for a minimum of three days after sawing and immediately before testing and kept moist during testing. (3) Testing of the bond strength between shotcrete and rock and between layers of shotcrete shall be carried out either by an in situ testing of rock / shotcrete or bonded cores in a laboratory. Test shall be carried out on cores greater than 60 mm and less than or equal to 100 mm in diameter. Drilling for in situ testing must penetrate the rock by at least 15 mm (4) Cores taken for laboratory testing shall be cured and protected until the time of testing. The rate of loading shall be greater than 1Mpa per minute and less than 3 MPa per minute. The frequency of bond testing shall be one test comprising of 6 specimens for each 300 cum of SFRS or as directed by Engineer-in-Charge. 5.7 EQUIPMENT (1) Only modern, properly operating mixing, delivery, and placing equipment approved by the Engineer-in-Charge shall be used for the performance of the work. (2) The compressor shall provide a supply of air adequate to maintain sufficient nozzle velocity for all parts of the work while simultaneously operating a blowpipe for clearing away rebound when required. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 63
(3) The delivery equipment shall be a pneumatic feed type or, for the wet-mix process, positive displacement type. The equipment shall be capable of delivering a continuous smooth stream of uniformly mixed material at the proper velocity from the discharge nozzle at all heights of the work. (4) The delivery equipment shall be thoroughly cleaned at the end of each shift. Equipment parts, especially the nozzle liner and water ring, shall be regularly inspected and replaced as required. (5) The discharge nozzle, for the dry-mix process, shall be equipped with a manually operated water injection system (water ring) for directing an even distribution of water to the aggregate- cement mixture. The water valve shall be capable of ready adjustment to vary the quantity of water and shall be convenient for the nozzle man. (6) Water pressure shall be maintained at a uniform level which shall be at least 1 bar above operating pressure and sufficient to ensure adequate hydration at all times. (7) The nozzle shall be capable of delivering a conical uniform discharge stream. Distortion of this stream shall be remedied by examination of the nozzle and any malfunction rectified by replacement of defective parts before further work is carried out. 5.8 PROFICIENCY OF WORKMEN (1) Nozzlemen shall have had previous experience in the application of coarse aggregate shotcrete or shall work under the immediate supervision of a foreman or instructor with such experience. Each crew shall demonstrate acceptable proficiency in the application of shotcrete to vertical and overhead test panels before beginning production work. Only approved work crews shall perform the work. (2) The acceptable shotcrete shall consist of a dense uniform concrete without major rebound inclusions and without discernible weakness of bond between layers. The nozzlemen shall shoot shotcrete with a uniform consistency and at the wettest consistency short of the sag point. The nozzle shall be held at a predetermined distance and position so that the stream of flowing material shall impinge as nearly as possible at right angles to the surface to be covered. 5.9 SURFACE PREPARATION (1) When shotcrete is to be applied to excavated surface immediately after blasting, the surfaces shall be prepared by a minimum of scaling followed by washing with clean water. All surfaces shall be wet & clean and already shotcreted surface on which another shotcrete layer is to be placed, free of rebound, at the time of application of shotcrete. The surface shall be kept moist until shotcrete is applied. (2) Where water flows from the rock against which shotcrete is to be placed and that water cannot be sealed off by shotcreting alone, the water shall be excluded from the area by caulking or diverted by pipes, pans or other approved means in such a manner that the shotcrete will be unaffected by action of the water through percolation, by hydrostatic pressure or erosion. (3) A layer of shotcrete, which is to be covered, immediately by a succeeding layer shall first be allowed to take its initial set. A layer of shotcrete, which is to be covered by a succeeding layer after its final set has taken place, shall have all laitance, loose material, dirt or other deleterious material and rebound removed by sweeping with brooms, sluicing or other means acceptable to Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 64
(4) Shotcrete surfaces shall be kept moist until either the succeeding layer of shotcrete is applied or alternatively the curing requirements set out in this Section have been observed. (5) At any time during surface preparation, Engineer-in-Charge may order Contractor to apply shotcrete to isolated areas before proceeding with surface preparation due to safety reasons in case of emergency. 5.10 MIXING AND PLACING (1) Shotcrete materials shall be accurately weigh-batched before mixing. Aggregates shall be thoroughly mixed without the addition of water before being deposited in the placing equipment. Mixes, which are not applied within 60 minutes of adding cement, shall be discarded. Rapid hardening additive shall be accurately proportioned. (2) The minimum thickness of shotcrete in any one layer shall be 25 mm. The maximum thickness of shotcrete applied in any one layer at any location shall be 50 mm. (3) The Engineer-in-Charge will examine rock faces following blasting and scaling in underground excavation. On the basis of such examination, the Engineer-in-Charge may require immediate shotcreting of surfaces, in which case shotcrete shall be applied within 4 hour of blasting and before drilling the next round. Shotcrete equipment shall be available before blasting where poor rock conditions are anticipated so that shotcrete can be applied with minimum delay. (4) Shotcrete, other than that placed immediately after blasting, shall not be placed in any area until all blasting within 20 m of the area has been completed, unless otherwise approved by Engineer-in-Charge. (5) Shotcrete in open area works shall not be carried out when shotcrete cannot be placed effectively because of adverse weather conditions, unless adequate cover is provided over the working area until the shotcrete has been cured sufficiently to prevent damage. (6) The Contractor shall develop operating procedures and operations to give: a) minimum rebound, b) Smooth finished surface, c) no hollow areas in the shotcrete, d) minimum of shrinkage cracks, e) Good adherence of the shotcrete to rock or other surface. (7) The flow of the material at the nozzle shall be continuous and uniform and the rate of application over any given area shall also be uniform. Slugs, sand spots, wet areas or other defects shall be cut out and corrected as specified herein. (8) An approved method of establishing layer thickness, such as the use of plug gauges or boreholes, shall be employed. (9) In shotcreting vertical or steeply inclined surfaces, other than roofs of underground excavations, application shall begin at the lowest point and the shotcrete layer shall be built up in horizontal strips until the entire surface is covered. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 65
(10) Where drain holes have been drilled and instruments have been installed into rock on which shotcrete is to be placed, the Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to prevent such holes from being plugged or instruments from being damaged. (11) When shotcreting is to be performed near existing structures, Contractor shall ensure that no damage results to the structure and shall protect the surfaces of structures before and during shotcreting. (12) Application of shotcrete in any area shall be considered complete when the shotcrete has been built up to the thickness specified. The thickness of shotcrete specified on Drawings shall be the minimum thickness measured anywhere in the treated area, with the exception of protrusion of rock whose dimensions in plan are less than the thickness of the shotcrete specified, in which case the minimum cover shall be not less than the 2/3 of the specified nominal thickness. (13) Where shotcrete is placed over wire mesh and supporting bolts, it shall be covered with shotcrete to a depth of at least 25 mm. Where rock bolt extensions are to be added to existing rock bolts, the exposed ends of the rock bolt threads shall be suitably protected before shotcreting. 5.11 REBOUND (1) Rebound shall be kept to a minimum and continuously monitored. Special care shall be taken that rebound does not build up at the junction of walls and floors both underground and on the surface. (2) Rebound shall be removed and disposed of before any adjacent area is shotcreted. Rebound shall not be reused. (3) Contractor shall make every effort to keep rebound to a minimum. If, in the opinion of Engineer-in-Charge, rebound is excessive, he may require the Contractor to revise the mix design or the application procedures or take other measures deemed necessary to reduce the rebound. 5.12 PROTECTION, CURING, AND FINISHING (1) Suitable screening of the nozzle and of the application surface shall be provided during periods of windy or draughty conditions. (2) Freshly laid shotcrete shall be protected from rain or water until the surface is of sufficient hardness to prevent damage. (3) When dry specks first appear at the surface of any shotcrete layer, it shall be wetted with a water jet at least once in every 4 hours or otherwise cured to the satisfaction of Engineer- in-Charge for a minimum period of 7 days. Membrane curing shall not be used when a further layer of shotcrete or other bonded finish is to be applied. (4) In underground excavations and surface excavations the shotcrete shall be water cured. (5) The surface of the shotcrete shall be left as shot without any finishing. As an exception, the surface of the annulus of reinforced gunite placed at the internal surface of the tunnel concrete lining shall be smoothened. 5.13 REPAIR (1) Before a succeeding layer of shotcrete is placed, the preceding layer shall be checked for drumminess. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 66
(2) The Contractor shall repair all drummy, sandy, cracked or spalled areas and any other areas where, in the opinion of Engineer-in-Charge, the shotcrete is faulty, by removing the shotcrete to a sound area of rock or shotcrete, carrying out surface preparation as specified herein and replacing that area to the satisfaction of Engineer-in-Charge. 5.14 TOLERANCES (1) For shotcrete on natural surfaces or surfaces with an undefined shape, the thickness at any point shall not be less than 80% of the specified nominal thickness and also the average thickness of shotcrete shall not be less than specified nominal thickness. (2) The thickness over the individual protruding rock pieces may not be less than two- thirds (2/3) of the specified nominal thickness. 5.15 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 5.15.1 General (1) Measurement for payment for shotcrete (plain or SFRS) will be of the volume of shotcrete placed. The volume will be calculated from the payment area of shotcrete multiplied by the specified thickness as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The payment area for surface excavation works is defined as the projected area over the plane parallel to the plane of average excavation. (3) The payment area for underground excavation works is defined as follows: a) When excavated profile does not extend beyond B Line (Theoretical Excavation Line) as defined in the Section "Underground Excavation", the payment area will be the radial projection of irregular area covered by shotcrete on to the excavation pay-line (i.e. B-line perimeter multiplied by length along the underground opening), b) When excavated profile extends in the portions of geologically accepted overbreak as defined in the Section "Underground Excavation", an imaginary line parallel to B-line will be drawn in such a way that it depicts average line of the actual excavation. In case perimeter of such an imaginary line is less than or equal to the perimeter of a line parallel to and 300 mm beyond B-line, the payment area will be calculated by considering perimeter of pay-line (B-line) only, as described in (a) above. However, in case perimeter of such an imaginary line is more than the perimeter of a line parallel to and 300 mm beyond B-Line, the payment area will be calculated by multiplying the perimeter of such an imaginary line with length along the underground opening. (4) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule which shall include the entire cost of the following: a) All labour, plant and materials including Cement, Silica fumes and admixtures. b) Storage, batching, mixing and supply of all materials, water supply, preparation and cleaning of surfaces, c) Placing of plug gauges for control of layer's thickness, d) Shotcrete material wasted in rebound, e) Temporary protection, curing and testing, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 67
f) All activities related with performance of material testing. (5) The Contractor shall not be entitled to any extra payment over and above the Unit Prices entered in the Schedule for application of shotcrete within heading zone or bottom range zone as defined in the Section "Underground Excavation". (6) The in-situ volume of shotcrete placed in underground works shall be deducted from the volume of structural concrete lining and backfill concrete behind steel lining /ribs to be measured for payment as stipulated in the Section "Concrete". (7) Shotcrete placed by Contractor in excess of thickness shown on the Construction Drawings or as specified by Engineer-in-Charge will not be measured for payment. 5.15.2 Materials (1) No separate payment will be made for the nominal cement content of 500 kg/m3 indicated in this Section. (2) In case the required minimum specified compressive strength of the shotcrete/SFRS cannot be reached, or is in excess of with the cement content of 500 kg/m3, variation of cement content (increase or decrease) will be assessed separately and paid for or recovered from the contractor as the case may be and as specified herein. (3) Measurement for payment for variations of Portland cement content used for shotcrete will be of the quantities, by weight, of cement approved and computed on the basis of the number of cubic meters of shotcrete measured and approved for payment. The amount of cement required per cubic meter of shotcrete will be as established at trial mix stage or the approved modifications thereof as established by the Engineer in the course of shotcrete work. (4) Payment will be made at the Unit Prices entered in the Schedule, which shall include the extra cost of provision, delivery, transportation, storage and mixing, and complying with all requirements specified. (5) No separate payment will be made for the admixtures and the cost thereof shall be included in the Unit Price for shotcrete/SFRS.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 68
6 EMBANKMENT CONSTRUCTION 6.1 SCOPE OF WORK 1) This Section covers all labour, materials, equipment and services related to the foundation preparation and construction of the concrete-faced rockfill dam (CFRD), which the Contractor shall execute under this Contract. Other works on the dam, including excavation, grout curtain, cut-off wall, concrete, control of water and instrumentation are covered in other Sections of these Specifications. 2) This Section also covers earth embankments other than the rockfill dam, including cofferdam construction, backfill behind, below, around and above structures, and any other fill, except for the road works. 3) Most of the embankment fill materials will be available of the required excavations for the Permanent and Temporary Works. The Section "Open Excavation" covers these excavations. 4) The work include processing if required, placing and spreading, compaction, sprinkling with water as needed for the materials specified hereinafter. 5) The CFRD-dam embankment shall include the following material zones as shown on the Construction Drawings: Non-cohesive soil (semi pervious), 1A Alluvial fill (processed): Zone 1B Filter Zone (sand and gravel): Zone 2 Filter Zone (concrete sand) : Zone 2A Transition Zone (processed/selected): Zone 3A Transition Zone (processed/selected): Zone 3D Rockfill: Zone 3B Rockfill: Zone 3C Riprap: Zone 4 Downstream Protection (selected rockfill): Zone 4A The dam has also the following features: Concrete face slab, plinth and parapet wall, Concrete extruded curb supporting Zones 2A and 2. 6) The Contractor shall construct the plinth, face slab and parapet wall on the upstream side of the dam and install instrumentation in and on the embankment as shown on the Drawings. The Contractor shall also construct a permanent road on the dam crest and on the downstream face of the dam as shown on the Drawings. 7) The embankments shall be constructed to the lines, grades and dimensions as shown on the Construction Drawings, provided that at any time before or during construction the Engineer-in-Charge may vary the dividing lines between zones of the embankment, the crest elevation of any embankment, inclination of the slopes, as well as the thicknesses of layers specified herein, or order any other modification which he deems to be necessary. 8) The slopes exposed to permanent view shall be levelled according to current construction practice. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 69
9) Concurrent with construction, the Contractor shall monitor the behaviour of the dam embankment by taking instrumentation reading, using the instruments installed in accordance with the Section "Monitoring Instruments", and shall report to the Engineer- in-Charge at the time intervals indicated therein. Should any such reading indicate that, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, the safety of the dam is in doubt he may direct the Contractor to reduce the rate of construction of one or more zones, or to suspend all construction of the embankment until further notice. 10) The approval given by the Engineer-in-Charge to the Contractor's methods and equipment shall not relieve the Contractor of his full responsibility for the proper and safe execution of the dam embankment or backfill works, or of liability for injuries to, or death of persons, or any obligations under this Contract. 6.2 SUBMITTALS 6.2.1 Submittals before construction 1) Within 28 days after the day of receipt of the Notice to Commence the Contractor shall submit a detailed method statement for all excavation and embankment fill placing procedures for construction of the dam. This statement must describe the items of plant and equipment to be used and must also contain description, drawings and a complete programme for the transport of rockfill from the sources indicating the placing stages and work rates, haulage methods and routes and stockpiles etc. 2) Not less than 56 days prior to the commencement of any operations for obtaining material for embankment, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval details of the proposed methods, procedures, and equipment that he intends to use to obtain material of the required quality, size and gradation as specified for each zone of the dam embankment. 3) Not less than 56 days before the embankment placement begins, the Contractor shall submit detailed information on his proposed methods for placing and compacting material in each of the embankment zones to the lines, grades and tolerances specified in this Section. All details, specifications and number of each proposed equipment shall be indicated in the technical report, as well as the type and number of special equipment to be used in places inaccessible for the normal compacting equipment. Further, the Contractor shall prepare and submit a detailed planning for the construction of the cofferdam and pre-cofferdam, taking into account the monsoon season. 6.2.2 Submittals during construction 1) The Contractor shall submit all results of material tests carried out prior to, and during the placement of the embankment material as well as results of the test embankment (see Appendix at the end of this Section). These test results shall be submitted within 7 days after completion of the tests. In addition, quarterly reports with format and content approved by the Engineer-in-Charge shall be submitted by the Contractor, summarising fill placement and results of placement control. 2) The Contractor shall submit at monthly intervals the updated, detailed embankment construction programme, progress report and drawings depicting the embankment, including all work related to the instrumentation. 6.3 PLANT AND EQUIPMENT 6.3.1 Compacting equipment 1) The type of the compacting equipment used for the rockfill dam and other embankments shall be proposed by the Contractor and shall be tested on the test embankment. Only after the compaction tests have demonstrated the effectiveness of the equipment, will it be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 70
2) Vibrator rollers for compacting rockfill shall be of the smooth steel-drum, either self- propelled or towed type. The total static weight on the drum axle shall be not less than 10 tons. The drum shall be equipped with suitable devices to prevent accumulation of material during operation. Operating frequency shall be between 1,100 and 1,500 vibrations per minute. Dynamic force shall be not less than 20 tons at 1,500 vibrations per minute. 3) Vibrating plate mechanical tampers weighting 600-800 kg will be required for compacting fills not accessible to larger items of compacting plant. The tampers shall be capable of compacting a layer thickness of 50 cm. It should be capable of producing compaction equal to that produced by the equipment specified above. 4) Compaction of material in areas where it is impracticable to use a roller or larger tamper shall be performed by approved hand power tampers. It should be capable of producing compaction equal to that produced by the equipment specified above. When such compactors are used the lift thickness shall be reduced to obtain the required compaction level. 6.4 MATERIALS PROCESSING PLANT 1) The Contractor shall provide and maintain in perfect working conditions an adequate processing plant capable to deliver the quantity, quality and gradation of processed materials required for the Zones 1B, 2, 2A, 3A and 3D of the embankment. 2) Preparation processes required to ensure the quality and gradation of the materials shall include, but not be limited to, the combination of sieving, crushing, washing, separation and re-mixing of materials. 3) The plant capacity shall be determined by the Contractor taking into account the peak demand for materials required by the approved construction schedule. 6.4.1 Transportation equipment 1) The Contractor shall provide and maintain in perfect working condition an adequate transportation equipment capable to transport all types of materials required for the construction of the dam and other embankments or backfills. 2) This transportation equipment, trucks, conveyor belts, cableways, etc., shall have the necessary capacity to transport any kind of material from the place of its origin or from stockpiles to the designated final location as required for the proper execution of the work. The number and capacity of the items of transport equipment shall be sufficient to ensure the construction schedule requirements are met, with an adequate allowance for reserve. 3) The material transporting methods and placement procedures shall be such that segregation or separation of material components during transport or during unloading and spreading is prevented. 4) Spreading and grading equipment 5) The Contractor shall provide and maintain in perfect working conditions adequate equipment for spreading and grading of materials brought to the embankments in accordance with these Specifications and capable to fulfil the approved construction schedule. 6) Motor graders, bulldozers, and power shovels shall be available in sufficient numbers for spreading and placing the embankment materials. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 71
6.4.2 Water supply and sprinkling equipment The Contractor shall provide and maintain in perfect working conditions suitable equipment such as pumps, tanks, hoses, and sprinkler trucks to provide water for dust prevention and for watering of the rockfill, amounting to 200 l water per m3 , or as directed by the Engineer-in- Charge. 6.5 CONTRACTOR'S LABORATORY AND TESTING 6.5.1 Laboratory and testing equipment 1) The Contractor shall build, equip, operate, and maintain an adequate field laboratory for sampling and testing of materials as stipulated in the Section "Site Installations". The laboratory shall be run by Contractor's personnel experienced in sampling and testing of materials, and quality control. All sampling and testing to be undertaken shall be under the direct supervision of the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Concerning the construction of the rockfill dam, and other embankments and backfills, the Contractor's laboratory and its staff shall carry out the following: Organisation and evaluation of the test embankment, Control of the construction materials, Control of the placing of material in the embankments, All activities required in connection with the installation of the instrumentation, taking the readings and evaluation of the results. 3) The testing of materials shall be performed both in the excavation and quarry areas and on the embankments. The Contractor shall plan his testing activities in such a way that a minimum interference with the ongoing construction work is caused. However, it may be sometimes necessary to reduce or stop the construction if the proper performance of the tests so dictates. 4) The Contractor shall be able to perform with its equipment the following kind of tests: Grain size distribution IS 2720 (4) or ASTM D 422 Hydrometer analysis IS 2720 (4) or ASTM D 422 Atterberg's limits IS 2720 (5) or ASTM D 4318 Moisture content IS 2720 (2) or ASTM D 2216 Specific gravity & absorption IS 2720 (3) or ASTM C 127 Specific gravity of soils IS 2720 (3) or ASTM D 854 Compaction test (Proctor) IS 2720 or ASTM D 698 Relative density IS 2720 or ASTM D 4254 Field density test IS 10379 or USBR Earth Manual E- 24 Los Angeles abrasion test ASTM C 535 Soundness test IS 2386 (5) or ASTM C 88 Point load strength IS 8764 Compressive strength ISRM Basic friction angel of rockfill ISRM 5) Further, equipment shall be available to perform field density and field permeability tests. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 72
6) Material passing the 63.0 mm size sieve shall have its grain size distribution determined by sieve analysis according to IS 2720. Particles larger than 63.0 mm shall be removed and graded by weight on site. 6.5.2 Material testing 1) Before placement of any embankment material, at least 3 series of the applicable tests listed in (4) of the 6.5.1 above shall be performed on all materials of the different zones. 2) During placement of the embankment, the following approximate numbers of tests will have to be carried out by the Contractor: Test Description Number of Tests on Material Zone: 1A 1B 2 2A 3A 3B 3C 3D Grain size distribution 5 5 80 3 40 20 10 20 Specific gravity 2 2 10 3 5 5 - 5 Los Angeles Test - - 10 - 5 5 - 5 Soundness Test - - 10 - 5 5 - 5 Relative Density - - 15 6 15 - - 6 In-situ Density At least 3 tests per lift 10 10 20 3) Other tests shall be carried out as instructed by the Engineer-in-Charge 6.5.3 Test embankment 1) Test embankments of zone 2, 3A, 3B and 3C shall be constructed according to stipulations given in the Appendix at the end of this Section. The Engineer-in-Charge may direct that separate test sections be constructed for materials of different characteristic. 2) Tests will permit the Engineer-in-Charge to confirm or modify the layer thicknesses and/or the number of compaction passes at specified velocity and vibration ranges, and the required volume of water to be used for placement. 3) In case of changes in the quarry or borrow area, changes in characteristics of material, or changes in the construction equipment, the Contractor shall, upon request of the Engineer-in-Charge, perform new test sections. 6.6 CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS 6.6.1 General 1) The construction of the rockfill shells of the dam embankment shall consist of sound rock fragments available from the required excavation for the foundation of the concrete structures or the tunnels. 2) Materials originating from the excavation required for the intakes, tunnels and other Permanent and Temporary Works shall be used to the maximum possible extent for embankment construction. Excavation and haulage procedures, drilling and blasting patterns etc. shall be such to ensure that a maximum amount of the material excavated for these structures and Works will be suitable for construction of the dam. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 73
3) Part of the material may also be obtained from borrow areas and quarries as already identified or as may be designated in the course of the work and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Contractor's operations in the quarries and borrow areas shall be as specified in the Section "Surface Excavation". 4) Dam construction materials from the required excavation areas, from approved quarries or from borrow areas shall be brought to the embankment directly, stockpiled or prepared by processing to meet the requirements specified in this Section, as proposed by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 5) Construction materials shall be obtained, transported, prepared, processed, and stockpiled in such a manner that embankment construction can proceed without delay. The Contractor shall select his plant and organise his operations taking fully into account all delaying factors such as monsoon season rains and their effects, floods, groundwater levels, construction phases etc., so that the approved construction schedule is kept. 6) The Contractor's attention is drawn to the provisions contained in the Section "Surface Excavation" referring to the excavated materials and the disposal thereof. 7) The characteristics of the placed materials shall conform to the requirements stipulated herein. All such requirements stipulated in the following clauses refer to the materials after placing and compaction in the final locations. 6.6.2 Random fills on plinth and in cut-off open trench (Zones 1A and 1B) Zone 1A shall consist of selected non-cohesive low permeability soil. Rock fragments or clay lumps having a maximum dimension of 150mm shall not be permitted. The Zone 1A gradation shall contain a minimum of 30% by weight passing 0.075mm. Zone 1B shall consist of selected / processed alluvium fill having a maximum dimension of 76mm. 6.6.3 Filter and transition zones (Zones 2, 3A and 3D) 1) The Filter material (Zone 2) shall consist primarily of crushed unweathered rock obtained from the required excavation, conforming to the following gradation limits: Indian Standard Percentage passing Sieve Designation by weight _______________________________________________________ 63.0 mm 100 40.0 mm 80-100 20.0 mm 55-80 4.75 mm 30-55 0.63 mm 10-30 0.075 mm 0-5 2) Zone 2A Fill (Concrete Sand) shall consist of well graded, hard, durable natural sand from an approved source. 3) The transition material (Zone 3A) shall consist of sound rock from the required excavation with boulders and fines removed to conform to the following limits: Indian Standard Percentage Passing Sieve Designation by weight _______________________________________________________ 200 mm 100 63.0 mm 55-100 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 74
20.0 mm 25-50 4.75 mm 10-30 0.075 mm 0-5 5) The transition zone 3D shall be in conformity with the grain size distribution of the foundation material respectively the rockfill material and is in conformity with the standard filter criteria of Terzaghi and Sherard. 6.6.4 Rockfill (Zones 3B and 3C ) 1) The Zone 3B shall consist of slightly weathered rockfill, or better, obtained from the required excavation areas. Zone 3C shall be moderately weathered rock, or better, also from the required excavation. 2) Rock of unsatisfactory characteristics or containing organic material, soil, fines or other unsuitable material will not be accepted for placing in the embankment. 3) The Engineer-in-Charge may reject rockfill which: Cannot be placed or compacted into a relatively dense embankment with equipment and methods being employed, Is not well-graded or has a gradation, which falls outside the specified limits. 4) The rockfill shall be free draining. Following gradation requirements shall be fulfilled: ZONE 3B Zone 3C Maximum Size 60 cm * 120 cm Amount passing 40 mm 10 - 45% <45% Amount passing 4.76 mm <20% <20% Amount passing 0.075 mm <5% <5% The above gradation limits corresponds to homogeneously placed fill. * Within 6 m of the dividing line between Zone 3A and Zone 3B, Zone 3B rockfill shall be placed in layers having a maximum thickness of 300 mm after compaction. Segregated 3B material forming on the contact with Zone 3A shall routinely be removed prior to placing Zone 3A fill. 6.6.5 Rip rap and downstream protection (Zone 4 and 4A) 1) Material for rip rap shall have maximum weight of 225 kg, 40 to 50% to be more than 115 kg, 50 to 60% between 50 to 115 kg and 0 to 10% less than 50 kg. 2) Material for bedding of rip rap shall be geotextile. The geotextile shall be of at least 3mm thick non-woven, needle punctured geotextile and made of polyester fibres. The type of geotextile, installation procedures and overlap width of the panels should be submitted for approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) Zone 4A shall comprise of rockfill of maximum size 100 cm. D 25 shall not be less than 10 cm. 6.7 CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE AND TOLERANCES 1) The work on the concrete faced rockfill dam shall be completed in the following sequence, except where deviations are approved or directed by the Engineer-in- Charge, and this sequence shall form the basis for the Contractors detailed method statement and work programme: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 75
All required clearing, stripping, trimming of the area of the dam foundation, followed by excavation for the left bank and right bank colluviums slide debris material until native dense alluvial foundation and for the trench along the line of the cut-off wall. The overburden slope over the dam must be stable. Place a rockfill mass (zone 1B). Consolidation and curtain grouting. Construction of the cut-off wall. For the foundation area of the plinth wall of the concrete face (independently from the construction of the cut-off wall and the plinth across the valley floor), placing of slush grout and dental concrete over the exposed rock surface, where required, drilling and grouting of plinth anchors and then plinth construction. Embankment placing may be performed at the same time as, and independently of work on the cut-off wall (instrumentation shall be installed as shown in the Construction Drawings, and all test embankments have to be completed before embankment placing starts). Plinth concreting on the alluvium and terrace foundations across the valley floor. Embankment fill placing up to the level of the foundation of the parapet wall, the concrete extruded curb should be constructed at the same time as the fill. Construction of the parapet wall along the dam crest. Placing of remaining fill materials on the dam crest, up to specified camber levels. Face slab concreting on the upstream slope of the dam. Concreting of the connecting slabs between the plinth and cap of the cut-off wall. Surface targets installed on the dam as indicated in the Construction Drawings. 2) The completed rockfill embankment must reach the elevations specified by the contractual dates stipulated in the construction programme, and the Contractor shall assure that equipment, labour and materials, and the supply of the necessary embankment materials, in particular crushed filter and transition, are fully adequate to meet this construction schedule. Possible limitations in fill placement during monsoon months (generally between mid-J une to mid-October) shall be fully allowed for when preparing the construction schedule. 3) Embankment materials shall not be placed outside of the lines shown on the Construction Drawings or as amended by the Engineer-in-Charge, nor shall encroach into adjacent zones further than allowed within the tolerances specified below and measured on a horizontal plane perpendicular to the dam axis. Line Tolerance Toward dam axis Away from dam axis ______________________________________________________________ Dividing line between zones upstream of Dam axis: - Zone 1A Zero 500 mm - Zone 2A & 2 Zero Zero - Zone 2 & 3A 500 mm Zero - Zone 3A & 3B 500 mm Zero Dividing lines between zones downstream of Dam axis: - Zone 3B & 3C 1500 mm 1500 mm 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 76
Outside faces of dam embankment: - Zone 3C Zero 500 mm 4) Abrupt changes will not be permitted along the dividing planes between zones. The upstream face of Zone 2 shall be within 10 cm from the slope line shown on the Construction Drawings measured over a slope distance of 15 m in both directions. 5) During construction, the differential heights between adjacent zones at any cross- section of the embankment shall be within the following limits: Description Above Below ________________________________________________________ Elevation of Zone 2A above 2 Zero 300 mm Elevation of Zone 2 above the adjacent 3A Zero Zero Elevation of Zone 3A above adjacent zone 3B within 6 m of boundary of zone 3B 500 mm Zero
Larger differential heights between zones 3B and 3C may be permitted, subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge, provided that any slope shall not be steeper than 1.0 to 1.3h, the toe of the slope shall not be within 6 m of the division line and the top width of any intermediate fill stage shall not be less than 12 m. 6) The final elevations of the upper horizontal surfaces of the material zones shall be within the following tolerances, measured from the elevations shown on the Construction Drawings or as amended by the Engineer-in-Charge: Zone Above Below ________________________________________________________ Zone 1A and 1B 20 cm 0 cm Crest of dam 20 cm 0 cm 7) Where specifically approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, the Contractor may construct temporary construction haul roads within the compacted rockfill embankment with roadway gradient not exceeding 13% and with side slopes not steeper than 1:3. 6.8 FOUNDATION PREPARATION 6.8.1 General 1) The excavation of the foundation for the dam embankment shall be carried out, and the foundation prepared in accordance with the stipulations contained in the Section "Surface Excavation". The suitability of each part of the foundation for the embankment and the plinth will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) No embankment material shall be placed in any dam section until the foundation of this section has been dewatered, adequately prepared and approved by the Engineer-in- Charge. 6.8.2 Alluvium and terrace foundation 1) The estimated depth of the required excavation will be shown in the Construction drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Sand lenses and loose material shall be removed to the extent as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, and replaced with Zone 2 or Zone 3A material as directed. Compaction shall be made as defined for placement of Zone 2 and Zone 3 materials. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 77
3) No foundation surface shall have a slope steeper than 1V:1.5H, by cutting back, except where this requirement is waived by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4) Immediately before the foundation receives embankment, it shall be compacted with 6 passes of a 10 t vibrating roller or equivalent. 5) Isolated rock blocks and boulders bigger than 80 cm lying on Zone 3B and 3C foundations shall be broken into pieces by blasting or hammering. These rock fragments shall then be spread on the foundation and compacted as specified above. 6) Isolated rock blocks and boulders bigger than 30 cm lying on the foundation of Zone 3D shall be removed from the foundation. The removed material can be used in Zone 3B, 3C or 3D as appropriate. The prepared surface shall be compacted as specified above. 6.8.3 Rock foundation for plinth, filter (Zone 2) and transition (Zone 3A) 1) The plinth, filter and transition zone foundation plus an additional strip of about 0.2H subject to a minimum of 3 m under Zone 3B shall in general be slightly weathered rock or better. It shall be trimmed or backfilled with concrete to permit construction of the plinth on uniform slopes up to the dam abutments. 2) Trimming shall be performed in a manner which results in a reasonably undamaged foundation surface for the plinth concrete. Recesses shall be filled with dental concrete or concrete placed in conjunction with plinth concrete depending on the extent of excavation. 3) Erodible zones in the plinth foundation shall be thoroughly cleaned by appropriate means as specified for dental excavation and backfill. If an erodible zone fault / swarm of seam crosses the plinth foundation, it shall be cleaned and backfilled with dental concrete or shotcrete for a distance of 6 m or 1/3 hydraulic head, whichever is least, downstream of the plinth. These distances shall be measured from and perpendicular to the plinth reference line. 6.8.4 Rock foundation for Zones 3B, 3C, and 4A areas 1) The foundation for Zones 3B, 3C and 4A shall be stripped of overburden and loose rock with the objective to obtain a foundation equal or superior to the rockfill zone placed above. In general, the foundation surface of Zones 3B, 3C and 4A shall be equal or exceed the definition of "moderately weathered rock". 2) Seams and weathered zones shall be treated on case to case basis. Larger depressions and weathered areas shall be treated individually to the extent necessary to ensure that the foundation objective is obtained. 6.9 CONCRETE FACED ROCKFILL DAM 6.9.1 General 1) Dumping and spreading of embankment materials shall be carried out to the lines and slopes shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The setting-out of the limits of each dam zone shall be done by the Contractor. The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to modify these limits and/or make other changes in the theoretical cross-section of the dam if he deems it necessary due to design consideration, or for optimisation of the dam section or acceleration of the construction. 2) The placing methods and programmes shall be thoroughly planned based on the Contractors submittals and discussions between the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 78
3) Embankment material shall not be placed on any portion of the foundation until that portion has been inspected and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4) When so directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, the Contractor shall remove and dispose of unsuitable material placed in the embankment and material rendered unsuitable after being placed in the embankment. Material re-excavated from stockpiles for placement in the embankment will be subject to the same inspection and approval as materials obtained directly from the quarry or excavation. 5) In the event of slides or erosion in any part of the dam during construction, the Contractor shall remove material from the affected area, as directed by the Engineer- in-Charge, and shall rebuild such portion of the embankment. 6) Placement of embankment material will not be permitted when, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, there is insufficient illumination to permit proper quality control. 6.9.2 Compaction 1) The thickness of the layer, number of passes required, and the speed of compacting equipment for the different zones of the dam embankment shall be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge on the base of the test embankment. 2) The thickness of the layers indicates the thickness before the compaction. One pass is defined as one trip of the compacting equipment over the area to be compacted to ensure complete coverage of the entire surface of the layer, including approximately 20% of the area for overlaps. 3) Dumping, spreading, and compacting of embankment materials in the vicinity of concrete structures, items of instrumentation or other equipment shall be performed with adequate equipment and in such manner that no damage occurs to the concrete, instrumentation or other structures. Any damage shall be repaired by the Contractor at his own cost. 4) Unless directed otherwise by the Engineer-in-Charge, based on findings from the test embankment, compaction of dam embankment shall be as given in Table "Materials and Characteristics of Dam Fill" at the end of this Section. 6.9.3 Random fill (Zones 1A and 1B) 1) The material in Zone 1A shall be placed in layers of thickness not exceeding 40cm each compacted to at least 95% Standard Proctor. 2) The material in Zone 1B shall be placed in layers of thickness not exceeding 40 cm, each compacted by six (6) passes of the vibratory roller with a minimum weight of 10 t, or as required by the Engineer-in-Charge. The level of Zones 1B and 2 shall be maintained approximately equal during construction. 6.9.4 Construction of filter and transition zone (Zones 2 and 3A) 1) Material in Zones 2 and 3A shall be placed and spread in layers and compacted as specifed. The top levels of Zones 2 and 3A shall be kept about equal during placing. These zones shall also be placed at the same time as the adjacent Zone 3B embankment material, unless otherwise agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge. Moistening of these zones may be required to obtain a homogeneous, well compacted fill 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 79
2) Any Zone 3B material spilled on the transition zone shall be carefully removed before proceeding with compaction. Movement of plant across the transition zones and/or plinth will be permitted only at approved selected crossing places which, after use, shall be thoroughly cleaned. The Contractor shall obtain approval from the Engineer-in- Charge before proceeding with construction of the transition zone at cross-over points after use. 3) Where transition zone construction follows Zone 3B construction, care shall be exercised to ensure that the contact with Zone 3B material is completely compacted by performing vibratory roller passes immediately adjacent to the Zone 3B slope. 4) Compaction of the transition zone materials will have to achieve a percentage of the maximum possible degree of compaction. This percentage will be determined by means of settlement tests or density tests on the test embankments. During the construction of the filter and transition zones in the dam, time shall be allowed for carrying out the tests needed to confirm the compaction achieved. 5) In the areas where compaction by the vibratory roller is impracticable, special attention shall be given to the compaction of the zones. The material in such areas shall be placed in approximately 15 cm horizontal layers and compacted by mechanical plate compactors or approved special equipment to a density equal to that in the remainder of the zones. The Contractor shall propose a detailed method of placement and compaction of the transition material at the perimeter joint for approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. 6.9.5 Construction of rockfill (Zones 3B and 3C ) 1) The material in the rockfill zones shall be placed normally from one abutment to the other, in layers whose thickness does not exceed the values given in the table at the end of this Section, or as modified based on the results of tests on the trial embankment. Sluicing by at least 200 litres of water per cubic metre rockfill, or any other value which may be determined during the compaction tests, will be required. 2) The Zones 3B and 3C shall each be compacted by a minimum of six (6) passes of the 10 t vibratory roller; or any other number of passes as may be required by the Engineer-in-Charge based on the results of the test embankment. The un-compacted lift thickness shall not exceed 60 cm for Zone 3B and 120 cm for Zone 3C. 3) The vibratory roller shall not be operated at speeds in excess of 5 km/hour. As a general rule, the direction of rotation of the roller shall be reversed at the end of each completed pass. 4) The downstream face shall be accurately shaped to generate a neat appearance. The rocks of the Zone 3C on the downstream face shall be at least 0.5 m diameter and placed with high point to the design plane and protrude not more than 20 cm. Placement is to be made to one layer thickness above the existing layer surface. 6.9.6 Placing of rock boulders (Zone 4 and 4A) 1) These boulders shall be selected and placed by the most appropriate means to the lines, grades and tolerances shown on the construction drawings. No compaction will be required. 6.10 BACKFILL 6.10.1 General 1) The Contractor shall place and compact backfill of the specified type to the lines, grades and dimensions in the locations shown on the Construction Drawings, behind structures, in over break, over excavation, or where directed by the Engineer-in- Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 80
2) Material to be used as backfill shall be subject to the consent of the Engineer-in- Charge, and shall be, as far as possible, obtained from required excavation for Permanent or Temporary Works. 3) The distribution and gradation of backfill material shall be such that the finished backfill is free from lenses, pockets, streaks or layers of material differing substantially in texture or gradation from the surrounding material. Backfill material shall include no organic matter, and the Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to reject entire loads of material which contain high percentage of organic matter which can not be satisfactorily removed. 4) The traffic over the backfill shall be adequately controlled to avoid rutting or cutting the placed backfill. Each load of material shall be placed in such a way as to achieve the best practicable distribution of material. The operation of trucks and heavy equipment shall be restricted near buildings, walls, piers or other facilities to avoid damage to any Permanent Works. 5) Any material which, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge is objectionable or inadequate shall be removed to the Contractor's own cost. If the compacted surface of any layer of material is determined to be too smooth and impermeable to bond properly with the succeeding layer, it shall be loosened by harrowing or by other approved method before the succeeding layer is placed thereon. 6) Backfilling adjacent to the concrete structures 1m and over in height, shall not commence before 7 days from concrete placement. Prior to backfilling, forms shall be removed and the area cleaned of trash and debris. All Works to be covered by backfill shall be inspected and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge prior to start of backfilling. Backfill shall be placed in proper sequences so that no differential earth pressures occur on footings, pipes, or other structures. 7) Backfilling operations shall not be performed with frozen materials and lumps, and during low temperatures if the material will affect adversely the Works. 8) The Contractor shall maintain and protect the finished backfill in satisfactory conditions at all times until completion and acceptance of the Works. After backfilling operations have been finished and prior to finish grading, the Contractor shall slope the surfaces to prevent ponding of water. 6.10.2 Random backfill 1) Random backfill shall consist of earth and rockfill of unspecified gradation placed as it comes from excavations. It shall be placed and compacted in horizontal layers 20 to 50 cm of loose thickness, depending on equipment used. The final thickness will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The moisture content prior and during compaction shall be near the optimum moisture content distributed evenly throughout each layer of material. 3) Random backfill shall be compacted to at least 90% Standard Proctor in accordance with IS:2720. 4) Random backfill to be placed adjacent to structures shall be carefully placed to prevent any displacement or damage. Material to be placed within 1 m of the structure shall contain no material greater than 100 mm. 6.10.3 Free-draining backfill 1) Free-draining backfill material shall consist of a well graded mixture of sandy gravels and cobbles with a maximum particle size of 300 mm (except as stated below), and a maximum of 5% by weight passing U.S. Standard Sieve No.200 (0.075 mm). 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 81
2) Material to be placed within 1m of the structure shall contain no material greater than 100 mm. 3) Free-draining backfill shall be placed moist in layers not exceeding 500 mm, before compaction. It shall be compacted to 70% relative density as defined in IS:2720. 4) Free-draining backfill shall be compacted by vibratory rollers. Where backfill is required to be placed adjacent to structures or in other restricted areas, it shall be compacted by mechanical tampers or other approved method of compaction. 6.10.4 Sand-gravel backfill of trenches Reasonably well-graded sand and gravel shall be used for backfilling of trenches for pipes, cables, ducts, bedding for ditches, etc. The maximum particle size shall not exceed 75 mm and a maximum of 5% by weight passing U.S. Standard Sieve No. 200 (0.075 mm). The material shall be spread in layers of 200 mm and compacted by hand tamping. 6.11 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 6.11.1 General 1) Measurement and payment for the clearing, stripping, excavation, placing of shotcrete, grout and concrete will be made in accordance with the corresponding Sections of these Specifications. 2) No separate measurement and payment will be made for dewatering and keeping the foundation surface dry. 3) Foundation preparation: no extra measurement for payment will be made for the preparation of the foundations and protection or maintaining excavated surfaces in satisfactory conditions until the embankment fill is placed, including any temporary supports necessary to support the sides of the excavations. 4) Measurement and payment for the removal of unsuitable material from the foundation below or outside the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings or ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge, will be made as specified in the Section "Surface Excavation" for dental excavation. 5) In case the volume of backfill concrete which had to be placed in the foundation exceeds 0.5 m 3 per 1 m 2 of the foundation, as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, payment will be made as specified in the Section "Concrete" for backfill concrete in surface excavation. 6.11.2 CFRD and cofferdam embankment construction 1) Measurement for payment of the embankment materials will be made to the lines and grades shown on the Construction Drawings, or as adjusted by the Engineer-in- Charge, notwithstanding any variations from these lines as allowed by the tolerances specified in this Section. 2) Measurement for payment for the different zones of the dam embankment specified herein will be of the in-situ volume of the material placed and compacted in specified layers, and to the required densities, by the number of passes prescribed by the Engineer. 3) Camber on the crest of the dam, as shown on the Construction Drawings will be added to the measurement for payment. 4) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of, but not be limited to, the following: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 82
Provision of all labour, equipment, and materials required for the preparation, segregating, grading, blending and mixing, wetting or drying of the materials in order to obtain the required gradation, moisture content and other properties, Stockpiling if any, Loading the materials at the processing plants or stockpiles, Transport of materials from the sources, Provision of all labour, equipment and materials required for the placing, spreading, compacting, watering as needed for the embankment materials; dressing of the slopes, trimming, compacting and protecting the upstream dam face, Construction of test embankments, quality control and performance of testing as required, with exception as stipulated in the Section "Site Installations", Surveying, setting-out, checking of embankment profile and alignment, and any subsequent rectification works resulting from undue or incorrect surveys; provision of suitable equipment for, and delays caused due to carrying out this work. 5) If the Engineer determines that, with the equipment used, more passes are required to obtain an appropriate compaction of the fill, he may order the Contractor to execute additional passes with the compacting equipment. Such additional passes will not be paid separately. 6.11.3 Backfill 1) Measurement and payment for the different types of backfill will be of the in-situ volume of material placed and compacted if required. 2) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the supply of material, placing, and compacting as specified. 6.11.4 Exclusions 1) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following: Extra work caused by the Contractor's negligence in setting-out the structures and slopes, Rectification, removal and replacement of the materials which during the placement or afterwards have been frozen, contaminated with foreign matter, mixed with materials from other zones, or lost due to erosion, Extra work or material required to repair damages to the temporary or final surfaces caused by the erosion or travel of the construction equipment, Increase of quantities caused by settlement resulting from the consolidation of the embankment during the construction, Damage and repair to the concrete structures caused by Contractor's operations. 2) No adjustment to the Unit Price entered in the Schedule will be made due to variation of the division lines between the various zones.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 83
MATERIALS AND CHARACTERISTICS OF DAM FILL Summary of material properties and placement guidelines
Material Description & Size Zone Method of Placement Compaction Data Random Fill Semi-pervious to impervious 1A Spreading compacted to 95% Standard Proctor Random Fill Processed alluvial 1B Uncompacted lift thickness: 40 cm 6 passes with 10t vibratory roller Filter Crushed unweathered Max. size 76 mm 2 Uncompacted lift thickness: 30 cm 6 passes with 10t vibratory roller. See Specs. for slope compaction Concrete Sand Sand 2A Uncompacted lift thickness: 30 cm 6 passes with 10t vibratory roller. Transition Slightly weathered or better processed Max. size 20 cm 3A Uncompacted lift thickness: 30 cm; Placement together with Zone 2 6 passes with 10t vibratory roller. Compacted Rockfill Rockfill Max. size 60 cm 3B Uncompacted lift thickness: 60 cm
6 passes with 10t vibratory roller Compacted Rockfill Rockfill Max. size 80 cm 3C Uncompacted lift thickness: 120cm
6 passes with 10t vibratory roller. Transition Natural of Processed 3D Uncompacted lift thickness: 40 cm;
6 passes with 10t vibratory roller. Uncompacted Rockfill Selected Rip Raps Min. size 1.0 m 4 & 4A Placed None 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 84
APPENDIX TEST EMBANKMENT Introduction (i) A test embankment will be constructed in an area proposed by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. If the area is located within the downstream shell, two separate test fields shall be made, one for Zones 2/3A and one for Zones 3B/3C. The boundaries in the test fields shall correspond to the boundaries of the area. The objectives of such an embankment are the following: to assess the performance of the compaction equipment; to verify the design layer thickness, the selected number of passes of the compaction equipment and the appropriate amount of water required for placement; to determine the density and gradation of the compacted fill. (ii) The fill material will be placed as received from excavation or from a stockpile. (iii) The test fill will consist of an embankment comprising the Zones 2, 3A, 3B and 3C with material obtained from the required excavation for the Permanent or Temporary Works. The four test zones are distinguished by different materials. Measurements will comprise settlement observations after spreading a lift and during compaction. In-situ density and permeability tests will be performed after placement of two layers. (iv) Should required excavation reveal that moderately weathered materials occur in very significant quantities, the Engineer-in-Charge may order that the test embankment be doubled in size to test placement of these materials. (v) The test embankment performed in the downstream shell area shall become part of the finished main dam, unless all or part of it is specifically ordered to be removed by the Engineer- in-Charge. Thus test holes and trenches shall be backfilled, and other aspects of embankment construction maintained in accordance with the Construction Specifications. Lifts (i) The test embankment has four main zones corresponding to the different materials to be tested. There are four lifts in each section with thicknesses as defined in table below. Layer Thickness of Test Zones Lift No. Zone 2 Zone 3A Zone 3B Zone 3C (cm) (cm) (cm) (cm) 4 50 50 100 120 3 50 50 100 120 2 40 40 80 100 1 40 40 80 100 (ii) Settlements for each layer shall be measured initially and after the 2nd, 4th, 6th, 8th, and 10th roller passes. Construction Procedure (i) The first step is to create an even surface on which the test embankment can be built on. The location of the embankment will be in the main dam area and all overburden shall be stripped in accordance with the Construction Specification. Unweathered rockfill material corresponding to Zones 2, 3A, 3B, and Zone 3C (as indicated on the Dam Drawings for the subject locations) shall be employed to smooth out the uneven ground surface. This backfill shall be compacted in lifts with thicknesses defined in above Table and compacted with up to 10 passes of a 10 t vibratory roller at a speed of 3 to 3.5 km/h maximum. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 85
(ii) In areas initially inaccessible to the roller, a vibratory plate compactor, weighing about 0.6 to 0.8 t shall be used. The levelled base area should have a size of not less than 70 x 76 m unless limited by available space. Its surface should not deviate by more than 15 cm from the average elevation. (iii) After preparation of the base area, the rockfill shall be placed in specified lifts. The test fill is divided in two Fields; in Field I, water amounting to 100 l/m3 of rockfill shall be applied; whereas, in Field II 300 l/m3 water shall be applied to the rockfill. Dumping of the base rockfill shall be such that it falls on the layer being placed near the forward edge. Usually, the final surface of a layer should not deviate by more than 10 cm from the average thickness. (iv) After completely spreading a lift by the bulldozer, a single coverage of the tractor and vibratory roller with the vibrating mechanism disengaged is made over the entire surface of the layer. This step smoothes out the surface and to moves the top most stones into stable positions. A grid of measuring points is then laid out on each test zone. Measurements shall not be taken closer than 3 m from any outside edge. Measurement points shall be marked by an easily visible colour, such as orange or yellow. (v) Rolling will done in such a way that each lane receives the same number of passes. There shall be an overlap between adjacent lanes of about 20%. Sufficient space must be made available beyond the ramp areas so that the roller can manoeuvre outside the test areas. Each lift shall be rolled by a total of ten passes and with a speed of 3.5 - 5 km/h. The frequency of vibration of the roller shall be checked during rolling, for example by a reed tachometer. Testing programme for the test enbankment (i) The following tests are proposed to assess the performance of the test embankment, and are described subsequently: settlement monitoring gradation tests effect of compaction on particle size tests in-situ density tests permeability tests trench excavation Settlement Monitoring (i) The settlement of the fill is observed by levelling from a point from which all the grid points of a test zone can be seen. The datum bench mark shall be located on sound rock. The grid points are best marked by spray paint. They shall be properly numbered. The initial level readings, (R o ) are taken after the first levelling pass with the roller (without vibration) and after the grid points have been marked. In order to obtain representative readings the rod is set on a 30 cm square steel plate with a hemisphere at its centre on which the rod can be held. This plate shall be carried from point to point by the rod man. (ii) After the initial reading, the grid system shall be surveyed after two, four, six, eight, and ten passes of the roller, respectively. When necessary, fresh paint shall be sprayed on the grid points. The readings shall be recorded on a data sheet. For computing average settlements, those values which indicate negative settlement shall not be taken into account. The results shall be plotted on a separate graph for each test zone. Each graph shall show a series of four curves (one per lift) indicating cumulative settlement in percentage versus number of compaction passes. Gradation tests Particle Gradation of Rockfill 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 86
(i) The gradation of the fill materials shall be determined after compaction by the probable number of passes to be specified, as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge based on results of compaction of the first three lifts. (ii) The holes created by taking the samples for the second and third layers shall be backfilled and recompacted before placing the following layer. The same applies to the fourth layer if the test embankment is kept as part of the main dam. (iii) From the 2nd and 4th layer and each material zone (but only for the 100 l/m3 Field I), one test pit shall be excavated and the following tests shall be performed: Excavate down to 1/3 layer thickness, weigh the material, make gradation test and measure volume of hole (i.e. to obtain the density of the fill). Perform gradation test. Deepen the hole down to the next layer (i.e. the bottom 2/3 of the layer), and perform the gradation and density tests again. Fill the hole with clean water and perform the falling head permeability test (iv) Rock pieces 15 cm in size and less shall be separated by screening bins, while pieces larger than 15 cm shall be measured by appropriate means. A sieve shaker must be used to separate the fractions passing the 76 mm, 38 mm, 19 mm screens and the No. 4 (4.75 mm) sieve, respectively. The results of the gradation tests shall be plotted as particle diameter versus percentage passing. Effect of Compaction on Rockfill Gradation (i) Two large gradation tests each for Zones 3B and 3C shall be performed to measure the effect of compaction on the percentage of material passing the 38 mm screen. The percentage of the material in the sample passing the 38 mm screen shall be measured before placement. The entire sample except for oversized rock shall be remixed and spread on a convenient hard surface in a layer about 0.6 m thick and large enough for compaction by the vibratory roller. A layout and programme for this test shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for review before this test is carried out. After levelling and four passes of the roller, the entire sample shall be retrieved and screened once more to measure the percentage passing the 38 mm screen. The difference in percentage passing before and after compaction will provide a guide to permit routine gradation testing on quarry material instead of material taken from the completed rockfill embankment. (ii) In the course of establishing a working procedure for placement, levelling, and compaction of Zones 2 and 3A material, gradation tests shall be performed on samples of material both before and after compaction in order to establish the effect of compaction on gradation of the material. Zone 2 material shall be sampled only after both normal and slope compaction is completed. (iii) A testing method shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for review before the tests are conducted. Number of tests are listed in Table A.1. Additional tests may be directed by the Engineer-in-Charge if 1) results are inconsistent or 2) if there is evidence that the test method is inadequate. The test results shall be used to allow routine sampling of stockpiled materials for gradation control rather than samples taken from the completed embankment. In-Situ Density Tests (i) In-situ density and gradation shall be determined after completing compaction of the 2nd and 4th layer for each material zones of the test embankment. Each test sample for Zone 3B and 3C shall be at least 2.0 to 3.0 m3 in volume, whereas samples of Zone 2 and 3A shall have a volume of 0.5 m3. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 87
(ii) The Contractor shall propose a procedure for performing the in-situ density test for approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. In-situ density is computed from the weight and volume of the rock sample tested. When the in-situ density test is completed the gradation of the sample tested shall be determined according to "Particle Gradation of Rockfill" of this Annex. In-situ density tests shall be made at selected locations. Trench Excavation (i) After completing the in-situ density and gradation tests; a trench about 2 m depth in Zone 2 and 3A, 3 m depth in Zone 3B, and 4 m in Zone 3C shall be opened parallel to the longitudinal axis of the test embankment. This trench will give information on the segregation of fines, the bond between lifts and the interlocking between individual pieces of rock. The trench shall also show the contact zones between Zones 2 and 3A, Zones 3A and 3B, and Zone 3B and 3C materials. (ii) The condition of the faces exposed in the trench shall be described and unusual features mapped. The observations shall be complemented by photographs. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 88
TABLE A.1 - SUMMARY OF TESTING PROGRAMME FOR TEST EMBANKMENT
Type of test Location or source Frequency of measurement Total number of observations or tests Settlement observation: Grid point on top of each lift Initially after placing and smoothing, and after 2,4,6,8 and 10 passes respectively 2 x 36 x 6 x 4 =1728 Particle gradation (only field for 100 l/m3) 1/3 top layer: 2nd and 4th lifts one for each zone 4 x 2 =8 2/3 bottom layer: 2nd and 4th lifts one for each zone 4 x 2 =8 In-situ density (only field for 100 l/m3) 1/3 top layer: 2nd and 4th lifts one for each zone 4 x 2 =8 2/3 bottom layer: 2nd and 4th lifts one for each zone 4 x 2 =8 Trench: Along longitudinal axis of test embankment -- Length about 53 m or as specified by the Engineer- in-Charge Effect of compaction on rockfill gradation: see "Effect of Compaction on Rockfill Gradation" see "Effect of Compaction on Rockfill Gradation" see "Effect of Compaction on Rockfill Gradation"
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 89
7 DRILLING AND GROUTING 7.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) The work under this Section includes all labour, materials, equipment, operations and services required for the execution of drillholes, water-pressure test, performance of grouting in the holes from surface and from the underground construction sites, at locations shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The following grouting activities shall be required to be executed in underground works : a) Contact grouting in all concrete lined tunnels. This contact grouting is performed to fill the voids between concrete lining and the surrounding rock b) Contact grouting in steel lined tunnels between backfill concrete and rock. c) Contact grouting between concrete and rock surface in tunnel plugs. d) Consolidation grouting in head race tunnel near adit junctions and other identified locations with poor geology. e) Consolidation grouting in desilting basins f) Consolidation grouting in shafts. g) Consolidation grouting during excavation process in tunnels / shafts / caverns when geological conditions so require. h) Curtain grouting in plinth, below cut-off wall and around tunnel plugs (3) The following grouting activities shall be required to be executed in surface works: a) Consolidation grouting for surface excavations for dam, inlet and outlet portals of various tunnels and adits, when geological conditions so require. b) Consolidation grouting of dam foundations and foundations of the other structures. c) Curtain grouting for dam, below cut-off wall d) Grouting below cofferdam. (4) The following drainage activities shall be required to be executed in underground works: a) Drainage holes (pressure relief holes) in desilting basins, concrete lined tunnels and shafts to drain water behind concrete lining. b) Drainage holes required during tunneling activity. (5) The following drainage activities shall be required to be executed in surface works a) Drainage holes (pressure relief holes) for surface excavation. 6) The following exploratory drilling shall be required: a) Probe holes during tunnel excavation with or without coring b) Exploratory holes with or without coring in rock 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 90
c) Exploratory holes with or without coring in overburden 7) Holes for instrumentation: Holes for instrumentation shall include those required for installation of single point and multiple point borehole extensometers in surface slopes, desilting basins caverns or any other location 8) Scope of work also includes regular professional advice from competent external agencies to supplement Contractors own skills for grouting works of various types required under these specifications. 7.2 SUBMITTALS 7.2.1 Drilling (1) Prior to the start of drilling (and/or grouting work) in any one working area, the Contractor shall provide notice of and make available to the Engineer-in-Charge a drilling and/or grouting plan, with 56 days time for review. Once work has commenced and as the local sub-surface conditions are disclosed, the drilling and/or grouting plan may have to be modified accordingly on the basis of consultation with and direction by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall be prepared and equipped for variations in the drilling and grouting work. (2) The Contractor shall make drilling logs and other pertinent information available to the Engineer-in-Charge on completion of each work phase and as needed during the work. (3) The Contractor shall provide notice of, and make available to the Engineer-in-Charge reports giving the results of each water-pressure test performed within one working day of the end of the shift in which the tests were carried out. The reports shall contain complete records of the execution of the test as described in this Section. (4) The Contractor shall provide to the Engineer-in-Charge (prior to scheduled use in the field) documentation of the effects on the grouting mixture of any additive proposed for use in the drilling water, and no additives shall be used without prior approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) Within 24 hours of completion of any drilling with core recovery, the Contractor shall submit, in duplicate, a technical log of the drillhole in a form approved by the Engineer- in-Charge. The log shall be in accordance with IS:4464 and shall include the following data: a) Date of beginning and end of drilling, b) Drillhole number, c) Location, ground surface elevation, coordinates, inclination, direction, and length of drillhole, d) Type and diameter of drilling bit and core barrel used, make of drilling rig and length and diameter of casing, if used, e) Elevation of ground water levels encountered, including dates and times of measurement, f) Results of leakage tests and other drillhole tests, if any, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 91
g) A record of the drillers observations on progress of drilling, rate of penetration, speed and uniformity of rotation of bit, action of the drill rig such as jerky, smooth, rough, steady, etc., h) Length of each core run and the length, or percentage, or both of the core recovered and location and cause of core losses, i) Any changes in the character of the drilling water or mud, and in case the drilling water was lost (partly or totally), the elevation or depth when this happened, j) A simple drillers interpretation and description of the nature of the formation encountered as the drilling progress, k) Location and nature of cavities, seams, cracks, soft or broken rock, whether filled or open, and any other observation which could give information in connection with the purpose of exploratory drilling, l) Names of drillers and inspectors. (6) Geological logging shall be performed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall employ a well qualified, experienced geologist at each location/work site. When required by the Engineer-in-Charge the Contractor shall provide assistance during core logging, and in particular with handling of core boxes and cleaning of cores. (7) Colour photographs of the core boxes from each drillhole shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge in 3 copies within 10 days from the completion of the drillhole. (8) The Contractor shall submit reports in duplicate giving the results of each water- pressure test performed, within 24 hours of the end of the shift in which the tests were carried out. The reports shall contain the following: a) Location and number of drillhole, b) Date and time of test performance, c) Type of test, d) Pressure readings and water levels before and after testing, e) Packer rod characteristics and depth of packer(s), f) Total injected water volume and rate per minute and per linear meter of hole for various pressures applied. A plot showing water take versus increasing and decreasing pressure shall be prepared and both data and plot shall be submitted, g) Description of all surface water leaks indicating the distance and approximate quantity. (9) Should the Contractor intend to use a water-soluble additive to drilling water, he shall submit a notification and a sample of the additive to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval at least 15 days prior to being used. 7.2.2 Grouting (1) At least 56 days prior to the start of the grouting works, the Contractor shall submit for approval fully detailed proposals and a detailed layout of his proposed arrangements for grouting, including specifications of all equipment, tools and all grouting materials to 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 92
be used, and qualification and experience of the proposed personnel, and extent of technical support from external agencies. (2) An overall grouting program shall be drawn up jointly between the Contractor and the Engineer-in-Charge. Grouting mixes, pressures, pumping rates, and sequencing will be selected, subject to modifications, to meet local conditions encountered during the performance of the work. Grouting works shall be planned in such a manner that they can be carried out according to the approved plan concurrently with other activities. Modifications to the grouting program shall be implemented as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) Prior to each phase of grouting, the Contractor shall submit for approval a detailed program for the particular grouting works along with information relating to the methods he proposes to use and details of grout mixes. No grouting work shall be executed without prior written approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) During the performance of the grouting works, the Contractor shall keep complete daily records of all grouting operations. These grouting records shall be compiled on an approved form and shall be submitted weekly to the Engineer-in-Charge. Results of water pressure tests and grout takes shall be presented in tabular form as well as graphically. The records shall contain all the information as per guidelines of IS:6066 - 1994, and shall include the following: a) Number and location of the drillholes, b) Results of water-pressure tests, c) Grouting method, d) Date and time of commencement of grouting and of each change in grouting operations, e) Rate of pumping, f) Grouting pressures and gauge reference number, g) Water-cement ratio and its variations, h) Separate quantities of cement, sand, bentonite, fly ash, admixtures and chemicals used, i) Connections, if any, with other holes and cracks, as well as any surface leakage of water or grout; crack location, how it was caulked and the success of caulking shall be described and approximate station and offset of each surface leak shall be recorded where it occurs in the dam foundation, j) Number of holes and depth of holes left for redrilling, k) Time of completion, l) Name of the foreman in charge. (5) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to require any additional information deemed necessary to be included in the documents to be submitted. 7.3 DEFINITIONS GROUTING is defined as injecting a mixture of cement and water with the addition of admixtures, sand, bentonite, and fly ash, if required, or similar approved mixture under pressure into overburden or rock mass or between rock/concrete contact through a system of boreholes by means of a pump designed for such a purpose. Cement grouts are subdivided as under: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 93
- Unstable mixtures are simple suspensions of cement in water. These suspensions are only homogeneous as long as they are in movement and the sedimentation starts as soon as the movement is stopped. - Stable mixtures are colloidal suspension dissolved in water in which grain size is so small that no appreciable sedimentation occurs during the grouting operation. These suspensions are obtained by high speed mixing of cement with addition of bentonite. - Thixotropic mixtures. When percentage of bentonite in the stable mixture in increased, the mixture becomes thixotropic. Thixotropy is the property of denser stable bentonite suspensions to form gel when left at rest. ZONE is part of the impervious curtain grouting or consolidation grouting where all the drillholes have the same depth or the same inclination or where a level for the depths of holes is specified. In a zone, Engineer-in-Charge may adjust and drillholes as required by the topographical and geological conditions to ensure a continuous grouting curtain. STAGE is a section of a drillhole in which grouting or water pressure testing is performed. PACKER GROUTING consists of drilling a hole to its full depth in a single operation, cleaning and washing, water-pressure testing if required and grouting the hole in successive stages in any desired sequence of section which are isolated by use of packers from the ungrouted sections. This method shall generally be used. STAGE GROUTING consists of drilling and grouting a hole by stages. First a hole is drilled to a limited depth, cleaned, subjected to water pressure tests if required and then grouted. J ust after the initial set of grout, the hole is cleaned by washing or by other appropriate means. Then the hole is drilled to another limited depth, cleaned, subjected to water pressure tests if required and grouted and so continued in successive stages until satisfactorily grouted to its full depth. This method is to be used only when directed by Engineer-in-Charge. FULL DEPTH GROUTING means that each hole is drilled to the full desired depth, washed, pressure tested and grouted in one operation. This method is usually limited to short holes 5 m or less or holes up to 10 m that have only small cracks and joints and there is no risk of surface leakage. SPLIT SPACING consists of progressively closing curtain or consolidation grouting by drilling and grouting holes midway between holes which have previously been drilled and grouted. The spacing between primary and secondary holes may vary from one zone to another depending upon geological conditions encountered. CONSOLIDATION GROUTING is the drilling of shallow holes and grouting of the rock in foundation of the dam, spillway, intake and in rock surrounding the tunnels and shafts. CURTAIN GROUTING is the grouting executed to form a continuous impervious wall. In principle, this curtain shall consist of a single row of holes divided into zones of variable depths, inclinations and spacing. CONTACT GROUTING is drilling and grouting at low pressures required to fill the voids between concrete and rock surface or between concrete and steel lining. OPEN END WASHING is the process of cleaning drill cuttings and sludge from a drillhole by injecting water or water and air at the bottom of the hole and returning the fluid and suspended matter to the top of the hole. GROUTING PRESSURE shall mean the pressure of grout injection as measured at the nearest pressure gauge near collar of hole while the grout is being pumped into the hole. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 94
EFFECTIVE PRESSURE shall mean the actual pressure of grout at the packer end, taking into consideration the difference of elevation between the packer end and the nearest pressure gauge or the water table. SUCCESSFUL CONNECTION means the completion of all operations necessary to achieve a proper seating of a packer assembly that can sustain the required pressure without leakage or loss of pressure during pressure water testing or grouting to refusal. GROUT TAKE OR GROUT ABSORPTION is the quantity of materials injected in a hole expressed in units of kg of dry cement/bentonite and of sand. WATER CEMENT RATIO is the ratio of the mass of water to the mass of cement. 7.4 EQUIPMENT 7.4.1 Drilling Equipment (1) All drilling equipment used shall be of a type, capacity and mechanical condition capable of performing the drilling required under this Contract, and shall be subject to the approval of Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Contractor shall have sufficient drilling rigs at the Site for the timely completion of the Works. The drilling rigs shall be in good operating condition and adequate for the satisfactory progress of the work. Combustion engines for operation of drilling equipment will not be permitted for underground work. (3) Drilling equipment shall be capable of drilling at any angle, upward or downward, and shall have the following capacity: - Exploratory holes up to 100 m, - Dam grouting curtain up to 150 m, - Consolidation and impermeabilization grouting up to 20 m, (4) Standard drilling equipment of the rotary and percussion type shall be used to perform the drilling as specified herein or as required by the Engineer-in-Charge. Percussion drilling equipment shall be equipped with a water swivel for continuous flushing of the holes during drilling. (5) The Engineer-in-Charge may require some of the grout holes and pressure relief holes to be drilled using rotary type drills with core recovery. The rotary type machines shall be capable of drilling NX size holes utilising double tube core barrels equivalent and capable of recovering soft or friable materials with maximum possible core recovery. The equipment and crew shall be made available at site when Engineer-in-Charge requires exploratory holes to be drilled. All such cores shall be properly stored in wooden boxes and logged for inspection as per the Indian Standard. (6) The drilling units shall be mobile and of size suitable to the dimensions of the galleries. (7) The Contractor shall keep at the Site an ample supply of different types and sizes of drilling bits to allow optimal drilling in the different materials to be encountered in the course of work, and sufficient rods and casings of various diameters to allow proper telescoping and to ensure the stability of drillholes. (8) The Contractor shall provide measuring equipment for checking the actual inclination and alignment of drillholes. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 95
7.4.2 Grouting Equipment (1) Only modern, properly operating grouting equipment approved by the Engineer-in- Charge and operated by trained and experienced crew shall be used for the performance of the work. This shall be specifically observed when dealing with chemical products. (2) The grouting equipment required to carry out the work shall include mixers, grout pumps, packers, pipes, grout lines, fittings, pressure gauges, telephones, lighting circuits, trolley grout platforms and miscellaneous supplies. Sufficient grouting equipment shall be provided to meet the construction schedule and each plant shall be capable of satisfactorily supplying, mixing, stirring, pumping and injecting grout mixes of various viscosities as specified herein. The equipment shall be maintained in good operating condition at all times and any grout hole that is lost or damaged due to mechanical failure of equipment or inadequate delivery of grout shall be replaced by another grout hole by Contractor at no additional cost to Owner. (3) The grouting equipment for mixing and placing the grout shall be such as to provide a continuous circulation of grout throughout the system and to permit accurate volume and pressure control. It shall be capable of effectively mixing and stirring the grout and forcing it into the hole in a continuous uninterrupted flow at any desired pressure up to the maximum required grouting pressure for a flow rate of 150 litre/min. (4) Grout pumps shall be of the progressive cavity type and shall be capable of pumping at least 150 litres/min of grout at a maximum discharge pressure of 1,700 kPa (1.7 N/mm2). (5) Grout mixers shall have a minimum capacity of 0.5 m 3 and shall be mechanically operated horizontal paddle type or preferably colloidal high speed impeller type. Facilities shall be provided at the mixer for the accurate measurement of grout materials so that mix proportions can be carefully controlled. (6) Sump or holding tanks having a minimum capacity of 0.5 m 3 shall be mechanically operated and designed to keep the mixed grout agitated and in suspension. All grout should be discharged from the mixer into the agitator and from the agitator into the pump panel through a 2.36 mm screen to remove lumps and large particles. (7) Water meters shall be calibrated in litres and tenths of liters without by pass so that water can be measured directly in the mixer. A strainer with cleaning valve shall be provided in the water supply line, upstream of the meter to prevent sand and abrasive particles from entering the meters. (8) Pressure gauges of the approved make shall be of such calibration to cover a range of pressures from 0 to 0.5 N/mm 2 (500 kPa) and from 0 to 1.5 N/mm 2 (1500 kPa), An adequate number of spare gauges shall be provided at each grout plant. Contractor shall provide a standard master gauge against which all other gauges shall be checked periodically for accuracy and satisfactory operation. All the pressure gauges shall be numbered for identification. (9) Packers shall be capable of effectively sealing the grout holes at the specified elevation and shall be capable of withstanding without leakage pressures up to the maximum grouting pressure. The type of packer to be used shall be of the pneumatically expanded rubber sleeve type. Double packer assemblies separated by up to 3 m of perforated pipe shall also be provided. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 96
(10) A double line circulating system shall be used and the inside diameter of all lines, walls and connections shall be not less than 25 mm. Hoses and supply lines shall be capable of withstanding pressure 50% greater than those specified for grouting. (11) Grouting headers shall be provided for feeding grout into the holes. The header shall include a supply connection, a connection with a valve to the hole, and a return line with valve. Two number of approved make pressure gauges for the appropriate pressure range shall be installed. One shall be installed to indicate the pressure of the supply at the pump and the other to measure the back pressure at the hole. (12) Contractor shall furnish, install, maintain and operate satisfactory communication system between grout plants and the holes being grouted regardless of grout area locations. (13) Contractor shall supply sufficient operating personnel, supervisors, labour, spare tools, to carry out each phase of the work properly and expeditiously. (14) The grouting units shall be mobile and of size suitable to the dimensions of the galleries/drifts. 7.4.3 Water Pressure Testing Equipment (1) The washing and water-pressure testing equipment shall include pumps, piping, pressure gauges, valves, seal assemblies and all other accessories, necessary to perform the Work. (2) The Contractor shall provide a sufficient number of complete sets of pressure testing equipment (with spares) to allow simultaneous testing at the various drilling and/or grouting locations. (3) The pumps furnished shall be of the gear, centrifugal, or other acceptable types, with a minimum output of not less than 0.28 m3/min at 1.5 N/mm2 (1500 kPa) gauge pressure and shall be capable of maintaining constant pressure. (4) The Contractor shall supply water storage tanks sufficient for the pumps in addition to flow meters and pressure gauges for calibration and checking. (5) Water-meters and pressure gauges shall be calibrated and certified by an independent laboratory prior to installation at the Site and shall be subject to periodic verification. One pressure gauge and one water-meter shall, after independent checking, remain at the disposal of the Engineer-in-Charge for further checking purposes. The Contractor may be requested to establish, by way of tests, correction graphs for pressure losses occurring in the pipes. Pressure gauges shall be installed directly at the collar of the drillhole. 7.4.4 Embedded Pipes and Fittings for Grouting (1) Standard mild steel pipes and fittings for grouting shall be set in the rock and concrete as the Engineer-in-Charge may direct, or where shown on the Drawings. The pipes and fittings embedded in concrete shall be cleaned thoroughly of all dirt, grease, grout and mortar immediately before embedding and shall be firmly held in position and protected from damage or displacement while the concrete is being placed. A standard coupling and nipple wrapped to facilitate eventual removal shall be attached to the grout pipe where embedded in concrete. No portion of the pipe shall be allowed to remain within 50 mm of the concrete surface and the resulting recess, after removal of the pipe or fitting, shall be filled with dry-pack mortar. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 97
(2) Care shall be taken to avoid premature blockage of pipes. Any pipe that becomes blocked before completion of operations shall be cleaned out in a satisfactory manner or replaced by the Contractor. 7.5 SITE LABORATORY (1) The Contractor shall have a laboratory specially equipped for studies and tests relative to drilling and grouting works available on the Site. The laboratory shall be manned by experienced laboratory assistant(s) familiar with conventional grout tests. (2) In addition to the usual general laboratory equipment such as scales, oven, permeability meter and the like, it shall be equipped with : - A multi-speed laboratory mixer, - A Marsh test cone, - A mould for pressure testing the above cubes, variable from 0 to 2 tons, - A set of sieves for grain size analysis of fines, - Conventional laboratory glassware, including 1 litre beakers and test tubes, thermometers and aerometers, and Atterberg limit measuring cups, - A Baroid scale type mud density meter. (3) The Engineer-In-Charge shall be given free access to the laboratory and shall be entitled to carry out any studies and measurements he deems necessary. (4) The Contractor shall prepare and test the trial mixes as directed by the Engineer-in- Charge at least 28 days before commencement of any grouting. Materials for use in grout mixes shall be tested for compliance with the applicable requirements stipulated in "Materials" of this Section. Tests shall be performed on the grout mixes proposed for use in the Works, to establish the consistencies in mixes, practical mixing ratios, initial and final setting times, and such other properties as may affect the quality of the grout. (5) During the actual grouting operations the Contractor shall carry out tests on grout mixes at the same time as grouting, and shall plot values of viscosity, sedimentation limits, compressive strength, and maximum viscosity possible for the grouting on a diagram. The frequency of testing will be once for each grouting job site or until acceptance criteria have been met. However, if a significant change in the cement source occurs, sampling and testing must be repeated and the new mix approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 7.6 GROUTING MATERIALS (1) Water used for all drilling, washing and water testing and as an ingredient of grout mixtures shall be fresh, clean and free from deleterious amounts of silt, organic matter, alkali, acids, salts, oil and other impurities. (2) Cement used in the grout mixes shall be PPC cement. Fine cement (Blaine surface area 3500 cm 2 /gm) may be specified during the course of work for curtain grout, if so required. (3) Whenever sand is added to the grout mix, it shall consist of clean, hard and durable particles free from lumps or clay and objectionable foreign matter. A supply of 5 cubic metres of sand shall be kept in proximity of the work at all times. Sand shall conform to the following grading requirement: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 98
Sieve size (mm) Percentage passing by weight 2.360 100 1.800 95-100 0.600 60-85 0.300 30-50 0.150 10-30 0.075 0-5 (4) Bentonite may be required in grout mixes. The bentonite used shall be conforming to IS:12584. (5) Approved admixtures shall be used by Contractor in the grout mix to optimise the strength, viscosity, density, decantation, setting time and shrinkage. Only admixtures proved by testing prior to the start of grouting may be used, when approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Manufacturer's certificates or guarantees will not be accepted as relieving the Contractor of his responsibility for the suitability of any admixture. (6) Approved quality Micro Fine Cement shall be used to achieve best possible penetration in the First Stage of grouting. Furthermore, the chosen micro fine cement shall have rapid hardening properties. The standard mix to be utilized of microfine cement grout shall have a water : cement ratio of 1:1 with the dosage of a special dispersing agent. Technical Data i) Fineness (Blaine) >15000 cm2/gram ii) Water/ Cement Ratio 1:1 at 20 degree Centigrade iii) Initial Set (Measured by Vicat Needle) 60 120 iv) Final Set (1 mm penetration by Vicat needle) 120 -150 min v) Marsh Cone Time 32 34 sec vi) Grain Size character (D 95 ) 16 mm vii) Bleeding Maximum 1% (7) The Contractor shall handle, store and protect all cement and additives in such a manner that these materials will not be subject to deterioration or contamination. Deteriorated or contaminated materials shall not be used in the Works. 7.7 GROUT MIXES 7.7.1 Selection of Grout type : Following table shall be used as a general guidance only for selection of grout type for a particular application which may or may not occur at this project and may require other additives to be determined during grout optimisation process: Type of grouting Objective Ground Characteristics Grouting Compounds 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 99
Contact grouting in tunnels Void filling Pure cement slurries (w/c ratio <0.8%) Consolidation grouting in tunnels and to assist excavation
Strength Narrow or wide joints and fissures filled with sand or clay Pure cement slurry Wide empty joints or fissures high permeability Thick stabilized cement suspensions Injected grout leaks into adjoining open holes. Inflowing water in fissures Thick Thixotropic suspensions (bentonite added for thixotropy) Crushed rock injected grout leaks to the surface Thick thixotropic suspension with fine sand added, additives for quick setting (if required) Curtain grouting in plinth and below cut-off wall, around tunnel plugs
Fine interconnected fissures, medium to low permeability Thick cement or Cement-bentonite suspensions Impermeability Rock containing many narrow interconnected fissures large permeability Stabilized cement bentonite suspensions Highly fractured rock high permeability Thick cement suspensions with some fine or medium sand, addition of bentonite for thixotropy 7.7.2 Pure Cement Slurries (1) Water/cement slurry mixes are defined in terms of the W/C (water/cement) ratio by weight. (2) High-turbulence mixing of these slurries shall last at least two minutes after pouring of the full cement weight into the mixer. 7.7.3 Use of bentonite in cement suspension grout Preferred rate of sedimentation of a grout suspension is below 10%. Normal grout mixes dont meet this requirement when the water cement ratio is more than 0.8 To meet the requirement of sedimentation rate below 10%, the grout suspension must be stabilised. As a rule, stabilization is effected by bentonite addition in the range of 1% to 4% of the weight of cement. The relative loss of strength of hardened grout is negligible upto 6% bentonite addition. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 100
7.7.4 Stable Bentonite-Cement Grouts (1) Stable bentonite/cement grouts shall be laboratory tested prior to use. The following graphs, in particular, shall be drawn : a) Equiviscosity curves, b) Bleed limit curves, c) Curves of equal mechanical strength, d) Curve of maximum possible viscosity for grouting. (2) These figures shall be obtained with a mixer which reproduces the high turbulence of the site mixers and with the same materials (cement, bentonite, water) as will be used on the site. Bentonite/cement mixes for grouting shall not bleed more than 5%, expressed in terms of the volume of water visible above the grout after setting and the total volume prior to setting, as measured in a 1 litre, 6 cm diameter test tube. (3) Viscosity shall be measured with a Marsh cone or equivalent method. (4) Unconfined compressive strength after 7 and 28 days shall be measured on 5 cm cubes stored in water. 28 days compressive strength shall be no less than 1 MPa. (5) The time to initial set shall not be longer than 24 hours. 7.7.4.1 Preparation (1) The bentonite/cement grout shall be made by first mixing a bentonite/water parent slurry in a high- turbulence mixer and storing it, once adjusted to the defined W/B ratio, for approximately 24 hours in a large tank where it shall be kept in gentle movement, after which a quantity of parent slurry shall be taken and mixed with additional water and cement in a high-turbulence mixer. (2) The final mixing of the parent slurry with cement shall last at least two minutes after addition of all ingredients. (3) The same mixing drum shall under no circumstances be used for mixing both bentonite/cement grouts and bentonite/water slurries. Bentonite shall not be suspended in water which contains even the slightest amount of cement. (4) The Contractor shall provide detailed information regarding the material and batching, mixing and grouting plant he proposes using in his submission for the Engineer-In- Charge's approval. 7.7.4.2 Grout Types (1) Three stable grouts with different batching proportions shall be developed. They shall be the thinnest possible mix (grout A), a mix of average viscosity (grout B), and the thickest possible pumpable mix (grout C. The composition of these mixes for one cubic meter of grout should be approximately as given in the table below: Grout A Grout B Grout C Water 850 l 848 l 846 l Bentonite 30 kg 40 kg 50 kg 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 101
Cement 425 kg 424 kg 422 kg Total volume 1,000 l 1,000 l 1,000 l Density 1.30 1.31 1.32 Viscosity (Marsh) 35 s 40 s 50 s Bleed 4 % 2.5 % 1 % 28 day strength 1.2 MPa 1.2 MPa 1.2 MPa
These compositions are given as a guide only and shall be adjusted to suit the materials used. A greater variety of mixes may be required. 7.8 EXECUTION 7.8.1 General (1) The extent of proposed drilling and grouting programme is tentative. Engineer-in- Charge reserves the right to increase or decrease any part of the drilling and grouting programme should conditions indicate that this is required. (2) The Contractor shall provide sufficient pump capacity and storage to ensure a continuous supply of water to all grouting operation at all times at each grouting location. Minimum water pressure in the supply lines shall be 0.35 N/mm 2 . Sufficient compressed air shall be supplied by the Contractor to perform the work with all equipment using compressed air operating at full capacity, the minimum delivery pressure in the air supply lines shall be 0.70 N/mm 2 at all times. (3) In order to ensure efficient and satisfactory performance, Contractor shall employ competent and experienced drilling and grouting supervisors who shall execute directions of Engineer-in-Charge and supervise the work to be done. (4) During drilling, grouting, washing and pressure testing operations, the Contractor shall keep concrete and rock surfaces free and clean of oil, grease, drill cuttings, grout, cement, excess of water or any kind of waste. At all times during the progress of the work covered by this section Contractor shall protect all open drillholes from becoming plugged or filled with oil, grease, drill cuttings, grout or waste. Contractor shall clean up; and remove all waste upon completion of the work in each area before he vacates that area. (5) Modifications to drilling and grouting techniques may be required as the knowledge and experience of rock and foundation conditions are gained. The Contractor will be required to alter his operations properly to meet such modifications as per instructions of the Engineer-in-Charge. Necessity may also arise for drilling holes at certain places in a telescopic manner for which equipment and accessories are required to be available. (6) All drillholes shall be thoroughly washed and cleaned by allowing drilling water to run until the return from the hole is reasonably clean as explained in IS:6066 - 1984. (7) Drilling through overburden shall be done by ODEX or other suitable method approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Consequently grouting shall be done by method "grouting through tubes with sleeves" as described in IS:4999 or any other equivalent method 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 102
approved by Engineer-in-Charge. Execution and controls shall be as per IS:4999 for overburden grouting. (8) All drillholes shall be protected from being clogged. Clogged holes shall be redrilled and cleaned at Contractor's cost. (9) Unless indicated otherwise, the drillholes shall not deviate from their designed alignment by more than 3% of their designed length. 7.8.2 Drilling 7.8.2.1 Percussion Drilling (1) The holes shall be drilled at locations, in the sequence, orientation, inclination and to the depths shown on the Drawings or as required by Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Most of the holes for consolidation, curtain or contact grouting and pressure relief will be drilled with drill of the percussion type which shall be equipped for constant water flushing at the far end of the drilling rod. (3) Holes drilled for contact/consolidation/curtain grouting in various structures shall be 45 mm f. Holes drilled for pressure relief shall also be 45 mm f, unless otherwise stated. (4) The use of rod dope, grease or other lubricants on drill rods shall not be permitted. No drilling water additives of any kind shall be used without the written permission of Engineer-in-Charge. (5) All holes shall be established to within 250 mm of the specified location. All orientation shall be within 1 degree of the orientation specified. If for any reason the drillhole deviates in inclination or orientation in such a way that it does not satisfy the purpose for which it was intended, the Contractor shall correct the deviation or shall drill another hole to the satisfaction of Engineer-in-charge. (6) Whenever the drill water is lost or artesian flow is encountered drilling operations may be stopped by Engineer-in-Charge who may require the hole to be grouted before drilling operations are resumed. The Contractor is required to record the location, the flow and pressure of any artesian conditions encountered in any drillhole. (7) On completion of drilling and washing of any grout or pressure relief holes drilled through the floor of the galleries, the Contractor shall immediately cap the holes with proper removable plugs (wooden or plastic) and shall protect them from entry of dirt or other foreign material. Any grout or pressure relief hole that gets obstructed prior to grouting or installation of elbow, shall be cleaned out or another hole shall be drilled by the Contractor. (8) Grout or pressure relief holes shall not be drilled within 12 m of another hole which is being grouted or which has been grouted within the previous 24 hours. (9) No hole shall be drilled through concrete before 5 days after the placement of the concrete. 7.8.2.2 Exploratory Drilling / Holes for Instrumentation / Check Holes etc (1) The Contractor shall perform exploratory drilling holes through overburden or concrete, rock and hardened grout at any inclination as directed by Engineer-in- Charge. The amount of and the requirement for, exploratory drilling will be determined by Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 103
(2) The use of mud or any other drilling fluids besides water is not permitted when coring. (3) Whenever the Engineer-in-Charge asks for the core recovery, the Contractor shall collect the cores and the cores shall be placed in wooden boxes in the correct sequence and designated accurately by permanently labelled wooden blocks recording the measured distances in the hole. No box shall contain cores from more than one hole. Designation marks, hole numbers and depth values shall be inscribed in the boxes, the cover securely fastened to the core boxes, and the boxes delivered at an area near the site as designated by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) Maximum core recovery will be required and if the blocking of the core is indicated by the drill behaviour, the core shall be removed immediately from the hole, regardless of the length of run which has been made. (5) Exploratory holes shall be water pressure tested and grouted under pressure if required by Engineer-in-Charge. 7.8.2.3 Drilling for crack grouting in concrete lined tunnels (1) The contractor shall drill holes for the crack grouting and sealing of open cold joints, construction joints and cracks in the concrete lining as directed by the Engineer-in- charge and as stipulated in Section Concrete. (2) The drilling shall consist of a series of 38mm dia drill holes executed within or along the cracks which have been determined by Engineer-in- charge to receive such treatments. Rotary drilling shall be used unless otherwise approved by the Engineer-in- Charge. 7.8.3 Washing and Water Pressure Testing (1) Immediately before grouting or pressure testing, the hole shall be thoroughly washed with water as explained in IS:6066 - 1984 or any other standard practice as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) For routine grouting operations, simple water tests shall be conducted immediately prior a stage of any grout hole is grouted. (3) A simple water pressure test involves isolating a segment of a hole generally 3 to 5 m in length by means of a single or double packers and pumping in water at constant pressure for a period of 15 minutes. The tests shall be carried out as per IS:6066 or any other standard procedure or code of practice approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 7.8.4 Grouting 7.8.4.1 General Grouting Procedure (1) Grout holes shall not be grouted except with permission from the Engineer-in-charge, until the concrete/shotcrete within a radius of 12 m from the grout hole has been completed and cured for five days. (2) Full depth grouting shall be limited to 5 m depth of hole in rock, however with latest information about rock geology, experience and pre-grouting results the Engineer-in- Charge may allow full depth grouting up to 10 m depth. (3) For deeper grout holes, more than 5 m length the grouting shall be performed in stages of not more than 5 m length of grout holes as directed by the Engineer-in-charge. (4) Once the grouting of a stage of a hole has been commenced it should be continued without interruption until completion. In general a stage may be considered complete when absorption of grout at the desired limited pressure is less than 2 lit./min. averaged over a period of 10 minutes. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 104
(5) As far as practical, a continuous flow of grout should be maintained at the desired pressure and the grouting equipment shall be operated to ensure continuous and efficient performance throughout the grouting operation. The Contractor shall respond quickly and effectively to effect the desired changes in the grout mix consistency, rate and pressure of injection, etc., as directed by the Engineer-in-charge during the grouting operation. (6) When grouting is interrupted due to plant break down, about 500-1,000 liters of clean water should be run into the hole and allowed to stand. (7) Should any hole connect to another during injection, the grout should be allowed to escape from the coupled hole until it is of the same consistency as that being injected; the coupled hole should then be capped and the combined holes brought up to pressure. After the first hole has been grouted, all the other holes are successively connected to the grouting header to subject them to the full pressure. (8) Grouting shall be stopped whenever pressure gauges register a sudden drop of pressure or the rate of grout absorption increases abruptly or there is any indication of upheaval, disturbance or leakage. Additional holes may have to be drilled and grouted in the vicinity or sealing cracks which might have been left due to premature blocking of holes by interruption of grouting operation. (9) It is advisable to begin with a low initial pressure of 0.1 - 0.25 kg/cm 2 /m of overburden and built up pressure gradually. The pressure shall be raised only when the intake rate falls below 5 lit/min. or as specified otherwise. (10) The true pressure at any depth should take into account the pressure head caused by weight of the grout in the hole as explained in IS:6066 - 1984. (11) The control of pressure shall be exercised according to the guidelines of IS:6066 - 1984. (12) Compositions of all grout mixes shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (13) When pressure does not build up even after the grouting, a thick grout i.e. with water cement ratio lesser than 0.6:1 by weight or by grout with filler such as sand and bentonite, it is desirable to stop grouting after predetermined limit of consumption is reached. Additional holes shall have to be drilled and grouted in the vicinity of such holes. (14) All grout holes shall be backfilled with grout mix 0.7 water : 1 cement with 3% bentonite or by mix as approved by Engineer-in-Charge after the grouting. A minimum 25 mm diameter delivery pipe is lowered to the bottom of the hole. Grout is pumped in the delivery pipe until it flows from the hole, then the delivery pipe is slowly withdrawn while pumping continues. If settlement of grout occurs after initial set, the holes shall be again backfilled by grout. (15) The Contractor shall caulk, dry pack or seal any surface leaks in rock or concrete before continuing grouting operation. (16) In areas of higher grout consumption sand may be required to be incorporated in the mix, the proportions of the sand permitted shall normally not exceed 2 parts of sand for 1 part of cement with approved plasticizer. (17) The grout mixes which cannot be injected within 2 hours of mixing shall be wasted. 7.8.4.2 Contact Grouting in Tunnels (1) Low pressure contact grouting shall be carried out between concrete lining and rock over the entire length of concrete lined tunnels (Diversion tunnel, spillway tunnel, head race tunnel and other hydraulic tunnels) as directed by Engineer-in-charge or as shown in the construction drawings. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 105
(2) Contact grouting shall be performed from holes drilled in the overt of concrete lining of the tunnels. 5 to 6 number holes at longitudinal interval of 3 m shall be drilled 300 mm into rock (or as shown in the construction drawings). (3) Washing and water pressure testing will not be required prior to contact grouting. (4) In any section of the tunnel, the concrete lining within 90 m of that section shall have been in place for at least 21 days before grouting commences. (5) Contact grouting shall be carried out at low pressure and shall continue until all voids are filled, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Vent pipes for the release of air and water during grouting shall be provided in locations directed or approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) After the grouting of any hole is completed, the pressure shall be maintained by means of a stopcock or other suitable device until the grout has set. (7) Check grouting shall be carried out where directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, to verify that voids have been completely filled with grout. Grouting will be regarded as being satisfactory if the pressure can be maintained for at least 5 minutes without further grout take. 7.8.4.3 Contact grouting in steel lined portion of tunnels (1) Low pressure contact grouting shall be carried out between rock and backfill concrete in the crown of steel lined portion of tunnels. (2) Holes shall be drilled 300 mm into the rock through pre-topped holed provided in the steel lining by hydro-mechanical contractor. (3) Work shall be required to be executed in close coordination with Hydro-mechanical contractor. 7.8.4.4 Consolidation Grouting (1) Consolidation grouting shall be performed at the following locations : Underground works: a) In tunnels near adit junctions and other identified locations with poor geology. b) Desilting basins c) shafts. d) During excavation process in tunnels / shafts / caverns when geological conditions so require Surface works: a) In surface excavations for inlet and outlet portals of various tunnels and adits, when geological conditions so require. b) In foundations of the structures such as tail race tunnel outlet. (2) Consolidation grouting shall normally be performed in a single stage through a nipple or packer installed at the collar of the hole within the concrete lining, but if geological conditions so dictate multiple-stage grouting either in ascending or descending arrangement shall be performed in the deeper holes. (3) Consolidation grouting at an open air structure shall first commence 7 days after concrete placement. Grouting for rock consolidation in any section of the completed underground structure shall not start earlier than 14 days after completion of contact grouting within 100 m of that section. (4) Immediately before grouting, the grout holes shall, rock characteristics permitting, be thoroughly washed out under pressure until the returning water is clear, and pressure tested. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 106
(5) Grout holes adjacent to a grout hook-up shall be left open during grouting operations to facilitate the escape of air and water from pockets in surrounding rock. Where, during grouting of any hole, grout is found to be flowing from adjacent holes or cracks of any kind, such openings shall be capped temporarily by plugging or caulking. (6) When performing the multiple-stage grouting in descending arrangement, the grout that is within the hole shall be removed from each stage except the deepest one, by washing, or by the use of a chopping or a "fishtail" bit before the grout sets. (7) In the event of a sudden drop in pressure or a sudden increase in grout take, grouting operations shall be temporarily halted until the crack or opening causing the loss is located and caulked. During this time the drillhole shall be continuously washed to avoid a premature grout set which would inhibit grouting to resume. If such a pressure drop or increase in grout take can be related to hydrofracturing, grout pressure shall be reduced. (8) If surface grout leaks cannot be located and successfully caulked, or the cause for the pressure loss cannot be determined, within 1 hour, the washing of the drillhole will be stopped and the grout in the rock formation shall be allowed to set for 24 hours. After setting, the drillhole shall be hooked onto again and grouted. If the hole, or stage, does not accept grout the hole shall be redrilled or a replacement hole shall be as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (9) If, during grouting, there is a communication between the holes, the Contractor shall either set packers in the communicating holes which shall be bled of accumulated air frequently and continue grouting one hole after another, or he may pressure grout the communicating holes simultaneously. (10) Grouting injection will be deemed to be completed when the take has become 0.03 m 3
or less per stage of hole being grouted during 10 minutes at the specified grouting pressure and mixture. (11) After completion of grouting, the packers shall remain in the hole and the pressure shall be maintained until the grout has attained its initial set. (12) The results of water-pressure testing and other information obtained during the performance of grouting will be used for the determination whether the grouting in each section of the Works under consideration is completed in a satisfactory manner, or whether additional grouting in separate drillholes is required. The termination of grouting work in any sequence in any section of the Works will be as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. 7.8.4.5 Curtain Grouting (1) Curtain grouting shall be performed in plinth of CFRD, below the cut-off wall, around tunnel plug from inside the tunnel as indicated on the Drawings, or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Hole depths, inclinations, sequence of grouting, method of grouting, whether single or multi-stage, in ascending or descending arrangement will be adapted by the Engineer-in-Charge based on information from exploratory drilling or current operations. The holes shall be drilled and grouted by the split-spacing method. (2) Normal sequence of grouting shall be ascending from bottom to top of hole in stages determined from water-pressure tests. Where the permeability exceeds 15-20 Lugeons, grouting shall generally be performed in descending arrangement. (3) When performing the multiple-stage grouting in descending arrangement, the grout that is within the hole shall be removed from each stage except the deepest one, by washing, or by the use of a chopping or a "fishtail" bit before it takes a hard set. (4) Stage length shall be a maximum of 5 m. (5) Unless otherwise directed, air, wash water, and grout pressures shall not exceed 2 bar plus 0.25 bar per linear meter of the depth measured from the collar of the hole to the bottom of the packer. In no cases shall grouting result in heave or hydrofracturing 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 107
(sudden increase of take). Grout pressure shall not be released nor packers moved until the grout in each successive stage has achieved an initial set. (6) The curtain grouting shall be performed from one or several grout stations. If several such stations are used, each shall be equipped complete, with mixers, agitator sumps, pumps, gages and measuring devices, and shall have a sufficient supply of grouting materials. (7) In case when the required pressure is not reached even when injecting maximum volume, the Engineer-in-Charge will decide whether the grouting will be interrupted, or the grout mixture is to be changed, or accelerator added. (8) Where grout is found to be flowing from adjacent holes or cracks of any kind, such openings shall be capped temporarily by plugging or caulking. If this does not bring satisfactory results, further grouting shall be interrupted and the injected material allowed to harden. (9) Grouting injection will be deemed to be completed when the take has become 0.03 m 3
or less per stage of hole being grouted during 10 minutes at the specified grouting pressure and mixture. (10) After the conclusion of the grouting program, the Contractor shall drill inclined check holes. Unless otherwise directed, the check holes shall be drilled at the spacing of 30 m, and two-thirds the depth of the grout curtain. Check holes may also be drilled in areas of complex hydrogeology, which require particular treatment. These holes shall be filled with grout. Based on the results obtained in the check holes, the Engineer-in- Charge may order additional grout holes or a new line of grout holes to be executed. 7.8.4.6 Closure of Holes and Clean-up (1) Upon completion of grouting work each hole shall be filled with thick grout and connections not embedded in the concrete shall be removed. The drilled holes in the concrete lining shall be reamed or redrilled (as needed) to a depth corresponding to the two-thirds of theoretical concrete lining thickness, and filled with dry-pack mortar, flush with the concrete surface (2) After completion of the grouting works the internal surface of the concrete or steel lining shall be cleaned and restored to its original condition 7.8.4.7 Crack Grouting in Concrete Lined Tunnels (1) Crack grouting shall be performed to seal the cold joints, construction joints, shrinkage cracks, honeycombs, poorly closed grout holes etc. in the structural concrete linings of underground structures as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge and as stipulated in Section Concrete. (2) Crack grouting shall consist of injecting a stable, cement-water mix through holes specially drilled into cracks or joints. Prevention measures shall be taken by plugging the joint with wooden wedges, cardboard, cement-gypsum mortar, or other suitable means to prevent the grout from flowing out of the crack. 7.8.5 Grouting of Overburden below Cofferdam (1) The riverbed overburden below the cofferdam shall be grouted which mainly consists of gravel, boulder and porous material. (2) Drilling (75 mm min dia) shall be done by ODEX method as described in IS:4999 or by equivalent method as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) Grouting shall be done through tubes and sleeves system as described in IS:4999. Alternative equivalent or superior method according to established procedure as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge may also be used for grouting. (4) The grout material and mix shall be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge in accordance with the guidelines of IS:4999. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 108
7.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 7.9.1 General (1) The estimates of the quantities for drilling, water pressure testing, sampling, and grouting given in the Schedule are to be considered merely as a guide serving the Contractor to prepare his Tender and not as an accurate indication of the quantity of the work. (2) The quantities for each of the pay items will be varied to suit the conditions disclosed in the course of the work, and the Contractor shall not be entitled to any extra payment over and above the Unit Prices entered in the Schedule by reason of changes of the amount and length of holes to be grouted and amount of material absorbed, by reason of the location of the grouting required by the Engineer-in-Charge, or by reason of the timing of the grouting in relation to excavation, concreting or other works. (3) The Unit Prices for drilling stipulated hereinafter shall apply regardless if drilling is performed by percussion or rotary drilling. 7.9.2 Drilling 7.9.2.1 Drilling for Dam Grout Curtain (1) Measurement for payment for drilling of grouting holes will be of the length of holes actually drilled in positions as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials for drilling and washing out of the holes and for temporary casing, if required. The Unit Price shall apply irrespective of the location, inclination or direction of the hole. (2) When drilling of the hole is carried out successively for multiple-stage grouting, the measurement for payment will only be of the total length of the hole drilled actually in the rock or concrete. Any redrilling required because of the Contractor's failure to clean the grout out of the hole before it has set shall be performed at the expense of the Contractor. (3) Measurement for payment for any required redrilling where the grout has been allowed to set at the direction of the Engineer-in-Charge will be of the actual length of redrilled hole. Payment for this length in linear meters will be made in the form of an additional payment over and above that made for the original drilling at the rate of 50% of the appropriate Unit Price. 7.9.2.2 Drilling for Consolidation Grouting (1) Measurement for payment for drilling through any material for consolidation grouting, carried out either during the excavation or after placing of the concrete lining, will be of the length of holes drilled in positions shown on the Drawings or established at the Site by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment, and materials for drilling and washing out of the holes, maintaining the holes free from obstructions until grouted, reaming or redrilling the holes after completion of grouting and filling with dry-pack mortar. (2) Where drilling is required after placing of the structural concrete lining, measurement of the length of hole drilled shall include the theoretical thickness of the lining irrespective of whether the hole was actually drilled through the lining or formed by other means. (3) When drilling of the hole is carried out successively for multiple-stage grouting, the measurement for payment will only be of the total length of the hole drilled actually in the rock or concrete. Any redrilling required because of the Contractor's failure to clean the grout out of the hole before it has set shall be performed at the expense of the Contractor. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 109
(4) Measurement for payment for any required redrilling where the grout has been allowed to set at the direction of the Engineer-in-Charge will be of the actual length of redrilled hole. Payment for this length in linear meters will be made in the form of an additional payment over and above that made for the original drilling at the rate of 50% of the appropriate Unit Price. 7.9.2.3 Drilling of Drainage Holes (1) Separate measurement and payment will be made for the following a) Drilling and washing out of the hole, b) Supply and installation of PVC pipes, (2) Measurement for payment for drilling of drainage holes will be of the length of holes actually drilled in positions as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials for drilling and washing out of the holes and for temporary casing, if required. The Unit Price shall apply irrespective of the location, inclination or direction of the hole. (3) Measurements for payment of PVC pipe installed in the drainage holes as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge will be of the length of pipe so installed. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of supply and installation of perforated or non-performed pipes, as well as all necessary couplings. (4) Where redrilling of the previously drilled drainage holes is required after an additional grouting, measurement for payment will be of the actual length of redrilled hole. Payment for this length in linear meters will be made in the form of an additional payment over and above that made for the original drilling at the rate of 50% of the appropriate Unit Price. 7.9.2.4 Drilling of Exploratory Holes, Check Holes, and Holes for Instrumentation (with Core Recovery) (1) Separate measurement for payment and payment will be made for the following: a) Drilling of holes 45 mm minimum diameter with or without core recovery, b) Drilling of holes 76 mm minimum diameter with or without core recovery, c) Drilling of holes 98 mm minimum diameter with or without core recovery. d) Extra over for core recovery. (2) Measurement for payment for drilling of exploratory holes will be of the length of holes of different diameters drilled in positions as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per linear meter of drillholes of different diameters for drainage holes entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials required for rotary drilling of holes. (3) Measurement for payment for core recovery when ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge will be of the length. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter for core recovery entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials required for the core recovery, provision of core boxes, preservation and storage of cores, preparation of technical logs of the drillholes, provision of colour photographs of the boxes cores, and any assistance provided by the Contractor to the Engineer-in-Charge during the geological logging and handling of core boxes. (4) The Unit Prices for drilling from the underground shall apply irrespective of the location inclination or direction of the drilling. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 110
7.9.2.5 Drilling for Contact Grouting in Underground (1) Separate measurement for payment and payment will be made for: a) Drilling for contact grouting in the crown of the underground structures, b) Drilling for contact grouting in any other zone, e.g. for backfilling the voids created by geological overbreak, between the steel lagging and the rock, etc. when ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Measurements for payment for drilling the holes for contact grouting between the concrete and rock in the crown both in concrete-lined and steel-lined sections of underground structures will be of the length of holes drilled in positions shown on the Drawings or established at the Site by the Engineer-in-Charge, irrespective of the location, inclination or diameter of the hole. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials required for setting-up drilling equipment, drilling and washing out the holes, reaming or redrilling the holes after completion of grouting, and filling with dry-pack mortar. (3) Measurement for payment for drilling the holes for contact grouting between the steel lagging and rock, or in any other zone will be of the length of holes drilled in accordance with Engineer-in-Charge's instructions, regardless of the location, inclination, direction or diameter of the hole. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment and materials required for setting up drilling equipment; drilling and washing out of holes, reaming or redrilling the holes after completion of grouting, and filling with dry-pack mortar. 7.9.2.6 Drilling for crack grouting (1) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for drilling holes for crack grouting and sealing of cracks in the structural concrete lining and the cost thereof shall be included in the corresponding unit prices for the concrete lining in question. 7.9.2.7 Water-Pressure Testing (1) Measurement for payment for water-pressure tests will be of the number of tests satisfactorily performed, irrespective of size, length, or inclination of hole, or whether carried out in holes drilled from the surface or underground. (2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per test entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of labour, equipment, and materials used for carrying out the water-pressure test, the provision of test records and reports to the Engineer-in- Charge, and all costs associated with interruptions to the drilling caused by the intermittent nature of the testing work. 7.9.2.8 Embedded Pipes and Fittings for Grouting (1) Separate measurement for payment and payment will be made for standard mild steel pipes and fittings in rock and concrete. (2) Measurement for payment for such embedded steel pipes and fittings left permanently in place will be by weight, regardless of pipe diameter. Payment will only be made for pipes whose installation has been expressly ordered or approved by the Engineer-in- Charge or when shown on the Drawings. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per kilogram entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of supply, installation, and protection against blockage of pipes and fittings. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 111
7.9.2.9 Exclusions - Drilling (1) All costs for drilling the holes for rockbolts, grouted anchor bar and prestressed anchors are excluded from this Section and will be measured and paid for in accordance with provisions of the Section "Rock Supports". (2) All drilling work required in connection with rock mechanics testing will be paid separately as described in the Section "Monitoring Instruments. (3) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following: a) Drilling through steel ribs, steel lagging, reinforcing steel or steel lining, b) Installation and removal of grout stub pipes, c) Reaming or redrilling any holes through the concrete lining for the purpose of placing, and for supplying and placing, the dry-pack mortar, d) Holes which have been blocked and cannot be used because of cave-ins, lost drill rods or packers, or striking other obstructions (e.g. reinforcement bars), and drilling the new holes to replace them. 7.9.3 Grouting (1) Measurement for payment and payment for grouting will be made based on the cement bags grouted. No separate measurement for 'placing/injecting grout' will be made. (2) Unit Prices for grouting shall include the entire cost of labour, supply of grout materials (cement, sand, bentonite, admixtures), equipments, handling, transportation, storage, testing, processing, mixing, hooking up to the hole (where appropriate), placing/injecting grout, hole closures and clearing up. 7.9.3.1 Exclusions - Grouting (1) All costs for grouting of the rock bolts, grouted anchor bar post-tensioned rock anchors are excluded from this Section and will be measured and paid for in accordance with the provisions of the Section "Rock Supports". (2) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for following: a) Preparation and testing of trial mixes, b) Grouting materials used in mixture which has been prepared more than one hour prior to injecting or which have been lost due to improper handling or rejected due to improper mixing, c) Supply and injection of water, d) Placing/injecting of grout, e) Sand, bentonite and admixtures, f) Plugging and caulking leaks during grouting, g) Protection of drainage system, if any, during grouting, h) Communication facilities required during grouting, i) Closure of the holes as specified and clean-up, j) Preparation and submission of records and reports on grouting operations. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 112
8 CUT-OFF WALL 8.1 GENERAL (1) The Works provided for in this specification consist of furnishing all plant, labour, material and services necessary for constructing a plastic-concrete cut-off wall through the alluvial deposits which fill the dam site, below the power intake and inlet of spillway tunnels to the dimensions specified indicated on the drawings. The wall will extend from the level of the plinth foundation of the dam to the alluvium/bedrock contact. The depth of this bedrock contact is variable. (2) The Contractor shall further set-up, equip, operate and maintain a field laboratory for sampling, testing, mix design and quality control for all work related to the cut-off wall construction. (3) The minimum width of the plastic concrete panels will be 1000 mm. The top of the wall shall be capped by a wall head consisting of reinforced concrete, which will ensure the connection to the plinth of the concrete face rockfill embankment. (4) The equipment, working procedures and accuracy must be such that the panel thickness is nowhere less than 1000 mm and the minimum width of the contact surface between adjacent panels is never less than 750 mm. 8.2 STANDARDS (1) Unless otherwise specified, the standards and recommendations of the Indian Standards Code of Practice shall be followed in respect of all materials, equipment and performances. In particular, Indian Standard IS 456:1978 is specifically mentioned. For pile load test IS:2911 (Part-4) shall be followed. (2) In case of differences between the Indian Standards and the Specification given herein, this Specification shall take precedence. (3) In case there are procedures or methods etc. for which an Indian Standard has not yet been issued, other generally well-known Standards shall be accepted as substitutes, such as the J apanese and British Standards (BS), the German Industrial Standards (DIN), or those of the American Society of Testing and Materials (ASTM) or the American Petroleum Institute (API), in this order of preference. 8.3 SUBMITTAL (1) The Contractor shall submit detailed plans and descriptions of all the following matters related to the construction of the cut-off wall: Name and references of specialised contractors to be employed for work on the cut-off wall. Names and experience records of specialist staff who will work on the wall. Plant and equipment to be used: full description (type and capacity) and drawings for the following items: Trench excavation plant Bentonite slurry plant Slurry cleaning plant Batching and mixing plants Equipment for transport and placing of concrete 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 113
Sampling and testing of materials: List and details of equipment for sampling and testing, detailed programme of mix design for plastic-concrete and selection criteria, detailed programme for quality control of bentonite, bentonite suspension, plastic-concrete mix and hardened plastic-concrete. Qualifications and experience of the Contractors proposed personnel List and details of equipment and methods to be used to check and verify the depth, width, verticality, continuity, and progress of concrete placement. Testing programme to determine slurry loss, penetration and filtration. The period required for any preliminary on site mix trials, excavation trials and the taking of slurry and plastic-concrete samples from the trench. The method of treatment and disposal of spoil and contaminated bentonite slurry. Programme of work and detailed working procedures and sequences (method statements). 8.4 MATERIALS 8.4.1 Bentonite suspension (supporting slurry) The slurry used to maintain the stability of the trench/panel excavation shall satisfy the following requirements Continuous support of the excavation, Solid particles are kept in suspension, The slurry can be easily displaced during concreting, The slurry shall not cause pollution of the ground, or of surface or groundwater before, during or after use. The constituents of the slurry suspension shall be mixed thoroughly to produce a homogeneous mix. The temperature of the water used in mixing of the supporting slurry at the time of commencing concrete placement shall not be less than 5C. 8.4.2 Plastic-concrete The plastic-concrete mixture shall consist of Portland cement, water, coarse and fine aggregate, bentonite and approved admixtures. Some portion of the Portland cement may be substituted by ground granulated blast-furnace slag or fly ash if the Contractor can demonstrate by comprehensive mixing trials that the hardened mixture will have the required properties. 8.4.3 Concrete Concrete for the head of the cut-off wall shall be manufactured according to the specification given in Section Concrete 8.5 MIX DESIGN (1) The Contractor shall prepare and submit a detailed mix designing programme for plastic concrete to be used for the cut-off wall construction. The plastic concrete shall have the following main properties: Maximum grain size 30 mm Unconfined compressive strength (28 days) >1.5 MPa Confined compressive strength ( c 0.4 MPa) >2.5 MPa Strain at failure (unconfined test) >3% Permeability <10 -8 m/s 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 114
Youngs Modulus 200-400 MPa (2) The Contractor shall perform all required tests on this concrete which shall include, but not be limited to the following: Density of mix Viscosity, consistency Setting time Unconfined compressive strength Tri-axial stress-strain behaviour Permeability Erosion resistance Slump (3) The Contractor shall prepare reports containing all test results, a detailed evaluation of them and a proposal of the mix which it is intended to use for construction. 8.6 QUALITY CONTROL (1) The Contractor shall perform with a regular frequency quality control tests of the bentonite suspension and the concrete mixes. (2) The tests for quality control together with the tentative acceptance criteria is listed. These acceptance criteria may be somewhat adjusted based on the results of the mixes the Contractor proposes to use. The Contractor shall vary the proportions of the mix to achieve the desired strength and deformation properties of the plastic-concrete. 8.7 EXECUTION 8.7.1 Excavation (1) The excavation of the cut-off trench will only be started after placing of the backfill which will support the plinth. In the vicinity of the trench, the surface of this fill shall be protected from damage by equipment and traffic by a layer at least 500 mm thick of sand/gravel. 8.7.2 Setting out (1) Setting out of the line of the cut-off wall shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. Setting out of the wall shall be to a centerline positioned with a tolerance of 50 mm, whereas the maximum horizontal deviation of the constructed panel from the centreline shall be 15 mm at the top level of the cut-off wall. 8.7.3 Guide walls (1) A suitable guide wall shall be used in conjunction with the method of excavation to ensure stability of the strata near ground level until concrete has been placed. During construction the level of support slurry in the excavation shall be maintained within the guide wall or stable ground, so that it is not less than 1500 mm above the level of external groundwater at all times. The wall shall extend at least 1000 mm below ground level or the surface of the working platform, or to any other such depth as will maintain stability of the upper soils during the panel excavation and as may be approved. (2) The finished inner faces of the guide walls shall be vertical with a tolerance of 1 in 200. The minimum clear distance between the inner faces of the guide walls shall be the specified diaphragm wall thickness plus 50 mm. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 115
8.7.4 Continuity (1) The method and procedure to be employed in the excavation must guarantee the continuity of the cut-off wall, i.e. produce a wall without open joints and without open areas in any plane, such that at each cross section of the wall, especially in the joints of alternating panels, the concrete has the specified contact. After excavation of each panel, the surfaces of the walls of the trench, and the alignment and depth of the trench section have to be checked. (2) The Contractor has to re-excavate those sections which do not comply with the requirements of continuity between sections, and/or the minimum thickness of the wall. For re-excavation, it may be necessary to first fill the poorly excavated zones with concrete. 8.7.5 Verticality (1) During excavation and on completion of each panel, the Contractor shall verify its verticality. The Contractor shall employ methods and procedures which allow maintaining verticality with a deviation that assures the continuity of the wall at its joints. The maximum allowable deviation from vertical at a depth of 70 m is 250 mm, and the minimum allowable width of the contact area between adjacent panels is 750 mm. 8.7.6 Cleanliness of excavation bottom (1) Prior to placing reinforcement or concrete the Contractor shall clean the base of the excavation of as much loose, disturbed and remoulded materials as practical and in accordance with the method of construction. Immediately before filling a section of the trench with plastic-concrete, a full check of the condition of the section shall be made in the presence of the Engineer-in-charge. 8.7.7 Stability of the excavation (1) The Contractor is responsible for maintaining the stability of the trench walls permanently and shall select equipment, methods and procedures which are able to fully satisfy this objective. (2) The thickness of a panel shall be not less than the specified minimum cut-off wall thickness. The length of any panel may be varied to suit an individual Contractors equipment subject to any upper limits on length as specified. Within these constraints the Contractor shall be responsible for selecting panel dimensions which ensure stability. (3) The Contractor shall comply with the following requirements with respect to the slurry to be used for stabilising the excavation: (4) The bentonite powder shall be mixed thoroughly with water by a suitable high shearing action mixer until all lumps have been broken up and dispersed within the mix. The proportion of bentonite to be included shall take into account the rheological properties of the bentonite such that the slurry shall be sufficient to maintain the stability of the excavation in the ground conditions encountered. (5) In order to minimise the risk of collapse of the trench faces, the level of the slurry in the excavation will be kept at least 1500 mm above the groundwater table of the adjacent terrain and not more than 0.5 m below the level of the working platform, except when, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-charge, the losses of slurry would be excessive. In this case the Contractor, with the approval of the Engineer-in-charge, could reduce the distance between slurry level and groundwater level. The Contractor shall make every 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 116
effort to minimise the slurry losses but without compromising his responsibility to maintain the stability of the excavation. (6) The slurry placed into the excavated trench must be circulated and agitated continuously employing adequate equipment. The slurry requirements must be maintained at all times including non-working periods and stoppages. (7) The Contractor shall provide equipment of sufficient capacity to clean the slurry of unacceptable quantities of rock debris and sediments from the excavation. The Contractor shall check the slurry periodically to verify its capacity to retain the walls of the trench and if necessary shall remove excess solid particles from the suspension. (8) The volume of slurry being used shall be measured and recorded so as to ensure that no excessive loss to surrounding strata will occur. Should such loss be detected and continue despite the addition of further slurry, or approved additives, and the stability of the trench be placed at risk, the Contractor shall immediately inform the Engineer-in- charge and take remedial action as necessary to preserve the stability of the trench. (9) After excavation and prior to concreting a panel, the entire volume of slurry in the excavated panel shall be circulated to remove all sand, gravel and other contaminants, and shall be replaced by circulated clean, fresh regenerated bentonite slurry containing not more than 3% of sand and gravel. In addition, this replacement slurry should have a unit weight of between 1.05 and 1.10 t/m3. 8.7.8 Placing of plastic concrete in the cut-off trench (1) Concrete placement cannot be started until each excavation step has been approved by the Engineer-in-charge. Concrete shall be placed as soon as possible after excavation of a section or panel has been completed, the bottom of the trench has been cleaned, and the slurry circulated. If, after circulation and cleaning of the slurry, more than two (2) hours elapse before the start of concrete pouring, the circulation and cleaning process has to be repeated. (2) Concrete placement has to be a continuous process without interruption until the level of the top of the wall as indicated on the Drawings is reached. The workability and method of placement of the concrete shall be such that a continuous monolithic concrete panel of the full cross-section is formed, and the placed concrete is dense and homogeneous. Before commencement of concreting of a panel, the Contractor shall satisfy the Engineer-in-charge that adequate operational equipment, labour and materials are available to allow the placing in the specified time of the plastic concrete needed to construct the panel in a single continuous operation. (3) The concrete batches shall be placed without any interruptions of duration long enough to allow a previously-placed batch to achieve a stiffness which would prevent proper bonding with a subsequent batch. Should such an interruption occur, the Contractor has to remove and replace the concrete in question. No spoil, liquid or other foreign matter shall be allowed to contaminate the concrete. (4) The concrete shall be transported from the mixing plant to the position of the panel in such a manner that segregation of the mix does not occur. (5) Internal vibrators shall not be used to compact concrete placed in the panels of the cut- off wall. (6) Concrete shall be placed through tremie pipes in one continuous operation. Where two or more pipes are used in the same panel simultaneously, care shall be taken to ensure that the concrete level at each pipe position is kept about the same. The increase in the level of the concrete in the trench has to be checked regularly. The 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 117
Contractor shall perform this check at several points of a section being concreted. The maximum distance between tremie pipes shall not exceed 3 m. (7) All hoppers and tremie pipes shall be kept clean and watertight at all times. The pipe shall extend to the base of the panel and every time concreting is started a sliding plug or barrier shall be placed in the pipe to prevent direct contact between the first charge of concrete in the tremie and the slurry. (8) The tremie pipes shall be progressively withdrawn as the concreting proceeds, but the pipe shall at all times penetrate the concrete to depth of at least 3 m until completion of concreting. The internal diameter of the tremie pipe shall be of sufficient size to ensure the easy flow of concrete. It shall be so designed that external projections are minimised, and the internal face of the tremie shall be free from projections. (9) The depth of the surface of the concrete shall be measured and the embedded length of the tremie pipe recorded at regular intervals for each batch of concrete. The depths measured and the volumes placed shall be plotted immediately on a graph during the concreting process and compared with the theoretical relationship of depth against volume. 8.8 CONTROL MEASURES FOR THE CUT-OFF WALL (1) The Contractor shall demonstrate by sounding methods that the completed cut-off is continuous over its entire area. In particular he shall prove that at panel joints the maximum offset between adjacent panels shall not exceed 250 mm, and that along any joint the thickness of the wall is nowhere less than 750 mm. (2) Some control items and their frequency of application which the Contractor shall consider during excavation and concreting of the wall are listed in the table below. The Contractor may propose control methods other than listed. Control measures for cut-off wall Control item Control method Frequency of control test Stratigraphy (Soil/rock profile) Excavation and geotechnical logging of trench Continuously Depth of panel Plumbline with measuring scale Once per panel Bottom of wall on or inside bedrock Drilling of holes in excavation, examination of excavated material Once per panel Verticality of wall Two measuring plumb lines attached on either side of grab, Koden equipment or similar Hydrofrase / Trench cutter with ENPAFRAISE and KODESOL or similar Inclinometer Every 10 m along the wall 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 118
Degree of overlap of adjacent panels Hydrofraise / Trench cutter graphical output Concrete dying or other similar methods Once per panel
8.9 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 8.9.1 Guide Wall The measurement of guide walls will be based on the volume of concrete as specified in Section Concrete. Payment for volume of Concrete placed and weight of reinforcement will be made at the Unit Price entered in the Schedule. The unit price shall include the cost for all formwork, installation of reinforcing bars, concrete placing and the removal of the guide walls after completion of the cut-off wall. No separate payment will be made for removal of the guide walls. 8.9.2 Cut-Off Wall (1) Measurement for payment and payment for diaphragm wall will be of square meter of the diaphragm wall constructed as shown in the construction drawings or as directed by Engineer-in-Charge. Measurement will be made from the top elevation of Guide walls to the bottom of each panel of the wall. (2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per square meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of the following: a) Setting out of the trench, b) Trench excavation, c) Bentonite slurry preparation, conveyance to trench, slurry circulation and cleaning, monitoring stability of trench and all quality control activities, d) Checking the cleanliness of the trench bottom, e) Supply and placement of plastic concrete (tremie concrete), f) J oint construction, g) Removal of the upper portion of the wall h) All mix designs, testing and quality control, i) Supply of material, aggregates, cement, bentonite, fly-ash etc., and water, j) Any deficient and wasted material (slurry, concrete, etc.) which has to be removed and replaced due to Contractors non-compliance with the specifications or Engineer-in-charges directions, and all related cost shall be borne by the Contractor, k) Any material which the Contractor places or uses for his own convenience, l) Developing alternative sources of material (e.g. aggregates) by the Contractor with the resulting additional material testing, m) All equipment required to achieve and monitor the verticality of the trench to the specified tolerances. 8.9.3 Tests (1) No measurement and payment shall be made for testing of construction materials, pile load test and monitoring of the excavation. All the associated costs shall be borne by 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 119
the Contractor, who shall make allowance for such expense in the Unit Prices for the cut-off wall. These shall include but not be limited to the following: a) The costs for all tests to be carried out prior to the start of the Works, i.e. testing on bentonite powder, water, bentonite slurry, cement aggregates, concrete mixes, etc., b) Routine tests for quality control during execution of the cut-off wall carried out by the Contractor as specified herein and as directed, c) Monitoring of the excavation for verticality and continuity before concrete placement by specialised equipment, d) Other material tests required during execution of the Works to be carried out by one or more approved testing laboratories, e) Preparation, storage, handling, curing and delivery of samples to a laboratory designated by the Engineer-in-charge, if so required for additional independent testing, f) Should the Contractor fail to adhere to his testing and monitoring, all tests deemed necessary by the Engineer-in-charge to check the manufacturing and placement of the slurry for stabilisation, or the plastic concrete for the cut-off wall will be performed by the Engineer-in-charge or by a laboratory assigned by him, at the Contractors expense. 8.9.4 Exclusions (1) No extra measurement and payment will be made for the following: a) Removal and disposal of spoil from the cut-off trench, b) Disposal of bentonite slurry, c) removal of the upper portion of the wall (guide wall) d) Corrective measures arising from non-compliance with the specifications or with the directions given by the Engineer-in-charge, e) Record keeping as specified, f) All other incidental activities required for the construction of the cut-off wall.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 120
9 CONCRETE (Excluding Formwork, Reinforcement, and J oints) 9.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) The work under this Section includes all labour, materials, equipment and services related to the concrete work to be carried out by the Contractor under this Contract. (2) The concrete work shall be performed to the dimensions as shown on the Construction Drawings or as otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Lift drawings shall be prepared by the Contractor. (3) The Contractor shall cooperate with all other contractors and organisations related to the construction of Permanent Works where the material or equipment is to be fixed to, or embedded in the concrete structures. (4) Plastic concrete for cut of wall in CFRD is covered separately in section Cut off Wall. (5) Formwork, reinforcement and shotcrete are covered separately in other Sections of these Specifications. (6) The approval given by the Engineer-in-Charge to the Contractor's plants and equipment or their operation, or of any construction methods shall not relieve the Contractor of his full responsibility for the proper and safe execution of concrete work or any obligations under this Contract. 9.2 STANDARDS (1) Unless otherwise specified, the standards and recommendations of Indian Standards Code of Practices shall be followed in respect of all materials, equipment and performances. (2) The following Indian Standards are specifically mentioned: IS:456 Code of practice for Plain and Reinforced Concrete IS:383 Coarse and fine aggregates from natural sources for Concrete IS:2386 (Part-IV) Method of testing of aggregates for Concrete- Mechanical property IS:5878 (Part-V) Code of practice for Construction of tunnels conveying water : Concrete Lining IS:516 Method of test for strength of Concrete IS:1489 Portland Pozzolana Cement Fly Ash based IS:1199 Method of sampling and analysis of Concrete IS:457 Code of practice for general construction of plain and reinforced concrete for dams and other massive structures IS:9103 - Concrete Admixtures : Specifications IS:7861 (Part-I and Part-II) - Code of practice for Extreme weather concreting, Recommended Practice (Hot weather and Cold weather concreting) 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 121
IS:2505 Concrete Vibrators Immersion type general requirements (3) In absence of relevant Indian Standards and specifications the recommendations of "ACI Manual of Concrete Practice" and U.S.B.R. Concrete Manual shall be followed. 9.3 SUBMITTALS 9.3.1 Submittals Before Construction (1) Submittals listed herein are related to items which require the consent of the Engineer- in-Charge and are to be submitted by the Contractor before the appropriate work may proceed. (2) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, but before procuring or mobilising to the Site the equipment, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in- Charge updated and detailed plans and descriptions, consistent with those submitted with his Tender and any subsequent amendments and additions agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor, of the following: a) Aggregates Processing Plant: Description, flow diagrams and drawings in sufficient details to indicate layout, type and capacity of crushing, screening, washing, conveying and other aggregate processing and handling equipment. b) Batching and Mixing Plants: Description, flow diagrams, and drawings of the plants, and details of the equipment the Contractor intends to use to determine and control the amount of each separate concrete ingredient and mixing thereof into uniform mixture. c) Concrete Cooling Plant: Details of refrigeration and ice plants and methods which the Contractor proposes to use to comply with concrete temperature requirements. d) Transport and Placing of Concrete: Full details of the equipment and methods for transporting the concrete from the concrete plant to the final point of placing, including numbers, type and capacity of transport vehicles, concrete pumps, vibrators, and details of standby plants to be installed. e) Mode and methodology of concrete curing, f) Sampling and Testing of Materials: List and details of equipment for sampling and testing, detailed program for quality control of concrete work, and qualification and experience of the proposed personnel. (3) At least 56 days in advance of any concrete work being carried out at the Site, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge following notifications based on the results of the preliminary material testing: a) Notification of the mill or mills from which cement will be obtained and whether cement will be ordered in bulk or bags. If cement is to be obtained from several 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 122
mills, the estimated amount of cement from each mill and the proposed schedule of shipment shall be stated, b) Notification of the source, analysis, method of delivery, and storage of water for concrete manufacture, c) Notification of any admixtures and pozzolans which the Contractor proposes to use, manufacturers thereof, and information about the chemical names of the principal ingredients and the effects of under or over dosage. Should the Contractor intend to use an accelerator in any concrete work for his own convenience, he shall give full details of the type, dosage, influence on construction, and the cost savings involved, d) Details of the materials for formwork and surface finishes, treatment of construction joints, and construction techniques which the Contractor proposes to use in order to achieve the required concrete surfaces and allowable tolerances, e) System, methods, and equipment for prestressing steel and grouting of cables in prestressed concrete elements. (4) At least 28 days prior to procuring or despatch to the Site of the particular item of work to which the submittal relates, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge the following: a) Details of curing compounds, if any, b) Details of epoxy mortar for concrete repair. (5) Drawings showing the location of construction joints proposed by the Contractor which differ from those shown on the Construction Drawings, including formwork and reinforcement details, shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge at least 28 days prior to commencement of work on that particular structure. 9.3.2 Submittals During Construction (1) Contractor shall provide the Engineer-in-Charge with a weekly placing schedule giving the detailed location of the pours, the approximate extent of pours, and the date on which the concrete will be placed. This weekly programme of concrete placement shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for his acceptance at least 2 days prior to the commencement of the week. (2) Before commencement of the concrete placement the Contractor shall prepare a checklist regarding all preparations for the specified work such as rock surfaces and foundations, cleaning, formwork, reinforcement, embedding, and submit this list to the Engineer-in-Charge, who after his satisfaction about the work preparations will permit the contractor in writing to commence concrete placement. (3) The Contractor shall keep and make available to the Engineer-in-Charge records of the date, amount, and storage location of each delivery of cement and of the part of the Works in which it was used and shall provide facilities for checking the stock of cement. (4) During the performance of the concrete work, the Contractor shall keep a diary where he shall record the construction procedures related to concreting. This diary shall be made available to the Engineer-in-Charge upon request. The records shall contain at least the following: a) Commencement and termination of concreting of various parts of the structures, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 123
b) Quantities and quality of aggregates and cement provided, and the storage from which they were drawn, c) Temperature of air, water, cement, aggregates, and concrete, d) Meteorological conditions and humidity of air, e) Sampling and testing performed and summary of results, f) Personnel employed during various stages of the concreting operation and name of the responsible inspector or foreman, g) Equipment used, h) Directives received from the Engineer-in-Charge, i) Any special material or procedures employed. (5) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to require any additional information deemed necessary to be included in the submitted documents. 9.4 CONSTITUENTS OF CONCRETE 9.4.1 Cement (1) The Contractor shall supply Portland Pozzolana Cement (PPC) conforming to IS:1489 Part-I. Percentage of fly ash will be 30% in PPC. Average compressive strength of not less than 3 mortar cubes tested as per IS 4031 (Part 6):1988 at 672 +4 hours shall not be less than 43 MPa. (2) Cement shall be procured from the cement sources/plants approved by the Engineer- in-charge. At least two sources/plants shall be selected out of those intimated by the Contractor so that one is a standby for any eventualities. (3) Each consignment of cement delivered to the Site shall be accompanied by a test certificate issued by the manufacturer in quadruplicate. The Engineer-in-charge will have the right to attend the sampling and testing at the manufacturers plant at any time. If delivery is not directly from the manufacturer, the intermediate storage and delivery arrangements shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer. (4) Cement which does not comply with relevant IS Code or is damaged in consignment, handling or storage shall be promptly removed from the Site. (5) All facilities for transport and storage of cement shall be subject to approval of the Engineer-in-Charge and shall be such that easy access for inspection is assured. (6) Bulk cement shall be transported from the port or mill to the site in adequately designed weather-tight trucks, or other means where cement will be protected from exposure to moisture. Immediately upon receipt at the site, cement shall be stored in a dry, weather-tight and properly ventilated structure with adequate provisions for the prevention of absorption of moisture, and constructed in such a way that there will be no dead storage. The vents of the bins and silos shall be equipped with dust collectors to reduce loss of cement during handling and inconvenience to the personnel. (7) Cement bags shall be stored in weatherproof buildings with a raised, well ventilated wooden floor, and placed so that each consignment can be segregated if required and used in order of its age. Bags shall not be stacked more than 1.5m high. Cement shall not be stored out of doors, except for immediate use, and in such event shall be protected during storage and handling by waterproof covers and a raised floor. Unused cement shall be placed back into the storage buildings. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 124
(8) Arrangements shall be made such that stocks of approved cement are adequate to meet the programme of work at all times. The programme shall allow time for testing and approval of each consignment before such cement is incorporated in the work. (9) Cement shall be preferably used in same order in which it has been received at the Site. Storage of cement shall be limited to 90 days in bags and 150 days in bulk. Cement that has been in storage for longer than these periods or which may have absorbed moisture shall not be used unless it has been re-tested by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer-in-charge. Cement that has become lumpy shall not be used. The cements coming from different mills or of different makes shall be stored separately. (10) The temperature of cement upon arrival to the Site shall not exceed 70C and when entering the mixers shall not exceed 50C unless otherwise approved. (11) Fly ash (pozolana) shall not be allowed to be mixed with cement at place other than factory/manufacturing unit. Fly ash (pozolana) mixed at factory shall conform to IS:3812 and IS:1344. (12) The Contractor is solely responsible for the timely supply of cement meeting the requirements of these Specifications and the Works. The delay due to the lack of suitable cement will not give the Contractor any right for the extension of time for the Completion of Works, or any claims resulting therefrom. 9.4.2 AGGREGATE 9.4.2.1 General (1) Unless otherwise specified, concrete aggregates shall conform to the requirements of IS:456 and IS:383. They shall be tested in accordance with the provisions of IS:2386. (2) Aggregates shall consist of clean, hard, dense, durable and uncoated materials, and shall have a stable moisture content and grading when delivered to the batching plant. Aggregates shall not contain substances which may impair the quality of the concrete, attack reinforcing steel or reduce bond. The following substances are regarded as being harmful: loam, clay, pieces with large cavities, foam-like or vitreous pieces, and organic materials such as topsoil, roots, wood, coal, lignite, etc. In doubtful cases the effects of harmful substances shall be established by tests. (3) Use of aggregates containing minerals which can cause alkali reactivity shall be permitted with use of Portland Pozzolana Cement conforming to IS 1489, subject to the approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. Presence of such minerals in the stones to be used as aggregates shall be determined by testing. (4) The shape of the particles shall be generally spherical or cubical. The amount of flat or elongated particles shall not exceed 25% by weight. A flat or elongated particle is defined as one in which the width to thickness, respectively length to width ratio is greater than 3. Rock which break down into such shape, regardless of the type of processing equipment used, will not be approved for use in the production of aggregates. (5) The Contractor shall make provisions for crushing and processing of material in accordance with recommendations contained in IS:383 to meet the gradation and other requirements of these Specifications, in order to obtain the total amount of aggregate required for concrete manufacture. Crushing, screening and washing operations, benefaction of aggregates, and blending of crushed and natural aggregates shall at all time be subject to the consent of the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) The handling, transporting, and stockpiling of aggregates shall be such that there will be a minimum amount of fines resulting from breakage and abrasion of material 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 125
resulting from free fall and improper handling. Excess in any of fine or coarse aggregate sizes shall be disposed of in approved manner. (7) The Contractor shall remove all rejected aggregate from the Site. 9.4.2.2 Source (1) Coarse and fine aggregates shall be produced from suitable material obtained from required excavation for Permanent and Temporary Works and from the approved quarry and borrow areas shown on the Tender Drawings or from other sources as may be designated or approved in the course of the work. (2) The Contractor shall carefully clear the area from which aggregates are to be produced of unsuitable materials and other objectionable matter. The area shall be operated so as not to detract from the usefulness of the area. All materials removed from the area and not used in the work shall be disposed of as directed. (3) Alternative sources developed by the Contractor shall be subjected to approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall carry out tests to furnish satisfactory evidence that aggregates from such alternative sources comply with the requirements of this Section. (4) The aggregate source shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. However, such approval of source shall not be construed as acceptance of all materials to be taken from that source. The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to reject certain localised areas, strata, or channels within the approved areas and zones, when the material is unsatisfactory for use. 9.4.2.3 Fine Aggregates (1) The term "fine aggregate" is used to designate aggregate in which the maximum size of particles is 4.75mm. (2) The gradation of fine aggregate shall be as per IS:383 (3) The percentage of deleterious substance in the fine aggregate shall conform to IS:383, except that the fine aggregate shall contain not more than 0.1% by weight of deleterious (reactive) ferrous sulphide. The total percentage of deleterious substance must not exceed 5% by weight. (4) Fine aggregate having specific gravity of less than 2.6 shall be rejected. Fine aggregates, when subjected to soundness test with a solution of sodium sulphate, after five cycles of tests, shall not suffer a loss of weight in excess of 10 per cent. (5) Fine aggregate, upon delivery to the batching plant, shall have a uniform and stable moisture content. The amount of moisture shall be less then 6% by weight, and shall not vary by more than 0.5% per hour. 9.4.2.4 Coarse Aggregates (1) The term "coarse aggregate" is used to designate aggregate which is retained on sieve opening 4.75mm. The coarse aggregate shall be well graded and its gradation will be decided based on the laboratory tests to obtain dense mass of concrete. The gradation will be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before production of the concrete. (2) Coarse aggregates shall be stored separately in stockpiles or bins in such a manner to avoid intermixing of different size of aggregates. The storing shall be done in following sizes: 4.75-10 mm 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 126
10-20 mm 20-40 mm 40-80 mm (3) The percentage of deleterious substance in the coarse aggregate shall conform to IS:383, except that the coarse aggregate shall contain not more than 0.3% by weight of deleterious (reactive) ferrous sulphide. (4) When subjected to following tests as specified in IS:2386 (Part IV), the coarse aggregate shall comply with following requirements: High Performance Concrete All Other Concrete (a) Aggregate Crushing Value Less than 30% Less than 45% (b) Aggregate Impact Value Less than 30% Less than 45% (c) Los Angles abrasion value Less than 30% Less than 50% (5) When subjected to sodium sulphate soundness test, coarse aggregate shall not suffer a loss of weight in excess of 12% after five cycles. (6) Coarse aggregate shall be hard, dense, durable, uncoated rock fragments. Rock having an absorption greater than 3% or specific gravity less than 2.5 shall not be used. (7) Aggregate delivered to the batching plant shall have a uniform and stable moisture content. (8) The nominal maximum aggregate size in relation to the structure dimension shall not be larger than: a) 0.20 of the narrowest dimension between the side of forms, b) 0.75 of the minimum clear spacing between the reinforcing bars, c) 0.25 of the slab depth. 9.4.2.5 Aggregate Storage (1) Aggregates shall be stored in a manner so that each size of aggregate is stored separately in free-draining piles in a manner that reduces breakage, deterioration, contamination and segregation to a minimum. Storage arrangements shall be subject to acceptance by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Contractor shall maintain sufficient aggregate storage at the Site at all times to permit continuous placement of concrete in accordance with the contractual time schedule. (3) The moisture content of aggregates shall be controlled as far as practicable, by wetting the stockpiles and by adequate drainage. All aggregate shall remain in a free-draining stockpile for at least 12 hours prior to use. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 127
(4) The preparation of stockpile areas, the storage of processed aggregates and the disposal of any rejected material shall at all times be subject to the approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) Materials shall be removed from stockpiles by methods which minimise segregation and crushing. No fine aggregate from the bottom 500 mm of the stockpile shall be used for mixing concrete. 9.4.3 Water (1) A reliable and adequate water supply shall be installed and maintained by the Contractor for washing of aggregates, manufacturing and curing of concrete. The water shall be clean and free from harmful quantities of oil, acids, alkalis, sugar, salt, silt and other organic matters and shall conform to IS:456. (2) Water shall contain not more than 1,000 mg/l of sulphates (SO 4 ), not more than 100 mg/l of chlorides (Cl), and shall have a turbidity limit of not more than 1,000 ppm. (3) Adequate water storage shall be provided at the batching plant to ensure smooth concrete production. (4) Contractor shall familiarise himself with source and quality of water available. Attention is drawn to the possible requirement of settling pond and other facilities that he may be required to provide. 9.4.4 Admixtures (1) Admixtures shall be proposed by the Contractor and shall be used only upon written approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Only admixtures that have been commercially used with satisfactory service in a similar type of concrete work shall be considered for approval. All admixtures shall be manufactured by a reputable company(ies), supported by a fully staffed technical service organisation and research group. (2) The Contractor may use the following admixtures when required with the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge: a) Superplasticizer meeting requirement of ASTM C-494, Type F. b) Air-entraining agent, (complying to IS 9103 : 1999) c) Accelerating agent in the concrete, mortar or grout to increase the rate of hydration, shorten the setting time or increase the rate of hardening or strength development, (complying to IS 9103 : 1999) d) Micro -Silica or silica fume. (3) Admixtures shall be stored and handled so as to avoid contamination or damage to their properties by temperature or moisture changes or other influences. (4) The quantity of admixture used and the method of mixing shall be strictly in accordance with the manufacturer's printed instructions, or as required to produce specified results and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) The Contractor shall be held liable for any damages and difficulties resulting from the selection and use of admixtures such as delay in concrete placing or damage to concrete during forms removal, and shall not be entitled to any time extension or claims resulting herefrom. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 128
9.5 CONCRETE MIX DESIGN 9.5.1 General (1) Denomination of concrete classes is based on the nominal cube compressive strength (in Newton per square mm) and maximum aggregate size. (2) The cube compressive strength is defined as the strength as measured at 28 days. The strength shall comply with the requirements of IS:456. (3) The following table shows, in general, the anticipated classes of concrete required in various sections of work. The specific class of concrete to be used in each area will be shown on the Construction Drawings or designated by Engineer-in-Charge: Class of concrete Max. size of aggreg. Nominal cement content Max. slump 28-day strength Location (mm) (kg) (mm) (N/mm 2 ) High Performance Concrete (HPC) 20 500 120 50 Invert of Flushing Tunnels / Diversion /Spillway and Silt Flushing Tunnels M30 20 500 120 30 Selected locations for Second Stage Concreting around Embedded Parts M25 20 370 120 25 Lining of Hydraulic Tunnel, Shafts, Face slab of CFRD and Plinth M25 40 370 120 25 Intake and Outlet Structures, Desilting Chamber, Face slab of CFRD, Plinth, Beams, Columns, Slabs and Footings, etc. M20 20 315 120 20 Various Unspecified Locations M20 40 315 120 20 Backfill behind Steel Liner and Various Unspecified Locations M15 40 225 120 15 Backfill concrete behind Ribs in Tunnels M15 80 225 120 15 Various Unspecified Locations M10 20/40 200 50 10 Extruded curb Concrete, Lean and Plum Concrete M10 80 200 50 10 Lean and Plum Concrete
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 129
(4) At least 4 months prior to commencement of any concreting of Permanent Works, the Contractor shall start the testing of materials, propose the composition of concrete mixes and prepare trial mix of each of the proposed concrete class. The Contractor shall prepare the trial mixes using the cement, water, aggregates and admixtures intended for the work and which conform to the requirements specified in this Section. (5) Contractor shall determine, in accordance with IS standards and/or ACI Manual of Concrete Practice, the mix proportions for the designated classes of concrete. The contractor shall submit the test reports to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval. This preliminary test program shall include the determination of following parameters: a) Cement properties, b) Characteristics of aggregates, c) Mix water properties, d) Admixture properties, e) Proportion of aggregate ranges in the mix, f) Proportion of uncrushed to crushed aggregates, g) Cement content, h) Water-cement ratio (W/C), i) Workability of concrete mixes, j) Compressive and tensile strength, k) Entrained air, l) Density, m) Water-tightness. (6) These test shall be carried out until the concrete mixes show appropriate strength, workability, density, and water-tightness without the use of excessive cement and water. The actual cement content in the mix design shall be optimized and justified by using cement of various manufacturers during trial mix design (7) To carry out these preconstruction tests, full scale machine-mixed test batches shall be made and test samples taken therefrom. Tests shall be made in ample time so that complete and acceptable results are available before concreting of structures. (8) Test samples shall be made in accordance with IS:1199 and tested in accordance with IS:516. The test results shall be analysed in accordance with IS:456. (9) The mixes for different classes of concrete shall be approved by the Engineer-in- Charge. (10) During the progress of the work, the mixes may be changed whenever, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, such change is necessary or desirable to secure the required strength, workability, water-tightness, density, economy, or to limit shrinkage. The Contractor shall not change the approved mix proportions without the written permission of the Engineer-in-Charge. (11) Water to be added to the mix shall be adjusted to compensate for any variation in the free moisture content of the aggregate as they enter the batch plant. Water beyond the specified water-cement ratio shall not be added without the written permission of the Engineer-in-Charge. 9.6 HIGH PERFORMANCE CONCRETE (1) High performance concrete shall be obtained by adding suitable percentage of silica fumes (6-8% of cement weight used in the mix or as per the trial mix design for 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 130
attaining the required strength of concrete mentioned in the drawings) in the concrete and with the use of Super plasticizer. Following are the design requirements: Characteristic 28 days compressive strength 50 Mpa Maximum aggregate size 20 mm Design slump 120 mm Maximum water/(cement +silica fume) ratio 0.32 To achieve the above requirement, tentative mix design may consist of the following Cement 500 kg Silica fume 35 kg. Superplasticizer As Required (2) Actual mix proportion to be used will be determined by trial mix design. Test samples shall be made in accordance with IS:1199, tested as per IS:516 and analyzed as per IS:456. Source of aggregate for high performance concrete shall meet the requirement of wearing surface and shall be as identified by Engineer-in-charge (3) Silica fume shall comply with ASTM C1240-03a. It shall meet the following requirements: Chemical Requirements (a) Sio 2 , min. % 85 (b) Moisture Content % 3 (c) Loss on ignition % 6
Physical Requirements Oversize: Percent retained on 45m (no.325), % 10 Percent retained on 45m (no.325), max. variation from average, percentage points 5 Accelerated pozzolanic strength activity index with portland cement at 7days, min. percent of control 10 % Specific Surface, min, m 2 /g 15 The Contractor shall present the results of quality control tests carried on a representative sample by the supplier. Once approved, the silica fume shall only be supplied from the same production plant. Deliveries shall be in impervious sacks weighing about 40 kg and shall be accompanied by manufacturers quality assurance certificates. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 131
9.7 QUALITY CONTROL 9.7.1 General (1) The Contractor shall be completely responsible for performing detailed quality control program during the execution of the work. This quality assurance program shall be subject to inspection and checking by the Engineer-In-Charge. (2) The Contractor shall keep records of test results which shall be presented to the Engineer-in-Charge upon request. (3) Should the Contractor wish to reduce his approved testing program he shall notify the Engineer-in-Charge of these changes 2 weeks in advance. (4) Aside from Contractor's testing program the Engineer-in-Charge will make control test to the extent as he deems necessary. The Contractor shall give all required assistance in sampling and provide for the proper storage and transport of the specimens to be tested by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) The Contractor shall make such arrangements or purchase a new equipment should the test results prove that changes in the aggregates or concrete plant are necessary to obtain required concrete quality. 9.7.2 Site Laboratory (1) The Contractor shall build, equip, and operate the site laboratory in which the tests included in the Quality Control Programme will be carried out. In some cases where special tests are required, they will be made in other specialised laboratories after approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The laboratory shall be equipped with all the necessary equipment to carry out the tests indicated below. a) Tests on aggregates as per IS 2386 (Parts I, II, III, IV) - Sieve analysis - Compressive strength - Specific gravity - Water absorption - Flakiness - Sand equivalent - Soundness and organic matter - Los Angeles abrasion b) Tests on cement - Equivalent alkaline content (IS 4032) - Specific Blaine surface (IS 4031 (6)) - Standard Mortar Compressive Strength (IS 4031 (6)) - Shrinkage (IS 4031 (10)) - Heat of hydration (IS 4031 (9)) - Setting time IS 4031 (5)) c) Tests on fresh concrete - Consistency through slump test (IS 1199) - Workability - Heat of hydration using thermometers, cells and recording instruments d) Tests on hardened concrete - Compressive strength on all classes of concrete (IS 516) 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 132
- Shrinkage IS 4031 (10)) (3) The site laboratory shall be properly air-conditioned and equipped with temperature and relative humidity recording instruments. 9.7.3 Concrete Sampling and Testing 9.7.3.1 Aggregates (1) Aggregate samples shall be taken from silos at the batching plant or from the conveyor belt. (2) The sampling shall be done at the frequency of one every 1,000 m3 of produced concrete (cumulative of all concrete classes) and once a week at minimum. (3) The following tests will be carried out : - Sieve analysis - Sand equivalent - Cleanliness of gravel - Flakiness of gravel - Los Angeles abrasion - Crushing Value - Impact Value 9.7.3.2 Cement (1) Quality control of cement shall first take place at the cement factory. This will be exercised by the factory itself under the supervision and the follow-up of the Contractor who shall submit the copies of test results of cement to the Engineer-in-charge for final approval. The quality control program will be established jointly with the Contractor and shall be submitted for the approval of the Engineer-in-charge. To ensure that this quality control program is properly conduced, the Contractor shall post at the factory one of his officials, when necessary (2) The requirements on the Site laboratory are stipulated in the Section "Site Installations and Services". (3) Once a train has been loaded at the factory and is ready for departure, six samples will be taken in six different cars and mixed in order to prepare one unique sample which will be split into two parts: - The first part will be analysed by the cement factory laboratory, - The second part will be despatched to the Site laboratory. (4) The following tests will be carried out at both laboratories and compared : - Setting time, - Expansion - Specific Blaine surface - Equivalent alkali content - Standard mortar compressive strength - Heat of hydration (5) Furthermore, each week, a sample of cement shall be taken at the batching plant and the following tests shall be carried out: - Setting time, - Specific Blaine surface, - Standard mortar compressive strength at 3, 7 and 28 days. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 133
9.7.3.3 Admixtures (1) Admixtures to be used for concrete production shall be tested for their suitability with the cement and other materials under actual working conditions. Each shipment of admixtures shall be tested for density and dry extract. (2) Admixtures older than 12 months, after their fabrication, shall be tested for deterioration. (3) Shipment of which the tested sample has not passed the criteria shall be rejected. 9.7.3.4 Water (1) A sample of water will be taken from the concrete batch plant every 3 months and submitted to chemical analysis as described in IS 3025. 9.7.3.5 Fresh Concrete (1) The following tests shall be carried out by the Contractor on fresh concrete samples: - Consistency (slump tests) on all concrete classes (sieved at 40 mm for 80 mm size of aggregate concrete), - Air content, - Temperature. (2) These tests shall be carried out at the beginning of manufacturing of the concrete for each work or part of the work and for large quantities once every 100 m3. (3) All consistency tests shall be determined on that portion of the total sample which passes a 40 mm size. (4) Air content shall be determined in accordance with the established standard. (5) One air test (0.006 m3 capacity bowl) is required at the beginning of each shift, whenever a class change occurs, whenever air test results are deviating from specifications and at 500 m3 intervals for each class of concrete in production. (6) Routine air tests as noted above will be determined on that portion of the total sample which passes a 40 mm sieve size. 9.7.3.6 Hardened Concrete (1) Set of six samples for compressive strength tests at 7 and 28 days will be taken and tested for each part of the work, being defined as the volume poured in one concreting operation. (2) For large concreting operations, this set of sample will be taken every 200 m3. (3) Compressive strength specimens shall be prepared by the Contractor and shall be performed in accordance with Indian Standards and Code of Practice. (4) All coarse aggregate larger than one quarter the minimum dimension of the mould will be removed by wet screening. Portions of samples of concrete used for slump, air content, unit weight, etc. will not be used to mould specimens for compressive strength testing. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 134
9.7.3.7 Analysis of Results (1) The test results will include the different components analyses, the values obtained on fresh and hardened concrete and the characteristics of the corresponding batch given by the printer of the batching plant. (2) The Contractor shall present regularly to the Engineer-in-Charge a synthesis of all the results in the form of tables, charts, statistical analyses (weekly and monthly reports). 9.7.3.8 Concrete Plant (1) Monthly checks, or when requested by the Engineer-in-Charge, of the concrete plant's weight-batching accuracy, including the accuracy of any admixture dispenser, shall be made by the Contractor in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge. When checked by standard weights and volumes its accuracy shall be within 0.5% or as specified by the manufacturer. 9.8 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA 9.8.1 Concrete Components (1) The measured values shall be within the specified range of values indicated above. (2) Any unsuitable material should be eliminated and the concrete manufacturing be suspended until the Contractor justifies that the replacing component is acceptable. 9.8.2 Fresh Concrete (1) Any controlled batch which will not satisfy the specified conditions in terms of consistency, air content and temperature, will be eliminated and concreting suspended until it is shown that corrections brought to the following batches are satisfactory. 9.8.3 Hardened Concrete (1) The acceptance criteria for hardened concrete shall be as per the clause 15 of IS:456. (2) If analysis of test cube results indicate poorer concrete in the structure as per the acceptance criteria of clause 15 of IS:456, the Engineer-in-Charge will order the Contractor to provide core tests. Location and number of cores will be decided by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall take out the specified sizes of cores from the structure. (3) In case the concrete cores fail to meet the specifications and the Engineer-in-Charge is not satisfied with various tests results and quality, he will then instruct the Contractor for removal or subsequent suitable strengthening measures for such works. 9.9 BATCHING AND MIXING 9.9.1 General (1) The Contractor shall provide, operate, and maintain at the Site automatic batching equipment to determine and control the amount of each individual material entering the concrete. Batching equipment shall be designed for such capacities which will permit performance of the concrete work in accordance with Contractual Construction Program. (2) Water, cement, admixtures, fine aggregate and coarse aggregate shall be measured separately and not cumulatively. The accuracy of the measuring devices shall be 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 135
maintained so that the indicated measure does not vary by more than 1 per cent from true measure throughout their range of use. The devices shall be capable of being operated to control the delivery of materials so that the combined inaccuracies in feeding and measuring do not exceed the following limits: Material Percent (by weight) Cement 1 Water 1 Aggregates 3 Admixtures 1 9.9.2 Batching Equipment (1) At the batching plant, standard certified test weights shall be provided and such other auxiliary equipment as may be necessary to check the operating performance of each scale or other measuring device. When required by the Engineer-in-Charge, operator shall make these tests in his presence. Unless otherwise required by the Engineer-in- Charge, check tests of equipment used for measuring water, cement aggregates and admixtures shall be made at least every week. After completion of each check test, operator shall report the results to the Engineer-in-Charge and make such adjustment, repairs or replacement as the Engineer-in-Charge deems necessary to secure satisfactory performance before further use of the measuring devices. (2) The batching equipment shall be capable of handling a minimum of three different sets of mix proportions concurrently, without having to reset scales manually, and recording the number of batches of each mix separately. (3) Each measuring unit shall include a visible springless dial (metric) which will register the scale load at any stage of the measuring operation or shall include an over-and- under indicator which will show the scale in balance at no load when loaded to the beam setting. The masses of the components of each batch shall be automatically recorded and the records submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge at daily intervals. (4) Each measuring indicator and volume measuring device shall be in full view of the operator, and the measuring equipment shall be arranged so that the operator may conveniently observe the operation of the bin gates, the materials discharging into the mixer and the concrete during mixing and discharging. The batch panel shall be equipped with chatter controls to control the dribble for each material batched and a volume selector capable of settings from 1 m3 up to the mixer capacity in increments of 1 m3. (5) The batching equipment shall be so constructed and arranged that the sequence and timing of the batcher discharge gates can be controlled to produce an intermixing of the aggregate, water and cementing materials, as the materials pass through the charging hopper into the mixer. The batching controls shall be so interlocked that a new batching cycle cannot be started until all the weighing hoppers are completely empty. (6) The operating mechanism in the water measuring device shall be such that no leakage will occur when the valves are closed and the discharge valve cannot be opened until the filling valve is closed. (7) The device for adding admixtures shall be interlocked with the batching and discharging operation of the water so that the batching and discharging of the admixtures will be automatic. The device shall be capable of permitting the quantity of 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 136
admixture being batched to be adjusted should this prove necessary, and shall be equipped with a suitable warning device to indicate when the level in the reservoir tank is low. (8) A calibrated container shall be incorporated in each admixture holding system such that normally the admixture will bypass the container during batching. However, at any time it will be possible to direct the batched material into the container to check the accuracy of measurement. (9) The batching equipment shall include an accurate recorder for providing a continuous visible record of the measurement of each separate material, including all added water and admixture. (10) The measuring and recording equipment shall be supported on foundations independent of those for the mixing plant to prevent them from being affected by vibration. (11) Effective communication system including telephone shall be provided between the concrete plant and the point of placement at all times, and such facilities shall also be available at either location for use by the Engineer-in-Charge as required. (12) Volume batching will not be permitted. (13) In case of use of fully automated batching plant, all the recording and indicating system intentioned above shall be available and on-line control of all components of the batching plant shall be provided. 9.9.3 Mixing (1) Concrete shall be mixed in a power- driven stationary batch mixers of approved type and size. They shall be kept clean and in proper working order. The mixing blades in the drum shall be replaced when worn by 10% of their design dimensions. (2) Movable truck mixers shall not be permitted for mixing concrete mixes. (3) The batching plant shall be provided with a bypass such that the mix materials can be discharged directly into a transit mixer drum. This bypass is to be used only in emergency and with permission of the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) The mixing equipment shall be capable of combining the aggregate, cementing materials, water and other ingredients, within the time hereinafter specified, into a thoroughly mixed and uniform mass, and of discharging the mixture without segregation. (5) The mixers shall be so charged that some water will enter in advance of cement and aggregate and all materials shall continue to flow in as rapidly as possible. The construction of the mixers should prevent loss of materials during charging. (6) The mixers shall not be charged beyond their rated capacities and the entire contents of the mixer shall be discharged before recharging. (7) Unless otherwise authorised by the Engineer-in-Charge for mixers of 1m3 capacity or less, the mixing of each batch shall continue for not less than +1.5 minutes as specified in IS:456 (but not more than 5 minutes when mixing air-entrained concrete) after all materials, except the full amount of water, are in the mixer. For mixers of larger capacity, the minimum mixing time will be increased by 15 seconds for each additional 0.5 m3. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 137
(8) The mixing time shall be increased when, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, the charging and mixing operations fail to result in the required uniformity of composition and consistency within the batch and from batch to batch. (9) Mixers shall be rotated at the rate recommended by the manufacturer of the mixers. (10) The arrangement for controlling, measuring and mixing operations shall be such that the operator may observe the concrete discharging from the mixer. (11) Each mixer shall be equipped with a mechanically or electrically operated timing and signalling device for indicating and assuring the completion of the required mixing period and for counting the batches. (12) Should a mixer at any time prove unsatisfactory, it shall be replaced or its use discontinued until it is made satisfactory. (13) Each mixer shall be cleaned after each period of continuous operation and shall be maintained in such a condition that the mixing action will not be impaired. (14) Where the distance between the batching plant and a concrete pour is such that it would in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge cause deterioration of mixed concrete in transit, dry batching may be permitted using transit mix trucks in accordance with IS:457. Water shall be added not later than 30 minutes after batching. (15) On no account shall any addition be made to any component of a concrete batched once that batch has been mixed and discharged from the mixer, whether for the purpose of retempering or for any other reason. (16) Batching and mixing of concrete shall not commence unless due notice, at least 24 hours in advance, has been given to the Engineer-in-Charge and written approval has been obtained for the placing arrangements, and for the preparation and accuracy of the part of the Works in which concrete is to be placed. 9.10 CONVEYING (1) The method and facilities for concrete transport shall be selected by the Contractor within the limitations of these Specifications, and he shall be responsible for adequacy and suitability of the transporting system. The time elapse between mixing and the initial set of the concrete shall be taken into consideration. All methods used shall be reviewed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The concrete transporting methods and facilities shall be such that will prevent segregation of coarse aggregate, excessive loss of slump, and loss of ingredients. Equipment such as buckets, cars, conveyers and pumping equipment which may be used for conveying concrete, shall be of such size, design and condition as to ensure an even and adequate supply of concrete at the placement area. All equipment shall be kept clean and in good working condition. (3) The use of chutes to convey concrete will not be permitted, except that chutes less than 3m in total length may be used immediately adjacent to or in the forms with acceptance of the Engineer-in-Charge. Where chutes are used, they shall be so constructed and arranged as to permit continuous flow of the concrete without separation of the ingredients. (4) There shall be no vertical drop greater than 1.5m, except where equipment satisfactory to the Engineer-in-Charge is used to confine and control the falling concrete. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 138
(5) Concrete may be dropped through flexible elephant-trunk chutes, provided methods are used at the lower end to retard the speed of the falling concrete and prevent it from segregating. Where it is necessary to drop concrete from more than 1.5m it shall fall into a hopper with a capacity of 1m3 more than the total capacity of the full trunk. (6) All conveying plant shall be supported independently of the forms, except as specifically permitted by the Engineer-in-Charge. (7) The conveying plant shall be kept free from hardened concrete and foreign materials, and shall be cleaned at frequent intervals. 9.11 PLACING 9.11.1 General (1) Contractor shall place concrete in a given location only after the Engineer-in-Charge has agreed with the placement of such concrete. All concrete shall be placed in presence of the Engineer-in-Charge. Concrete placed without prior knowledge and approval of the Engineer-in-Charge may be required to be removed and replaced at Contractor's debit. (2) The Contractor shall furnish, install, maintain and operate a telephone system or radio, linking the points of placing concrete with the concrete batching and mixing plant. These facilities shall also be available to the Engineer-in-Charge at all times. (3) When placing the concrete by pumping, direct communication shall be maintained between the concrete placing crew and the pump operators. (4) In order to reduce bleeding, slump shall not be higher than necessary to achieve proper placement and consolidation. Concrete shall be placed before initial set has occurred, i.e. 60 to 90 minutes after adding water to the mix. (5) No concrete shall be placed when the atmospheric conditions are, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, such that proper placing and hardening of the concrete are not guarantied. Specifically, the Contractor shall have the responsibility for meeting the hot and cold weather concreting requirements and for postponing concreting whenever such requirements cannot be met or, based on weather forecast, probably cannot be met. Even if the above requirements are fulfilled, the Contractor has the responsibility of delivering concrete product that meets specified requirements. 9.11.2 Preparation for Concrete Placing (1) Concrete shall not be placed until all formwork, installation of embedded parts, reinforcing steel, and surfaces against which concrete is to be cast have been accepted by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) All surfaces of forms and embedded items that have become encrusted with dried material from concrete previously placed shall be cleaned of all such material before the surrounding or adjacent concrete is placed. (3) Concrete shall not be placed in any structure until all water entering the space to be filled with concrete has been properly cut off or diverted by pipes, or by other means, and carried out of the forms clear of the work. Water shall not be allowed to stand on any concrete surface until it has attained its final set. Water flow over the concrete, which may injure the surface finish will not be allowed. (4) Pipes, conduits, dowels and other items to be embedded in concrete shall be so positioned and supported prior to placement of concrete to be stable and provide 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 139
sufficient clearance (50 mm min.) between said items and steel reinforcement to allow proper concreting. Securing such items in position by wiring or welding to reinforcement will not be permitted. (5) Where excavated surfaces which are to form the foundations for structural concrete, are absorptive or likely to become otherwise unsuitable, or where shown on the Construction Drawings, the Contractor shall place a 'blinding course' consisting of a layer of Class M10 or M15 concrete 50 to 100 mm thick, as directed by the Engineer- in-Charge, uniformly over the foundation such that the upper surface is at grade elevation. Blinding concrete shall be placed before installing reinforcement or formwork. (6) Immediately before concreting, the forms and all other surfaces which will be in contact with the fresh concrete shall be cleaned of all loose material and debris including shavings, wood chips, sawdust, pieces of wire, nails, fragments of hardened concrete and mortar. Clean-out holes which may be needed for this purpose shall subsequently be securely closed in order to obtain the required surface finish. (7) The use of compressed air for cleaning will be allowed only if adequate precautions are taken to avoid the deposition of suspended oil on construction joint surfaces, reinforcement or other items which are to be bonded to concrete. (8) The Contractor shall provide such personnel and equipment so that the performance of the concrete work is in a satisfactory manner. The transporting and placing equipment shall be clean and in good condition, adequate, and properly arranged to proceed with the placing without undue delays. The number and condition of vibrators for use and standby shall be ample for the requirements during placement. The lighting system shall be sufficient to illuminate the inside of the forms when concrete is placed at night. (9) The Contractor shall have protective coverings available for fresh concrete surfaces if there is a possibility of rain, hail, sleet, or snow. (10) Rock surfaces against which concrete is to be placed shall be clean and free from oil, standing or running water, mud, loose rock, objectionable coating, debris, and loose or unsound fragment. Faults, fissures and seams shall be cleaned to sound rock, and if directed, backfilled with dental concrete, shotcrete or dry-pack as appropriate. (11) Immediately before concrete is placed, all surfaces shall be cleaned thoroughly by the use of high velocity air-water jets, sweeping with brooms, wet sandblasting, bush- hammering, or other satisfactory means including combinations of the above. (12) Rock surface against which concrete is to be placed shall be kept wet for at least 12 hours during the 24-hour period prior to placing concrete and shall be in a damp condition at the time of placing, with all pools of water removed. (13) Before placing the concrete for tunnel lining the following requirements should be met: a) The excavated cross section profile shall be carefully checked to ensure the minimum lining thickness requirements and if necessary it should be corrected, b) All loose rock which has been trapped by the wire mesh covering over the excavated surface shall be cleared and the mesh be repaired and if necessary replaced, c) All timber supports, large wooden wedges used during the initial assembly and erection of steel supports shall be removed, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 140
d) Inverts of tunnel and shafts shall be totally cleaned of debris leaving sound rock wherever required the Contractor shall use mechanical tools to loosen and remove all loosened and blast damaged rock. (14) Before any concrete is cast against previously placed concrete, the surface of the old concrete shall be prepared as described in sub-section "Construction J oints". 9.11.3 Placing and Compaction (1) Concrete shall be carefully placed in designated position. Where dense reinforcement or deep forms may cause segregation of concrete while placing, suitable methods shall be used to prevent segregation. The free fall of concrete shall not exceed 1.5 m. (2) Concrete shall be placed directly in its permanent position and shall not be worked along the forms to that position. Vibrators shall not be used to move concrete laterally. (3) The addition of water into concrete after batching to compensate for stiffening of the concrete before placing shall not be permitted. (4) All concrete, with exception of concrete tunnel lining, shall be placed in continuous approximately horizontal layers. The thickness of the layers shall not exceed 400 mm for mass concrete, and 500 mm for structural and all other concrete. Each layer shall be soft when a new layer is placed upon it so that no seams or planes of weakness within the section can form, and the two layers shall be made monolithic by penetration of vibrators. (5) The Engineer-in-Charge reserves the right to order a reduced thickness of layers where the layers as stated above cannot be placed in accordance with the requirements of these Specifications. (6) Time interval between successive lifts of mass concrete shall be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. Nevertheless a minimum of 72 hours shall elapse between successive lifts. (7) No concrete shall be placed under water except where shown on the Construction Drawings or specifically so required by the Engineer-in-Charge. No concrete shall be placed in running water. Water shall not be allowed to rise over freshly poured concrete until final set has been achieved. (8) Each layer of concrete shall be consolidated to the maximum practicable density, be free from pockets of coarse aggregate, completely fill all recesses in forms and around embedded parts, and be free of all voids. The concrete shall be compacted and worked into all corners and angles of the forms, around reinforcement and embedded items without permitting the component concrete materials to segregate. (9) No layer of concrete shall be placed until the previous layer in the same lift has been thoroughly consolidated. Each layer of concrete within a lift shall be covered with fresh concrete as soon as possible, but certainly within the period when the lower layer is still capable of being revibrated so that successive layers can be thoroughly worked together. (10) The maximum permissible time between the placing successive layers in a pour shall not exceed initial setting time of cement or 45 minutes, whichever is less, and shall be reduced to suit the temperature, humidity and job conditions. Concrete shall not be piled up in the forms in a manner that causes movement of the unconsolidated concrete, or permits mortar to escape from the coarse aggregate. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 141
(11) On proposal of the Contractor and with the Engineer-in-Charge's approval, the concrete lining in tunnel may be placed in one continuous pour from invert to crown with construction joints normal to the axis of the tunnel over the full cross section, or continuous placing may be adopted with a sloping joint corresponding to natural angle of repose at end of each concreting cycle. (12) Concreting of lining shall be carried out by concrete pump using methods which do not cause segregation or requiring remixing of the concrete. The point of discharge when concreting the crown above the springing line shall be kept buried sufficiently to allow enough pressure to be built up to completely fill the crown including areas of overbreak in the crown if any. (13) Concrete shall be consolidated with the aid of approved immersion type mechanical vibrators complying with IS:2505 or electric or air driven vibrators operating at a speed of at least 7,000 cycles/minute when immersed in the concrete. The vibrating equipment shall at all times be adequate in number of units and power to penetrate concrete as it is being placed, to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge. Vibrators with flexible operating shafts shall be used for reinforced concrete and for concrete in restricted forms. At least one extra vibrator in working condition shall be constantly on hand at each point of placement for emergency use. (14) Application of the vibrators shall be made systematically and at such intervals that the zones of influence overlap and the concrete is properly compacted. (15) Every vibrator shall be operated in a near vertical position and the vibrating head shall be allowed to penetrate under the action of its own weight. In consolidating each layer of concrete, the vibrating head shall be allowed to penetrate and revibrate the concrete in the upper portion of the underlying layers. Extreme care shall be taken to ensure that the vibrators do not touch or disturb the reinforcing, embedded steel or forms. (16) To ensure even and dense surfaces which are free from aggregate pockets, honeycombing or air holes, it may be necessary to supplement internal vibration with hand-spading along the boundaries of the concrete and around embedded parts while the concrete is plastic under the vibratory action, should slip forms be used, the equipment and methods shall be such that the finished concrete will be well consolidated and homogeneous. (17) Contractor shall use any or all of the above methods of consolidation, if required, to produce the necessary finish. Form vibrators shall not be used unless the forms are designed for form vibration and unless specifically authorised by the Engineer-in- Charge. 9.11.4 Pumping Concrete (1) Positive displacement pumping or other approved methods may be used to place concrete in locations approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. The type and arrangement of equipment shall be subject to approval, and the equipment shall be operated only be experienced persons. Pneumatic placing will not be allowed. (2) The equipment and its method of operation shall allow the concrete to enter the forms at a low velocity. (3) Concrete pumps and auxiliary equipment shall be in good condition and shall be maintained as such throughout the duration of the work. Thorough washing down of all parts that come in contact with concrete shall be performed after each concreting operation. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 142
(4) Pumplines shall consist of rigid steel pipe or flexible pipe made of rubber, spiral-wound flexible metal or plastic, or combination of both. Use of aluminium pipe for pumplines shall not be permitted. Couplings shall be leakproof and strong enough to withstand handling during erection and poor support along the lines. They shall provide a full internal cross section with no constrictions of the smooth flow of concrete. (5) Immediately prior to the start of all concrete pumping, the pump and pumplines shall be primed by pumping an approved grout mixture through the equipment. (6) Concrete pumping operations shall be planned in such a way that concrete does not set before the succeeding layer is place thereon. An adequate supply of fresh concrete shall be provided at all times. (7) When placing the concrete by pumping in tunnel lining, the sides of the lining shall be brought up evenly through windows prepared in the formwork and care shall be taken equal pressure is maintained on the formwork. The crown shall be filled through the slick line running along the top of the formwork. This line shall be deeply buried in the concrete at all times. Identifications marks to indicate the depth of burial shall be provided. The buried pumpline shall be withdrawn from the form gradually as the placement is completed. Air boosters shall not be permitted until slick lines are buried at least 1.5 m into fresh concrete. 9.11.5 Concrete in Blockouts, Second Stage in Restricted Locations, etc. (1) All concrete required to be placed in blockouts to permit the installation and adjustment of mechanical and other equipment, around formed holes and second stage concrete in other locations shall be included in respective concrete as described in these Specifications. (2) The concrete surfaces of blockouts and first stage concrete at other locations shall be chipped and roughened as described herein before second stage concrete is placed at such locations. (3) Exceptional care shall be taken to placing concrete in blockouts in order to ensure satisfactory bond with concrete previously placed and to secure complete contact with all metal works in the blockouts. (4) The roughening of the first stage concrete surfaces shall be attained by chipping or sand blasting as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge and in such a manner as not to loosen, crack or shatter any part of concrete beyond the roughened surfaces. (5) After being roughened, the surfaces of concrete shall be cleaned thoroughly of loose fragments, dirt and the objectionable substances and shall be sound and hard to ensure good mechanical bond between the existing and new concrete. (6) Second stage concrete shall be placed in lifts of not more than 3.0 m and concrete placement rate shall not exceed 1.5 m per hour except as otherwise approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 9.12 FINISHING OF CONCRETE 9.12.1 General (1) The quality of the surface finish shall be in accordance with the requirements for the particular class of finish specified hereunder. The finished surfaces of concrete shall be free from areas of honeycombs, segregation, loss of cement or fine material, from damage due to stripping of forms, from boltholes, abrupt irregularities caused by 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 143
movement of forms or components, loose knots and similar features, and bulges or depressions in the general plane of the surface. (2) Only one type of formwork shall be used for all parts of a concrete structure which is visible from any direction. (3) The classes of finish shall be as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 9.12.2 Formed Surfaces (1) The classes of finish for formed surfaces are designated by the use of symbol F and the shape of the formwork panels required for concrete work shall be either plane (F1, F2, F3) or curved (F1C, F2C, F3C). (2) Surface finishes and other variations in finishing of concrete shall conform to the tolerances indicated below: Type of finish General areas of application and method of forming Tolerances (in mm) F1, F1C Formed surfaces of construction joints and other surfaces which will not be permanently exposed. The surface will require no treatment after form removal other than repair of defective concrete and specified curing, or treatment as specified for construction joints. +25 -10 F2, F2C All permanently exposed formed surfaces. Immediately on the removal of forms all unsightly ridges or fins shall be removed; all holes left by removal of ends of form rods shall be neatly filled with mortar and surfaces treated to meet the required tolerances by tooling and rubbing. +10 -10 F3, F3C Formed surfaces which will be exposed to flowing water. These surfaces shall be hard, smooth and dense, free from offsets, pits, voids, air holes and irregularities, and shall be chipped, ground and thoroughly cleaned as necessary to conform to the required tolerances. +3 -3 9.12.3 Unformed Surfaces (1) The classes of finish for unformed concrete surfaces are designated by the use of symbol U and shall be finished by screeding, floating and trowelling. (2) Surface finishes and other variations in finishing of concrete shall conform to the tolerances indicated below. Type of finish General areas of application and method of forming Tolerances (in mm) U1 Unformed, screeded surfaces which will be covered by fill materials. Finishing shall consist of sufficient levelling and screeding to produce an even, uniform surface meeting the required tolerance. +10 -10 U2 Unformed surfaces not concealed by fill. Floating by means of hand or power-driven equipment shall be started as soon as the screeded surface has stiffened sufficiently, and shall be the minimum necessary to produce a surface that is free from +5 -5 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 144
screed marks and that is uniform in texture. U3 Unformed, screeded surfaces which will be exposed to flowing water. This finish shall be applied by steel troweling after the concrete has hardened enough to prevent excess of fine materials and water from being worked to the surface, free from blemishes, ripples and trowel marks. After the surface has nearly hardened, it shall be trowelled once more until the surface is hard and glossy in appearance. +3 -3 (3) Interior surfaces shall be sloped for drainage where shown on the Construction Drawings. Exterior surfaces, which will be exposed to the weather, shall be sloped for drainage even if there is no such indication on the Construction Drawings. In such case the slope shall be at least 2% but not exceed 3%. 9.12.4 Tolerances for General Concrete Structures General Areas of Application Tolerances in mm Variations of the constructed line or outlines from established position in plan In 6 metres In 12 metres In 24 metres or more 12 mm 20 mm 30 mm Variations of dimensions to individual structural features from established position In buried construction Twice the above amount Variations from the plumb, from the specified batter or from the curved surface of all structures, including the lines and the surfaces, walls and vertical joints In 3 metres In 12 metres or more In buried construction 12 mm 30 mm Twice the above amount Variations from the level or from the grades indicated on the drawing In 3 metres In 12 metres or more In buried construction 6 mm 12 mm Twice the above amount Variation in cross sectional dimensions of columns, beams, buttresses, piers and similar members and variation in the thickness of slabs, walls and similar members -6 mm +12 mm Variation from plumb and level for sills and side walls for radial gates and similar watertight joints Not greater than: 3 mm/3 m 9.12.5 Bush Hammer Finish (1) Bush hammer finish shall be applied on the surfaces when required by the Engineer-in- Charge. Bush hammering shall not commence until at least one month after placement of concrete. The tool used for bush hammering shall be electrically driven and have a head 3 cm2 with 16 pyramid shaped teeth. The surfaces shall be finished at a rate of 250 to 400 cm 2 /minute indenting the concrete surface approximately 2 mm. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 145
9.13 CONSTRUCTION JOINTS IN CONCRETE STRUCTURES (1) Construction joints are defined as concrete surfaces on or against which concrete is to be placed and to which new concrete is to adhere and which have become so rigid that the new concrete cannot be incorporated integrally with that previously placed. (2) Construction joints shall be located as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor shall not be permitted to form any additional joints or deviate from the joints, without the written authorisation of the Engineer-in-Charge. Necessary rearrangement of steel reinforcement arising from such modifications shall be to the Contractor's debit. (3) Horizontal construction joints shall be arranged, wherever possible, to coincide with joints in the formwork. (4) J oints at exposed surfaces of concrete shall be straight and continuous. Feather-edged construction joints will not be permitted. (5) The faces of vertical joints shall be shuttered with expanded metal or other approved rough material. The expanded metal shall be removed as far as possible, before the adjacent lift is poured. If required, the surface shall be cleaned by wet sandblasting and roughened by light bush-hammering. (6) The surface of construction joints upon or against which new concrete is to be placed and to which new concrete is to adhere shall be clean, rough, and free of water when covered with fresh concrete. The laitance, loose or defective concrete and foreign material shall be removed from the surface of existing concrete. The previous concrete lift shall be saturated by water but surface dry when the successive lift is placed. (7) The surface of the hardened concrete shall be cleaned and roughened by wet- sandblasting and washing thoroughly with air-water jet. Care shall be taken to prevent undercutting of aggregate in the concrete during sandblasting. (8) Wet-sandblasting equipment shall be operated at an air pressure of approximately 7 bars. Sand to be used for blasting shall be dense, hard, not easily broken and sufficiently dry. (9) In lieu of wet-sandblasting the Contractor may propose high-pressure water blasting utilising pressures not less than 400 bars, provided that such high-pressure water blasting produce equivalent results to those obtainable by wet-sandblasting. (10) The horizontal surfaces of construction joints may be treated by cutting with an air- water jets ("green-cutting") This shall be performed after the initial set has taken place but before the concrete has become too hard for effective cutting. The fresh concrete surface shall be cut with air-water jets to remove all laitance and to expose clean, sound aggregate. After cutting, the surface shall be washed with clean water. Care shall be taken that the treated surface does not become contaminated before new concrete is placed upon it. Should the surface become contaminated that a satisfactory joint with new concrete is not ensured the Contractor shall clean it by means of wet- sandblasting. (11) Water used in cutting, washing and rinsing of concrete surfaces shall be disposed of in such a way that it does not stain, discolour or affect exposed surfaces of the structures. (12) Disturbance of the surface at a joint during the early stages of hardening shall be avoided, and traffic on the concrete will not be permitted until the concrete has hardened sufficiently to withstand such treatment without injury. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 146
(13) All construction joints shall be kept continuously moist until they are covered with concrete, provided that, if it becomes necessary to delay the placement of new concrete on or against a construction joint for an extended period, moist curing of the surface of the joint may be discontinued at the expiration of the regular prescribed curing period. If the moist curing is so discontinued, it shall be resumed not later than 24 hours prior to the placement of new concrete against the joints. 9.14 CURING AND PROTECTION OF CONCRETE (1) Plant for curing and protection of concrete shall be available at the location of each concrete placement before concrete placement is started. The water used for curing shall meet the requirements for water used for mixing concrete. The curing water temperature shall not exceed 25 o C. (2) Exposed surface of concrete which have been finished as specified shall be protected from the direct rays of the sun for at least 2 days after placing. Freshly placed concrete shall be protected from damage by rainfall. (3) Exposed surfaces shall be kept moist or the moisture in the concrete shall be prevented from evaporating for at least 14 days after placing by means of continuous sprinkling or spraying with water, or by other methods approved by the Engineer-in- Charge. (4) Care shall be taken not to disturb the steel reinforcement projecting from any placement for at least 24 hours after the completion of such placement. (5) The Contractor shall not move any load on concrete surfaces which in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge have not attained sufficient strength. In case loads are required to be moved, the Engineer-in-Charge may permit Contractor to do so on condition that Contractor provides the means for protecting the concrete surface subject to approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. (6) The Engineer-in-Charge may permit the use of curing by means of membrane forming compounds. Sealing compounds proposed by the Contractor will be subject to sampling and testing and will have to be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (7) Curing compounds shall be applied according to the manufacturer's recommendations to provide a continuous uniform membrane over all area. Curing compounds shall be applied only after moist curing has been carried out for at least 24 hours. Curing membranes shall be protected from damage at all times. (8) Curing compound shall not be used on any unformed surface where, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge, the irregularities in that surface would prevent the membrane forming an effective seal, on any surface which has a temperature lower than manufacturer's recommended application temperature, on any surface where a bond is required for additional concrete, or where a bonded surface coating is to be applied. Where a curing compound is placed on a surface where a bond is required, it shall be removed by sand blasting or by other means satisfactory to the Engineer-in-Charge. (9) Concrete poured in tunnels to form tunnel linings shall be cured by membrane curing, as described above. Curing compounds used in tunnels shall not contain solvents which may create hazardous conditions. (10) Curing compounds used for surfaces exposed to view shall degrade completely when exposed to air for more then 3 months. They are to remain at least 80% impermeable for 1 month after application. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 147
9.15 REPAIR OF CONCRETE 9.15.1 General (1) Repair of damaged or defective concrete shall be performed by skilled workmen only, and in the presence of the Engineer-in-Charge. No repair work shall be carried out until the Engineer-in-Charge has inspected the location of the proposed repair and accepted the method of repair proposed by the Contractor. (2) Contractor shall correct all imperfections on the concrete surface as necessary to produce surface that conforms to the requirements specified. (3) Where concrete is exposed to flowing water or to weather, porous and fractured concrete and surface concrete to which additions are required to bring it to prescribed lines shall be removed by chipping openings into the concrete a minimum of 75 mm below the reinforcing or to the depth required by the Engineer-in-Charge if sound concrete is not encountered at 75mm. Repair areas shall be formed and area filled with fresh concrete. If the concrete section to be repaired contains no reinforcement, concrete shall be chipped to a minimum depth of 100mm. (4) The chipped openings shall be sharp edged and keyed and shall be filled to the required lines with fresh concrete or patching mortar, as approved by the Engineer-in- Charge. Where concrete is used for filling, the chipped openings shall not be less than 75 mm in depth and the fresh concrete shall be reinforced and doweled to the surface of the openings, as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (5) Dry pack mortar for patching shall consist of 1 part cementing material, 2 parts by volume of regular sand, and just enough water so that after thorough mixing of the ingredients the mortar will barely held together when compacted by squeezing with the hand. The mortar shall be fresh when placed, and any mortar that is not used within 1 hour after preparation shall be wasted. J ust prior to mortar application, the surface to which the mortar is to bond shall be kept wet for at least 2 hours, then scrubbed with a small quantity of cement grout using a wire brush. (6) When repairs are more than 25 mm deep, the mortar shall be applied in layers not more than 20 mm thick to avoid sagging. After each layer, except the last is placed, it shall be thoroughly roughened by scratching with a trowel to provide an effective bond with the succeeding layers. The last or finishing layer shall be smoothened with a trowel to form a continuous surface with the surrounding concrete. All patches on exposed surface shall be neat and smooth and as nearly as possible of the same colour as the adjoining concrete. All patches shall be thoroughly bonded to the surfaces of the chipped openings, shall be cured to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in- Charge and shall be sound and free from shrinkage cracks and drummy areas. (7) For concrete surfaces where high velocity flows may occur, and as required by the Engineer-in-Charge, repairs to surfaces having F3 and U3 finishes shall be bonded with an epoxy adhesive approved by the Engineer-in-Charge and used in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. (8) All repairs to the surface of concrete required for flowing water shall be ground smooth to meet the tolerances specified for that surface. 9.15.2 Sealing Work in Concrete Lining of Underground Structures (1) The Contractor shall carry out sealing work to reduce water inflow and water losses through, and to guarantee the normal water-tightness of the concrete lining of underground structures according to criteria stated hereafter and as requested by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 148
(2) The work shall consist of sealing the cold joints, construction joints, shrinkage cracks both vertical and horizontal, honeycombs, and poorly grouted or sealed grout holes. The work shall be performed intermittently, whenever water inflows are observed and measured, wide cracks are discovered (especially after performance of tunnel pressure testing), or the future Impermeability is, in the judgement of the Engineer-in-Charge, doubtful. (3) The sealing work shall be carried out when following phenomena are encountered: a) Water inflow equals or exceed 1 l/min measured at each single inflow source, b) Any water inflow from grout holes and through honeycombs is unacceptable, c) Cracks or joints, regardless whether they are dry or wet, of width greater than: - 0.2 mm in tunnels and shafts containing reinforcing steel - 0.5 mm in unreinforced stretches of tunnels or shafts d) Areas of porous concrete (e.g. due to poor vibration) where depth of porosity is obviously deeper than superficial. (4) The sealing work shall be executed as follows: a) Crack or joint 0.2-0.6 mm wide shall be repaired as stipulated in the Section "Drilling and Grouting". b) Crack or joint wider than 0.6 mm shall be repaired as under (1) above, followed by cutting a groove 25x25 mm along the joint or crack and subsequent filling with an epoxy mortar. c) Wet joint may also be sealed by applying the "Oberhasli Method", which consists of cutting a groove as for the dry joint and by collecting the seepage water into one or several flexible plastic pipes. As soon as the groove is without running water is shall be filled with a quick-setting mortar and, after its hardening, followed by pumping the cement-bentonite-water slurry through the plastic pipes. d) Areas of porous concrete shall be grouted under high pressure (30 bar) with cement grout mix W/C=0.7, by weight, containing suitable water-reducing air- entraining admixture. Grout holes shall be drilled at 500 mm spacing until the rock. After grouting, the area shall be repaired with epoxy mortar. e) Grout holes filled only with water/cement mix shall be redrilled up to 2/3 of the theoretical lining thickness and filled with dry-pack mortar. 9.16 PARTICULAR REQUIREMENTS FOR INDIVIDUAL CONCRETE STRUCTURES 9.16.1 Concrete in the Dam Face Slab (1) Concrete used for construction of the dam face slab and for the parapet wall shall be class M 25/A40. Plinth concrete, and concrete in the cut-off wall cap and the starter bays shall be class M 25/A20. (2) Construction of the dam face slab shall be by continuous casting method. No horizontal contraction joints will be allowed in the slab except those shown on the Construction Drawings at the plinth and parapet wall. Horizontal construction joints will be permitted when continuous casting is forced to cease or where otherwise approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 149
(3) With the exception of starter bays, concrete work on the slab shall not begin until embankment construction has been completed to parapet wall foundation level over the whole embankment width. Starter bays may be constructed earlier with the prior consent of the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) The Contractor shall construct the dam face slab by casting alternate bays of approved width to the full embankment height. A minimum period of 14 days shall be allowed to elapse between casting of any infill bays and the completion of both adjacent bays. (5) The starter bays shall provide a transition from the constructed plinth shape at the perimeter joint to the profile of the face, as shown on the Construction Drawings. Any variation in the face profile shall be made up within the length of the starter bays. (6) Slipforms shall be of rigid construction capable of resisting the working loads imposed upon them and of a configuration approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. The length of the slipform along the slope shall be such that with the proposed concrete mix and slipform speed, concrete emerging from the slipform will not slump. (7) The Contractor shall construct trial bays with the slipform proposed to be used in constructing the concrete face slab at the locations as determined by the Engineer-in- Charge. On completion of the trial bay the Contractor shall modify his slipform or slipforming operations as necessary. (8) Prior to the execution of any work on a slip formed bay of the concrete facing, the Contractor shall erect stepped walkways from the crest of the embankment down the face along each side of the bay. (9) Prior to the setting of any slipform rails, the Contractor shall survey the entire dam face on a 3 m grid to determine the variation in the face profile from design lines and levels. The results of the survey together with the Contractor's proposals for setting the alignment and levels of the slipform rails shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval. Slipform rails shall be set so that the concrete facing, when constructed, follows the profile of the embankment as surveyed as closely as possible, provided that the tolerances specified are not exceeded. (10) Slipform rails and side forms shall be fixed to the embankment face in such a manner that they can be accurately aligned and do not become dislodged or misaligned during the construction of the facing. (11) Tolerances for the dam face slab shall be as follows: Thickness: Not less than the design thickness specified the Construction Drawings nor more than 150 mm above the specified minimum. Alignment: Deviation from a straight line in any direction shall not be grater than 10 mm in 2 m. (12) Any concrete placed which is defective or which does not otherwise conform with these Specifications shall be removed. (13) Curing of face slab is to be proposed by the Contractor. If water curing is selected, this shall be continued for a minimum period of 28 days. (14) The Contractor may propose alternative to the Concrete Facing of the Dam, which may be considered by the Owner based on the merits and if found technically suitable. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 150
9.16.2 Concrete Gravity Structures (1) Concrete used for the construction of mass concrete gravity structures shall be class M15/A80 unless otherwise approved or directed by the Engineer-in-charge. However, concrete surface exposed to weathering and standing or flowing water shall be constructed of class M 25/A40 concrete as indicated on the Construction Drawings. Where higher strength concrete is used, part of each lift will therefore normally be composed of two classes of concrete. Water-cement ratio shall not exceed 0.45. (2) Reinforcement shall be provided at the surfaces in contact with standing or flowing water and at all openings in mass concrete. (3) Mass concrete of retaining wall shall be water cured for at least 10 days unless otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. When curing compound is used as a bond breaking membrane at contraction joints, it shall be also be considered acceptable in meeting the curing requirements. (4) Where the overbreak in excavation below the theoretical lines and grades exceeds acceptable limits, as determined by the Engineer-in-charge, the Contractor shall place blinding unreinforced concrete class M15/A40 over the rock foundation in such thickness that the upper surface is at the theoretical grade elevation. Surface shall be roughened before placing the structural concrete. 9.16.3 Concrete Linings of Spillway Tunnels 1) Concrete used for the lining of the spillway tunnels shall be reinforced Concrete of Class M 25/A20 above spring line and High Performance Concrete in invert and sides. At specified locations top 200-400mm of concrete layer shall be of ALAG or WEARGRIT Concrete. 2) The Contractor shall submit his detailed proposal for placement of ALAG or WEARGRIT Concrete over the High Performance Concrete. The Contractor's proposed method of concrete placement is subject to the approval of the Engineer-in- Charge. 3) The Contractor shall place high performance concrete obtained by adding silica fume and other admixtures as stipulated. 4) At specified locations backfill concrete behind steel liner shall be required to be placed by the contractor. 9.16.4 Concrete Linings of Silt Flushing Tunnels 1) Concrete used for the lining of the silt flushing tunnels shall be Class M 25/A40 or in certain tunnel portions as the Engineer-in-Charge may direct Class M 30/A40. 2) The Contractor's proposed method of concrete placement is subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) The top layer of the invert and side concrete shall be terminated approximately 200 mm below the final surface to provide room for placing the High Performance Concrete to increase the abrasion resistance of the structure. 4) The Contractor shall place high performance concrete obtained by adding silica fume and other admixtures as stipulated. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 151
9.16.5 Concrete Linings of Desilting Basins, Tunnels and Shafts 1) Concrete used for the construction of the linings of the tunnels and shaft linings shall be as specified on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-charge. 2) The Contractor's proposed method of concrete placement is subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) The vault and invert of the tailrace tunnels lining as well as in the construction and/or permanent access adits shall be cast in separate operations. The Contractor shall propose the sequence of the casting operations. The proposed method of concrete placement is subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 4) The tunnel lining shall either be poured in sections or by "continuous pouring". If the Contractor wishes to use the latter method, then he shall first satisfy the Engineer-in- Charge that the concrete production, transport and placing equipment to be used has sufficient capacity to produce and handle the amount of concrete necessary for continuous pouring of the lining sections. In addition, the Contractor shall provide details of the steps to be taken in the event of an interruption in the concrete supply. 5) The number of vertical construction joints shall be reduced to minimum. Inclined construction joints will have the naturally running slope of placed concrete. In addition to treatment as specified in aforesaid "J oints in Concrete Structures", in case of inclined construction joints, the concrete in the crown and the invert shall be removed prior to placing of the next stage to avoid an acute angled construction joints relative to the inside surface of the tunnel lining concrete. No mortar layer will be required on the inclined construction joints in tunnel lining. 6) Prior to concreting, the rock surface shall be cleaned and shall be free from oil, mud, loose rock, objectionable coating, debris and loose or unsound fragments. All surfaces shall be cleaned with air-water jets or by other satisfactory means. Particular attention shall be given to the drainage of flowing, and the removal of standing water where concrete will be placed. 7) The Engineer-in-Charge will determine the extent of the steel reinforcement required in the concrete lining, based on the results of the rock mechanics test, if any, performed in the excavated tunnel. Generally reinforcement will be used where weak rock and/or high permeability is encountered and crack control is required. The maximum spacing of the bars will be 200 mm. 9.16.6 Backfill Concrete Behind Steel Liners 1) No windows for introduction of vibrators will be provided in the permanent tunnel/shaft steel liners. Working space has been provided at the crown of the tunnel to permit access for the necessary vibration of the backfill concrete. Special care shall be taken to ensure compaction of concrete and complete filling of the space beneath the steel lining, and the filling of the crown according to the procedure specified in aforesaid "Pumping Concrete". 2) Concrete used for backfilling behind the steel lining shall be Class M20/A40 or M20/A20. 3) At specified locations self compacting concrete shall be required to be placed by the Contractor. 4) Prior to concreting, the rock surface shall be cleaned and shall be free from oil, standing or running water, sand, loose rock, objectionable coating, debris and loose or unsound fragments. All surfaces shall be cleaned with air-water jets or by other 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 152
satisfactory means. Particular attention shall be given to the drainage of flowing, and the removal of standing water where concrete will be placed. 5) The Contractor shall co-operate closely with the supplier of all the steel-linings during their erection prior to backfilling. 6) Embedding concrete around steel liners in tunnels shall be placed at a maximum rate of rise of 150 mm per hour, unless reliable bracing has been installed to prevent uplifting of the pipes. In no case shall the differential level of concrete on either side of the liner exceed 150 mm at any time of placing. 7) Installation of subsequent steel liner units shall not proceed until either 24 hours have elapsed since placing of the backfill concrete, or the concrete has been shown to have obtained 20% of it's required 28-days cylinder compressive strength. 9.16.7 Concrete in the Gate Chambers 1) The Contractor shall place all required concrete in the chambers in accordance with the requirements of these Specifications, as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Concrete for the transformer cavern is included under this heading. 2) The levels of the floors in the chambers and the dimensions of the concrete elements such as beams, columns, floors, walls and openings as shown on the Tender Drawings are typical only and may be changed in the final design to suit the actual shapes and sizes of the equipment to be installed in the power and transformer caverns. 3) The Contractor shall cooperate closely with the supplier of the mechanical equipment during equipment installation and its embedding, including provision of bracing and ties necessary to maintain all equipment in their correct position during placement of the surrounding concrete. 4) Concrete slabs to be covered with a floor finish or tiles shall be left at a sufficient depth below the finished floor elevations to permit placing of the required thickness of floor finish or tiles, and proper allowance shall be made for the finish when anchor bolts, pipes and other metalwork are placed. 5) Concrete slabs forming floors shall be carefully screeded to the design levels shown on the Construction Drawings. Scabbing or grinding to bring the floor to the correct levels will not be permitted after installation or mechanical or electrical equipment has commenced. 9.16.8 Concrete Plugs in Access Adit 1) When no longer required for construction access purposes, the junction of access adit with the headrace tunnel shall be plugged with concrete as shown on the Construction Drawings. The concrete shall be cast in stages not exceeding 5 m in length. 2) Contact grouting in the crown of the completed plug will be required, and for this purpose a grouting pipes system shall be cast into the body of the plug. The pipe system shall consist of 2 longitudinal feeder pipes along the axis of the adit with vertical riser pipes butting up to the crown of the adit lining equipped with "Manchett"-type openings. The spacing of the riser pipes shall not be greater than 1 m. Grout injection shall be carried out as specified in Section "Drilling and Grouting". 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 153
9.16.9 Other Parts Embedded In Concrete 1) Anchors, anchor bolts, structural shapes, plates shapes, plates for gates, hoists, valves, machinery etc. and other miscellaneous parts shall be installed in the concrete by the Contractor, as shown on the Construction Drawings or as required by the Engineer-in-Charge. Wherever practicable, anchors shall be installed before the concrete is placed. Except as otherwise specified, drilling and installation of anchors in the concrete after concrete is placed, will not be permitted. Before being placed in position, all anchors and embedded parts shall be thoroughly cleaned of rust, grease, paint, splashed concrete, or other coatings that will reduce bond. Where the installation of the anchors is not practicable before the concrete is placed, formed openings shall be provided, and the anchors grouted into the openings at a later time in a manner acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Embedded anchors shall be supported during embedding and embedded so that the tolerances specified will not be exceeded. Care shall be taken not to disturb or displace embedded items during concrete placement. 3) Concrete may be placed to embed items erected by other agencies in the locations and to the dimensions shown on the Construction Drawings or as required by the Engineer-in-Charge. The methods of placement and rates of placing concrete shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Care shall be exercised that such parts shall not be damaged or disturbed by placing operations. 4) Unless otherwise specified the Contractor shall provide any foundation, wall or roof openings and coverings, concrete floor filling sleeves in foundations, inclusive of metal works supplied by other contractors. All adjustments to foundation levels, embedding, bedding and grouting works on foundations, and cementing works into walls and floors, shall be done by the Contractor but all levelling and adjustment of works in foundations shall be the responsibility of the other contractor. Grouting shall be done by the Contractor under the supervision of the other contractor who will also approve the grout mixes and grouting pressures. 9.16.10 Concrete in Blockouts for Equipment Embedding 1) The Contractor shall form blockouts, place reinforcement and concrete as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, and in such manner as to ensure good bond with the existing concrete, to secure complete contact with the metalwork to be embedded in the blockout concrete and to avoid displacement of the metalwork. 2) Blockout concrete includes concrete designated on the Construction Drawings or by the Engineer-in-Charge as second stage concrete. 3) Except as otherwise specified the hydro-mechanical, mechanical, and electrical equipment will be provided and installed by the suppliers in co-operation with the Contractor. 4) Before placing concrete, all parts to be embedded shall be checked to ensure that they are firmly fixed in their required position. The surfaces of blockouts or holes shall be thoroughly cleaned and wetted. Oil or grease shall be removed by brushing and chipping of affected surfaces to a sufficient depth, or by application of approved chemicals and flushed with clear water. 5) The parts to be embedded shall be cleaned of rust, mill scale, paint, oil or grease before they are set into place. Where bond between metal parts and concrete or grout is not desired, approved material such as flake graphite or paraffin shall be applied to 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 154
the metal parts. The metal surfaces shall be wetted before placing the concrete or grout. 6) Only non-shrink self compacting concrete containing approved admixtures shall be used for concrete in second stage and in blockouts for equipment embedding as shown on the construction drawing. 9.16.11 Grouting of the Equipment Bearing Plates and Anchors 1) Limited spaces and small blockouts where equipment bearing plates, anchors, rails, etc., are placed shall be grouted under pressure. 2) The grouting shall be performed using non-shrink cement-based grout or non-shrink epoxy grout as proposed by the Contractor and approved. All mixing and grouting shall be performed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and shall be tested prior to grouting. Technical service by manufacturer shall be organised by the Contractor upon request by the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) Before placing grout, the surfaces of the base concrete to which the grout will be bonded shall be roughened and cleaned of all laitance, loose or defective concrete, any coatings or other foreign material, followed by thorough washing with water. 4) Forms for grouting shall be installed where necessary and care shall be taken that the grout fill all spaces under the plates leaving no voids. The exposed surfaces of the grout shall be cured as recommended by the manufacturer and no loads shall be applied until the grout has reached the design strength. 9.17 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 9.17.1 General 1) Measurement for payment for each class of concrete, unless specified otherwise hereafter, will be of the volume placed within the lines, grades, and pay-limits shown on the Construction Drawings or as established at the Site by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Unless otherwise stated, no payment will be made for concrete placed outside these limits, other than in additional excavation directed by the Engineer-in-Charge, and the measurement shall not include any filling of overbreak unless recognised as due to geological conditions conforming to the limits defined in other Sections of these Specifications. 3) Payment will be made at the Unit Prices for different classes and types of concrete entered in the Schedule, which shall include the following: a. Excavation, loading, transportation, crushing, screening, washing, blending, and storage of aggregates, b. Batching, supply of mixing water, mixing, transportation, placing, and compacting the concrete, c. Provision, transportation, storage and mixing of cement at the nominal content per different classes of concrete indicated in Sub-Section "Concrete Mix Design", and complying with all requirements specified. d. Provision, transportation, storage and mixing of admixtures, e. Labour, tools and equipment for cleaning, and preparing surfaces prior to concreting, 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 155
f. Supply, fabrication, erection and dismantling of forms/shuttering. g. Forming and treatment of construction joints including furnishing and spreading of mortar layers, or starter mixes before concrete placing, h. Surface finishing including bush-hammering, i. Attaining the concrete temperature as specified, and hot and/or cold weather precautions, j. Protection and curing of concrete, k. Repair of defective concrete and removal of rejected concrete, l. Communication system connecting the points of placing concrete with the relevant mixing plant or delivery equipment, m. Furnishing the trial bays and panels, provision of material samples and all activities required in connection with the performance of the tests including their transportation to the testing laboratory. 4) All associated concrete work, such as removal of forms/shuttering and repairs and finishing of concrete shall be completed as soon as practicable after concrete is placed. Concrete will not be considered for payment until all associated works have been completed to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge. 5) Measurement for payment and payment for steel reinforcement is stipulated in other Sections of these Specifications. 9.17.2 High Performance Concrete (1) Measurement for payment of high performance concrete will be of the volume of concrete placed in forms and cost of concrete shall include all materials including, cement, admixtures, silica fumes etc. required as per the approved trial mix design. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include, the entire cost of preparation of contact surfaces with parent concrete, furnishing, mixing and casting of such concrete and any other related work. 9.17.3 Concrete Lining of Tunnels, Shafts 1) Measurement for payment for concrete placed in the tunnel(s), shaft lining and in the access adit(s) lining will be of the volume of concrete placed within the "B-line or Theoretical Excavation Line. (B-Line is defined as 100 mm away from A-Line around tunnels, shafts. A-Line is the minimum excavation line defined in 3.4 of Section Underground Excavation). Deductions from this volume will be made for the in-situ concrete, precast laggings or shotcrete /SFRS placed earlier which will be paid for separately. 2) Measurement for payment and payment will be made concrete placed in the tunnels, shafts. 3) The Unit Prices shall include, in addition to works described under "General", the entire cost of the following: a) Design, furnishing, maintenance, erection, and removal of steel and all other type of formwork, including formwork for transitions and formwork as bulkhead for concreting in approved overbreak areas. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 156
b) Pumping of the concrete, c) Sealing of cracks, cold joints etc., where directed by the Engineer, d) Provision and installation of thermocouples for temperature measuring. e) Concrete in unapproved overbreaks in tunnel overt, shafts. f) Concrete beyond B-Line in the invert of tunnel/adit (Overbreak in the invert are not recognised. 4) Concrete placed beyond B-Line in the geologically accepted overbreaks in the overt of the tunnel will be paid at 85% of the Unit Prices quoted for concrete lining in the overt, when the concreting is done simultaneously and is of the same grade. 5) When backfill concrete (M15) is placed behind steel ribs in geologically approved overbreaks, the same shall be paid at the appropriate Unit Prices per cubic meter entered in the schedule. 9.17.4 Backfill Concrete Behind Steel Liners 1) Measurement for payment and payment will be made separately for concrete placed behind steel-linings. 2) Measurement for payment will be of the volume of concrete placed within the "B"-line shown on the Construction Drawings. Deduction from this volume will be made for the in-situ concrete or shotcrete placed which will be paid for separately. 3) Concrete placed beyond B-Line in the geologically accepted overbreaks will be paid at 85% of the Unit Prices quoted for Backfill concrete behind steel liners, when the concreting is done simultaneously and is of the same grade. . 9.17.5 Concrete Plugs in Access Adit 1) In addition to works described under "General", the entire cost of labour and material related to concreting in stages, cooling of concrete, shall also be included in the Unit Prices entered in the Schedule including embedding the steel door and steel lining in adit plug, which will be supplied and installed by other contractor. 9.17.6 Second Stage Concrete and Concrete in Blockouts for Equipment Embedding 1) Measurement for payment of second stage concrete and concrete in blockouts will be of the volume of placed concrete. Only second stage concrete placed in spaces exceeding 0.10 m 3 in volume or 0.05 m 2 in cross section will be considered for payment. Concrete placed in blockouts or spaces less then stated above shall be deemed to be included in the Unit Price for concrete in the structure with which it is associated. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule for appropriate grade of concrete, which shall include, in addition to works included under "General", the entire cost of preparation of contact surfaces with parent concrete, furnishing of non-shrink agent where directed and any other related work. 9.17.7 Grouting of Equipment Bearing Plates and Anchors 1) Measurement for payment for the non-shrink cement-based grout or non-shrink epoxy grout will be of the actual volume placed in the blockouts and under bearing plates. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 157
2) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per litre (or kilogram) entered in the Schedule. Technical service rendered by the manufacturer as needed, will not be separately reimbursed but will deemed to be included in the Unit Prices. 9.17.8 Exclusions - Concrete 1) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following: a) Any rounded or bevelled edges, fillets, scoring, chamfers, or any deduction made for voids or embedded items which are either less than 0.10m 3 in volume or 0.05 m 2 in cross section. No allowance will be made for approved temporary openings, drains, embedded pipes, or recesses created by the Contractor for his own convenience during construction provided they are filled as directed, b) Any collecting of seepage water or water inflow from rock surfaces and diverting it into the drainage systems as specified in the Section "Care of Water During Construction", c) Any defective and wasted concrete; concrete which has to be removed and replaced due to Contractor's non-compliance with the Specifications or Engineer- in-Charge's directions, and all related cost shall be at the Contractor's expense, d) Any concrete which the Contractor places or uses for his own installations or for his own convenience, e) Developing alternative sources of aggregates by the Contractor and the resulting additional material testing, f) Pumping of the concrete, g) Admixtures used in the Concrete, h) Any precast and precast-prestressed concrete units damaged by improper storing, handling or transportation, i) Any pipe work or material incorporated into the work to aid in placement of concrete. j) For measurement and payment of precast reinforced cement concrete laggings, refer section Rock Support. 9.17.9 Cement 1) No separate payment will be made for the nominal cement content indicated in Sub- Section "Concrete Mix Design" for the respective class of concrete. 2) In case the required minimum specified compressive strength of a particular concrete class cannot be reached, or is in excess of, with the cement content indicated therein, variation of cement content (increase or decrease over the nominal cement content) will be assessed separately and paid for or recovered from the contractor as the case may be. 3) Measurement for payment for variations of cement content used for concrete will be of the quantities, by weight, of cement approved for the different classes of concrete specified, and computed on the basis of the number of cubic meters of concrete measured and approved for payment. The amount of cement required per cubic meter of concrete of each class will be as established at trial mix stage or the approved modifications thereof as established by the Engineer-in-charge in the course of concrete work. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 158
4) The aforesaid variation in cement shall be paid for or recovered from the contractor as the case may be at the rates stipulated in Schedule. 9.17.10 Tests 1) All cost associated with testing as described in this Section shall be borne by the Contractor, who shall make allowance for such expense in the Unit Prices for the concrete work. These shall include, but not be limited to, the following : a) The costs for all tests to be carried out prior to the start of concrete work, whether carried out at Site or elsewhere, b) Routine tests for quality control during the execution of the concrete work carried out by the Contractor as specified herein and as directed, c) Other tests required during execution of the work to be carried out by an approved test laboratory(ies), d) Preparation, storage, handling, curing and delivery of samples to a laboratory designated by the Engineer-in-Charge, if so required for additional independent testing. 2) Should the Contractor fail to adhere to his testing program, all test deemed necessary by the Engineer-in-charge to check concrete work will be performed by the Engineer- in-Charge or a laboratory assigned by him, at Contractor's expense.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 159
10 FORMWORK 10.1 SCOPE OF WORK The work under this Section shall comprise supply of all labour, plant and material and the performance of all work necessary for the design, fabrication, supply, erection, maintenance and removal of formwork and falsework to form concrete structures as shown on the Construction Drawings or as otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 10.2 DEFINITIONS For the sake of clarity, the terms used in this Section are defined as follows: a) "Forms" or "Formwork" shall mean the moulds into which concrete is placed, b) "Falsework" or "Shoring" shall mean the structural supports and bracings for forms used in any part of the Works, c) "Curved forms" shall mean any form not composed of plain surface and limits of curved forms shall not extend beyond the lines of tangency or intersections with flat surfaces. 10.3 SUBMITTALS 1) At least 56 days in advance of any concrete work being carried out at the Site, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge details of the materials for formwork and surface finishes, and construction techniques which the Contractor proposes to use in order to achieve the required concrete surfaces and allowable tolerances. 2) At least 56 days prior to the construction of the steel formwork for the tunnel lining, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge the shop drawings, details, and structural computations of the formwork construction. 3) At least 28 days prior to commencement of work on each particular structure the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge 4 copies of the detail shop drawings with all formwork details and 2 copies of the structural computations of the formwork construction. 4) Review by Engineer-in-Charge of Contractor's drawing and calculations shall not relieve Contractor of its responsibility for the adequacy of form and falsework, or for the safety of persons or property, for the successful completion of the work. 10.4 MATERIALS 1) Materials used for form sheathing and lining shall be of wood, steel, plywood, or fibreglass. All materials used in formwork construction shall be of adequate strength and quality for their intended purpose and shall be satisfactory to the Engineer-in- Charge. 2) Timber shall be sound, straight, free from warp, decay and loose knots and shall be dressed smooth. Except as expressly approved by the Engineer-in Charge, all timber brought to the Site for use as forms, shoring or bracing shall be new material. 3) Plywood for use as form shall be mill-oiled and edge-sealed. Plywood shall be non- warping, non-wrinkling and manufactured with special water proof glues. Plywood sheets shall be of uniform width and length. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 160
4) The surface of steel of steel lined forms shall be smooth. Forms with dents, buckled areas or other surface irregularities shall not be used. 5) Forms for concrete surfaces exposed to flowing water (other than tunnel lining) shall be lined with sanded, uncoated, plywood veneer. Steel or impermeable plastic liners will not be permitted. 6) Rough sawn boards may be used only for the lowest grade of surface finish (F1). 7) Reuse of forms will be allowed only if they are thoroughly cleaned and repaired and capable of producing the finish required for the concrete. Timber or plywood forms repaired with metal patches shall not be used. 8) Damaged forms which have deteriorated through use shall not be used. 9) Where required, expanded metal fixed to the formwork shall be used in vertical construction joints. 10.5 FORM TIES 1) The type, number and positions of internal formwork supports and ties shall be to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Form inserts or other similar permanently embedded items shall be accurately located and securely fastened in place. The number and location of form ties and bolts shall be such as to ensure that forms fit tightly against the concrete previously placed and remain in tight contact during operations. 2) The whole or part of such formwork supports and ties shall be removed without damage to the concrete so as to leave no part embedded nearer the surface of the concrete than the designed cover of the reinforcement or 50 mm in the case of unreinforced concrete. Only metal portions of formwork supports and ties shall be allowed to remain in place. 3) Through-bolts will not be permitted in water retaining walls. 4) Holes left after the removal of supports and ties shall be filled as described in Section "Concrete - Repair of Defective Concrete", and shall be finished off neatly to the standard of the concrete surface. Such filling shall be adequately cured. 10.6 DESIGN 1) Contractor shall be solely responsible for the adequate design, construction and maintenance of any and all formwork and falsework required in the Works. Forms shall be designed to permit the concrete to be deposited as nearly as is practicable directly in its final position, and to allow inspection, checking the cleanup of the formwork and reinforcement to be completed without delay. 2) Formwork and falsework shall be designed, fabricated, erected and removed in accordance with the applicable provisions of the recommended practice for concrete form of IS:456. 3) All falsework shall be designed to withstand safely all live and dead loads which might be applied to the falsework during all stages of construction, service and removal. 4) For the purpose of formwork and falsework design, the Contractor shall assume a value of 2.5 t/m3 for the density of concrete. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 161
5) Detailed drawings of shoring and formwork shall be prepared by Contractor . The calculations and drawings shall show the size and specification of the formwork, including the type and grade of all materials used in the construction, design loads on the formwork supports, horizontal forces imposed on the false work and used for design purpose, and details of splices and connections, including nailspikes and other fasteners. If mechanical equipment such as concrete buggies, screeding machines, etc. are to be used, this information shall be shown on these drawings. 10.7 ERECTION OF FORMWORK 1) Formwork and falsework shall be constructed only after the formwork drawings have been accepted by Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The Contractor shall construct the falsework in strict accordance with the approved formwork drawings, one set of which shall be kept at the Site at all times. No change will be allowed without prior written acceptance of such change by Engineer-in-Charge. 3) Formwork shall be erected and maintained such as to confine the concrete without loss of mortar and produce required finished surfaces. Forms shall be set and maintained within the specified tolerance limit such that the complete concrete surfaces are within these limits. 4) Forms for concrete against which backfill is to be placed or which will not be exposed to view may be constructed of smooth tight boards not less than 25 mm nominal thickness. 5) Forms for concrete exposed to view shall be constructed of steel or plywood which is smooth and free from defects with matched and sanded joints to give a symmetrical pattern over the entire area. Chamfer strips, 35 mm by 35 mm shall be used on all exposed corners, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 6) Any forms which in the opinion of the Engineer are unsafe or inadequate in any respect may, at any time, be rejected and the Contractor shall promptly remove the rejected forms from the Works and replace them. 7) An adequate number of temporary clean-out holes or short pipes shall be provided in the forms to secure the draining of rainwater. 8) When a second lift is placed on hardened concrete, the number, location and tightening of ties at the top of the old lift and bottom of the new shall be such as to prevent any damage to concrete. The form of a new lift shall overlap the hardened concrete by 100 mm, to prevent abrupt irregularities. 9) Forms for sloping concrete surfaces shall permit their placing board-by-board or panel- by-panel immediately ahead of concrete placement so as to enable access for placement, vibration, and inspection of the concrete. 10) All form surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned before erection and shall be lubricated with a non-staining mineral oil. All excess shall be wiped off the forms prior to placement of concrete. Oil shall not be allowed to come into contact with reinforcement steel or other embedded items. 11) Immediately before concrete is placed, all forms shall be inspected to ensure that they are properly placed, sufficiently rigid, clean, tight, properly surface treated and free from excess of oil or other foreign materials. No concrete shall be placed until formwork has been inspected and accepted by Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 162
12) The formwork for the gate groove areas shall be accurately drilled to be held with first stage anchor couplings/plates to be embedded in primary concrete. Both shall be fixed through formwork into the first stage anchors couplings/plates to ensure that the couplings/plates remain flush with primary concrete face and the couplings do not get plugged. 10.8 TUNNEL FORMWORK 1) Steel faced forms shall be used to achieve the F3C finish required on the hydraulic tunnels lining surface. The forms shall be fitted with ample windows at appropriate spacing and locations to allow the introduction of vibrators and to carry out inspections and any other work needed behind the form. 2) The formwork shall allow for continuous concrete pouring of the whole face. It shall be of rigid construction, non-deformable due to working loads imposed upon it. Once installed in the position the form shall maintain it without displacement during concrete placement. 3) The formwork shall be constructed in such a way that no abrupt irregularities arise at vertical construction joint. The joint in formwork shall overlap the vertical construction joint at least 500 mm and one formwork element remains in contact with placed concrete while others are being stripped down and installed for following concreting stages. 4) The windows shall be provided in each side about the mid height at the tunnel and the crown on alternate sides of the centreline. The windows shall be at least 600 mm in the least dimension and shall be spaced at a distance not exceeding 2.5m. 10.9 DAM FACE-SLAB FORMWORK 1) Slipforms shall be of rigid construction capable of resisting the working loads imposed upon them and of a configuration approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. The length of the slipform along the slope shall be such that with the proposed concrete mix and slipform speed, concrete emerging from the slipform will not slump. 2) The Contractor shall construct trial bays with the slipform proposed to be used in constructing the concrete face slab at the locations as determined by the Engineer-in- Charge. On completion of the trial bay the Contractor shall modify his slipform or slipforming operations as necessary. 3) Prior to the execution of any work on a slip formed bay of the concrete facing, the Contractor shall erect stepped walkways from the crest of the embankment down the face along each side of the bay. 4) Prior to the setting of any slipform rails, the Contractor shall survey the entire dam face on a 3 m grid to determine the variation in the face profile from design lines and levels. The results of the survey together with the Contractor's proposals for setting the alignment and levels of the slipform rails shall be submitted to the Engineer-in-Charge for approval. Slipform rails shall be set so that the concrete facing, when constructed, follows the profile of the embankment as surveyed as closely as possible, provided that the tolerances specified are not exceeded. 5) Slipform rails and side forms shall be fixed to the embankment face in such a manner that they can be accurately aligned and do not become dislodged or misaligned during the construction of the facing. 6) Automated extruded curb method shall be used in the preparation of the slopes supporting the face slab. The faces of the concrete curbs shall be treated with bond 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 163
breaking asphalt paint in order to permit sliding between the face slab and curbs. Where abrupt changes in the alignment which can produce high stresses in the curb, added reinforcement in the curb shall be provided. 10.10 FINISHED TOLERANCES Forms shall be so constructed that the finished concrete surfaces shall be of uniform texture in accordance with the types of finish specified in Section "Concrete". 10.11 REMOVAL OF FORMWORK 1) Removal of forms shall be performed with care so as to avoid injury to the concrete and as soon as permissible in order to avoid delay in curing and repair of surface imperfections. Forms shall not be removed without the consent of the Engineer. 2) Forms shall not be removed until the concrete has attained sufficient strength to prevent damage to concrete. Damaged concrete shall be repaired or treated by the Contractor as soon as possible, but not before the Engineer has inspected such damage and agreed to the remedial works. 3) The elapsed time between the completion of concrete placing and the removal of forms shall generally be in accordance with IS:406, but not less than the following: Undersides of beams, deck type slabs, undersides of openings generally 7 days Piers, columns and walls - lifts 2 m and under 24 hours - lifts over 2 m 48 hours Tunnel linings 16 hours Mass concrete 24 hours Removing time for propping under beams, slabs etc., will be taken as per IS:456. 4) The minimum periods indicated above are only indicative. The governing rule to be observed in the 28-day compressive strength, which shall be determined by the cube test in addition to those required by the provisions as described in Section "Concrete - Test During Execution of the Work". When fixing the minimum period for formwork removal, the shrinkage and creep of the concrete shall be taken in to consideration. 5) Considering the weather conditions and type of pour, the Engineer-in-Charge may modify the minimum elapsed time required before formwork can be removed from individual pours, and in case of formwork for beams and deck slabs it shall remain in place until concrete has developed the specified design strength. 6) Notwithstanding the above or any approval given by Engineer-in-Charge, Contractor shall be fully responsible for ensuring that sufficient time has elapsed for the concrete to attain adequate strength before removal of formwork. 7) Forms shall be removed so as to avoid cracking, spalling, peeling, breaking of edges or surfaces, or other damage to concrete. If it is necessary to use wedges, only wooden wedges shall be used against the concrete. Damaged concrete shall be repaired or treated by the Contractor as soon as possible, but not before the Engineer-in Charge has inspected such damage and agreed to the remedial works. 10.12 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 1) No measurement and payment for formworks/Shuttering will be made separately. This is deemed to have included in the Unit Price of the Concrete.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 164
11 REINFORCING STEEL 11.1 SCOPE OF WORK The Contractor shall supply, fabricate, and install all reinforcement steel as shown on the approved detailed reinforcement drawings and bar lists prepared on the basis of Engineer-in- Charge's Construction Drawings. The work shall further include the furnishing and installation of all tie wires, clips, supports, chairs, spacers, lap lengths or couplers and other appurtenances necessary to produce finished concrete structures. 11.2 STANDARDS 1) Cutting, bending, cleaning, placing and fastening in position shall conform to the requirements of the following Indian Standards (latest edition): IS:432(Part 1) specifications for mild steel and medium tensile steel bars and hard drawn steel bars for concrete reinforcement IS:456 Code of practice for plain and reinforced concrete IS:1786 Specifications for high strength deformed steel bars and wires for concrete reinforcement IS:2502 code of practice for bending and fixing of bars IS:2571 code of practice for welding of mild steel bars IS:13920 code of practice for Ductile detailing of reinforced concrete structures 2) Tolerances for reinforcement placing and fastening in position shall be in accordance with IS:456. 3) In case of a conflict between the above Standards and the Specifications given herein, these Specifications shall take precedence. 11.3 SUBMITTALS 1) Within 28 days from the date of issue of Notification of Award, but before procuring or mobilizing to the Site the equipment, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in- Charge updated and detailed plans and descriptions, consistent with those submitted with his Tender and any subsequent amendments and additions agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor, of the equipment proposed for the fabrication of reinforcing steel. 2) During the progress of the work, Engineer-in-Charge will prepare reinforcement drawings which will indicate the main structural reinforcement required in the particular structure. The Contractor shall notify in writing to Engineer-in-Charge at least 10 weeks before such drawings are required for each section of work. On the base of these drawings the Contractor shall prepare the detail bar bending schedules. All bars shown on the detail reinforcement drawings shall be identified on the bar lists and all bars shall be defined and dimensioned in clear and unambiguous way and be referenced to the relevant reinforcement drawings. The Contractor shall be responsible for the correctness of the reinforcement drawings and bar lists. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge blue prints and transparencies of the reinforcement drawings and bar lists as stipulated in the Conditions of Contract. 11.4 MATERIALS 1) All deformed reinforcing bars shall be high yield strength, deformed steel bars conforming to IS:1786 Grade Fe500. 2) All plain reinforcing bars shall be mild steel and medium tensile strength steel bars conforming to IS: 432( Part 1) 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 165
3) Wire for tying reinforcing steel shall be black annealed iron wire, or acceptable equivalent, with a diameter not less than 1.6 mm. 11.5 TESTING 1) Testing shall be conducted as per the requirements of Indian Standards given in 11.2 above. . 11.6 STORAGE 1) Reinforcing steel shall be stored above the ground in separate groups according to size and length. Reinforcing steel which has been cut and bent according to the schedules approved by Engineer-in-Charge shall be marked with a bar number shown on the schedule, by using weatherproof tag or by placing in marked bins, and shall be stored in such a manner as to be readily accessible when required and to facilitate inspection. 2) Reinforcement fabric supplied in rolls shall be straightened into flat sheets before being placed. 11.7 FABRICATION 1) Contractor shall cut and bend all reinforcing steel in accordance with bar schedules supplied by himself and duly approved by Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Reinforcing steel bars shall be cut and bent at the site of the works or at a fabricator's plant in an acceptable workmanlike manner in accordance with Indian Standards. Notwithstanding the above, a bar-bending machine and a representative stock of reinforcing steel shall be maintained at the Site, sufficient to allow minor revisions and additions to be carried out as required by Engineer-in-Charge. 3) The bars shall be bent cold at temperature greater than 5C. Bending below that temperature or warm-bending will only be permitted when adequate precautions are taken to comply with the corresponding direction issued by the steel manufacturer for such bending. 4) Reinforcing steel shall not be straightened or rebent in a manner that will damage the materials. Temporary bending and subsequent straightening of bars partially embedded in concrete shall not be permitted, except when shown on the Construction Drawings or with the written approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. Bars with kinks or bends other than those indicated on the Drawings and schedules shall not be used. 5) Reinforcement bars, other than tie bars, shall not be spliced at points other than those shown on the Construction Drawings without the consent of the Engineer-in-Charge. On occasions when it becomes necessary to alter the position of such splices, the new position and the type of splice shall be subject to the written approval of the Engineer- in-Charge. 6) Should the necessity of welding of reinforcement arise, the provisions of the IS-2751 and Indian Standard's recommendations for welding cold worked steel bars for reinforced concrete shall be followed. 7) The couplers shall be used for splicing the reinforcing bars of 25 mm diameter and more as indicated in the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-In- Charge. 8) Patent reinforcement splicing methods shall only be used with approval of Engineer-in- Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 166
9) The Contractor shall not weld any item to reinforcing steel except as approved by Engineer-in-Charge and in conformance with accepted procedures. 10) Reinforcing bars available from the rejected concrete structures shall not be used without prior approval by the Engineer-in-Charge. 11.8 PLACING 1) Before being placed in position, the reinforcing steel shall be thoroughly cleaned of loose mill scale and rust, grease, paint, or other coatings that would reduce bond. All splashed concrete that has dried on reinforcing steel shall be removed. 2) Reinforcing steel to be incorporated in the works shall be placed accurately in the positions shown on the drawings and shall be held firmly in place during the placing and setting of the concrete. 3) Reinforcing steel shall be so placed that there will be a clear distance of at least 50 mm between the reinforcing steel and anchor bolts or embedded metal work, if not shown otherwise on the drawings or required otherwise by Engineer-in-Charge. 4) Reinforcing steel shall be maintained in position by the use of small concrete blocks, steel chairs, steel spacers, steel hangers and other steel supports and ties, acceptable to Engineer- in-Charge. Wood supports or spreaders shall not be used. All intersections shall be securely tied except those where the bar spacing is less than 300 mm in each direction, where only alternate intersections need be tied. 5) Binding wire, and steel supports shall not be carried to permanently exposed surfaces and shall be subject to the same requirements with regard to concrete cover as for the reinforcing steel. 6) The cover of the reinforcement shall be as shown on the Construction Drawings. 7) All reinforcement shall be inspected in place and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before placing the concrete. Concrete placed in violation of this provision may be rejected and removal required. 11.9 TOLERANCE ON PLACING OF REINFORCEMENT Unless otherwise specified by the Engineer-in-Charge or shown on the drawings, reinforcement shall be placed within the following tolerances: a) Protective cover: For cover up to 50 mm +6 mm For cover 75 mm and more + 12 mm or 1/3rd of specified cover whichever is less b) Spacing: For effective depth 200 mm or less +10 mm For effective depth between 200 and 2000 mm +15 mm For effective depth more than 2000 mm +25 mm 11.10 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 1) Measurement for payment for reinforcing bars will be of the weight of reinforcing steel as stated in the bar lists furnished by the Contractor in the course of the work. The weight entered in the bar lists will be computed using the nominal weight per linear metre of different bar diameters based on the specific weight of 7,850kg/m 3 . 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 167
2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per metric ton entered in the Schedule, which shall include the cost of provision of transportation, storage, cutting, bending, placing, wire clips, ties, separators, chairs, spacer bars and any other fastening devices. The overlap which includes bends, hooks etc. shall be measured and paid as shown on the approved bar bending schedule and shall be subject to a maximum limit of 9% (nine percent) by weight of reinforcement placed. 3) Measurement for payment and payment for couplers shall be made in the number of couplers installed depending on the diameter of the reinforcing bars. Payment for couplers shall be made at the Unit price per number as entered in the Schedule. 4) No extra measurement for payment or payment will be made for the following: a) Wire for tying reinforcement, b) Any additional reinforcement or splices required when Contractor's casting sequences differ from construction joints shown on the Construction Drawings. c) Any reinforcing steel placed by the Contractor for his own convenience in addition to those shown on the Construction Drawings and entered in the bar lists. d) Any welding of reinforcement/couplers. e) Any overlap length used in the reinforcing steel over and above 9% of reinforcement by weight. f) Any reinforcing steel delivered for, and testing of the steel. g) Reinforcing steel in pre-cast lagging.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 168
12 WATERSTOPS AND JOINTS 12.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) The work under this Section include all labour, materials and equipment required for the supply, fabrication (if any), storage, handling, placing and splicing of PVC water stops / copper seals and other components to be incorporated in the movement joints in concrete structures as shown on the Construction Drawings, or as required by Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The work shall include all the necessary supports and ties required for placing PVC water stops / copper seals and other materials. 12.2 SUBMITTALS At least 56 days prior to procuring or dispatch to the Site of the particular item of work to which the submittal relates, the Contractor shall submit to the Engineer-in-Charge the details covering the properties and performance, including the certified copies of reports of all tests made by the manufacturers, along with material samples of the products, of: a) Waterstops (PVC and copper), b) Hypalon band, c) J oint fillers, d) J oint sealing compounds. 12.3 JOINT TYPES 12.3.1 Movement Joints in General Concrete Structures (1) The term movement joints comprise both, the expansion and the contraction joints in concrete structures. Movement joints shall be constructed at such locations and to such dimensions as shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall supply and install the various joint components as specified herein, as shown on the Construction Drawings and in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations. (2) No fixed metal embedded in the concrete shall be continuous through a movement joint except where expressly shown on the Construction Drawing. (3) Expansion joints may be comprised of the following elements: a) Flexible PVC water stop, b) Copper seal / copper water stop, c) Concrete shear keys, d) J oint filler, e) J oint sealing compound, f) Bituminous coating. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 169
(4) Contraction joints may be comprised of the following elements: a) Flexible PVC water stop, b) Copper water stop, c) Bituminous coating or other approved bond breaker. 12.3.2 Joints in the Dam Concrete Face Slab 1) J oints in the concrete sections of the dam shall be provided as outlined on the Tender and detailed on the Construction Drawings. The main joints and their constituents are described below. 2) The perimeter joints between the dam plinth and the dam face slab as well as with cut- off wall shall comprise: a) Pad made with bitumen/graded sand mixture, b) Copper waterstop complete with neoprene rod/neoprene filler, and polyurethane form, resting on a hypalon band, d) Bituminous fibre sheet joint filler, e) Fly ash protected by a hypalon band, f) At intersections of the perimeter joint with contraction joints in either the slab or plinth, special "T"-joints in the copper and PVC waterstops shall be fabricated as shown on the Construction Drawings. Waterstops shall extend from the perimeter joint laterally along slab and plinth contraction joints as indicated. 3) Vertical compression joints in the dam face slab shall comprise:: a) Mortar Pad, b) Copper water stop complete with neoprene rod/neoprene filler, and polyurethane form, resting on a hypalon band, c) J oint sealer, (4) Vertical contraction joints in the dam face slab shall comprise: a) Mortar pad, b) Copper water stop complete with neoprene rod/neoprene filler resting on a hypalon band, c) Surface painted with asphalt, d) Fly ash protected by hypalon membrane. (5) Horizontal construction joints in the dam face slab shall comprise: a) Rough Surface (Green Cut), b) J oint Sealer. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 170
(6) The horizontal contraction joint between the dam face slab and the parapet wall shall comprise of: a) Mortar Pad, b) Copper waterstop complete with neoprene rod/neoprene filler and polyurethane form, resting on a hypalon band d) Bituminous fibre sheet joint filler, e) Fly ash protected by hypalon membrane. (7) The vertical joints in parapet wall, shall comprise of : a) J oint sealant, b) Bituminous fibre sheet joint filler, 12.4 MATERIALS 12.4.1 PVC Waterstops (1) Waterstops shall be made of extruded polyvinyl chloride (PVC) conforming to IS:12200. Material for waterstops shall be clean, homogeneous and free from porosity and other imperfections. (2) Waterstops will have minimum width of 300 mm. Minimum wall thickness shall be 8 mm. (3) The properties of waterstops shall meet the following requirements: Specific Density: Not less than 1.3 g/cm 3
Tensile Strength: Not less than 120 kg/cm 2
Ultimate Elongation: Not less than 33% Stiffness in Flexure: Not less than 28 kg/cm 2
Cold bend: No crack when bent at 180 o after being exposed for two hours to a temperature of 5 o C Resistance to alkalis: Testing on alkalis shall result after 7 days in a variation in weight within the limits of -0.1% to +0.25%; after 28 days the variation in weight and shall be within the limits of -0.30% to +0.40%. (4) The wings of the PVC waterstop shall be provided with corrugations or bulbs to achieve good bond. PVC waterstops in expansion joints shall be provided with hollow centre bulb. (5) Waterstops must have been tested by the manufacturer as follows: a) Tensile strength and ultimate elongation shall be tested in accordance with IS:8543, specimens being cut by means of Die "C". Conformity shall be determined on the average of results from test on five specimen. b) Modulus of elasticity shall be tested by clamping the specimen on the testing machine in such a manner to form a cantilever beam with the 25 mm dimension as the beam width. The specimen shall be held between the centre line and nearest width on one side of the piece so as to result, with the load applied at the farthest rib from the clamp, in a nominal span of 4 cm in length. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 171
Load shall be applied across the full width of the specimen by a rigid, blade type, loading head of 1 mm contact edge radius. With load value being that obtained for a deflection rate of 5 mm/min., the modulus of the material shall be calculated from the formula E =PL 3 /3DI, in which: E =modulus elasticity (N/mm2) P =applied load (N) L =span length (mm) D =deflection under applied load (mm) I =moment of inertia of the specimen section (mm 4 ) The average thickness of specimen may be used for calculation of moment of inertia. Conformity shall be determined on the average of results from test on three specimen. Each specimen shall 25 mm in length and of the full cross section of the finished waterstop. c) Cold bend test : Each specimen shall be 25 mm wide and approximately 150 mm long. The specimen shall be cooled to 5C, then immediately bent through 180 around a 6 mm diameter mandrel. Any cracking shall constitute failure. Conformity shall be determined from the test conducted on three sheet samples in the range of 1.5 to 3.0 mm thick. d) Effect of alkali : either a single sample cut from the finished waterstop, weighing between 75 and 125 g or six strips from a sheet of PVC compound, each being 150 mm long and approximately 20 mm wide. For the test on i), the sample shall be weighed to the nearest milligram. For tests on ii), the strip shall be weighed together, not singly, also to the nearest milligram. The hardness shall be measured in accordance with IS:3400 (Part 2). The specimen shall be totally immersed in a solution consisting of 5.0 g C.P. sodium hydroxide and 5.0 g C.P. potassium hydroxide dissolved in 1 litre of distilled water. The solution shall be maintained at 20 C to 25C and shall be replaced every 7 days with a fresh solution at the same temperature. At 7 and 28 days, the specimen shall be removed, rinsed, surface dried, air-dried for 10 minutes and then checked for changes in weight. At 7 days it shall also be checked for any change in hardness. Weight changes shall be recorded as a percentage of the original weight and hardness change in durometer units. (6) Storage of material prior to placement shall be made in such a way as not to alter the properties of the material during storage. Water stops shall be stored so as to permit free circulation of air around them. All materials shall be protected from contact with oil and grease. Waterstops shall be stored in a place protected from the direct rays of Sun or to any other heat source. (7) Waterstops shall be joined and fixed in place in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations to form a continuous watertight barrier. All cross-pieces, T-pieces and corner-pieces shall be factory produced. All joints shall be welded with approved, thermostatically controlled electric heat equipment. The temperature at which the splices are made shall be sufficient to melt but not char the plastic material. All splices shall be neat with the ends of the joined waterstops in true alignment. A mitre-box guide and portable knife shall be provided for cutting the ends to be joined to insure good contact between joined surfaces. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 172
12.4.2 Copper seals or Waterstops (1) Copper waterstops shall be of the shapes and dimensions shown on the Construction Drawings and shall be pressed from hard, de-oxidised 0.8mm thick copper strip conforming to IS:1972. (2) The number of joints in the waterstop shall be the minimum practicable but shall not be closer than 3.5 m. J oints in copper waterstop shall be made by lapping the waterstop between 10-25 mm and brazing the lapped surface completely taking care to seal all corners with solder so that the joint is watertight. Brazing alloys shall be 96% tin and 4% silver. (3) The outside of the central rib of the waterstop shall be painted with bituminous paint and the central rib shall enclose a neoprene rod and polyurethane foam filler. (4) A hypalon band 6 mm thick shall be placed between the copper waterstop and mortar joint pads in the vertical construction joints in the dam face slab. The copper waterstop shall be fixed at spacings not exceeding 1m. 12.4.3 Steel Dowels Steel dowels shall be about 400 mm long plain steel bars conforming to IS:432 (Part 1), and of diameter approximately 25 mm. Prior to placing the subsequent pour, each bar shall be wrapped or coated to half the length with bituminous materials acceptable to the Engineer-in- Charge. As and alternative to such coating a galvanised mild steel or PVC cap may be used. 12.4.4 Joint Filler Bituminous fibre sheet shall be 12 mm thick and shall conform to IS:1838 (Part 1) for performed expansion joint fillers for concrete paving and structural construction (nonextruding and resilient bituminous types). 12.4.5 Joint Sealing Compound J oint sealing compounds shall be as per the specification for hot-applied sealing compounds for joints in concrete (IS:1834). 12.4.6 Bituminous Coating Bituminous coating shall consist of two (2) layers of coating as per IS:290. 12.4.7 Joint Pads (1) Mortar joint pads to be provided as bedding for the copper waterstop forming part of vertical construction joints in the dam face slab shall be of 1:3 cement-sand mortar. (2) The joint pad made of bitumen graded sand mixture to be provided beneath the copper waterstop in the perimeter joint shall be either of the following materials, at Contractor's option: Material 1: Sand asphalt mixture using 7% MC-250 cutback asphalt with washed sand Material 2: Crushed aggregate asphalt mixture. 12.4.8 Bitumen-graded sand mixture Bitumen graded sand mixture for surface sealing shall be similar to those specified for the joint pad. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 173
12.4.9 Hypalon Band The hypalon rubber membrane shall be as specified in the Drawings. It shall be placed as protection to the fly ash. The membrane shall be firmly fixed to the concrete at spacing not exceeding 500 mm. This membrane will also be used under the copper water stop as shown on drawings. 12.4.10 Joint Sealant J oint sealant shall be as per IS:11433. 12.4.11 Neoprene Rod/Filler, Bituminous fibre sheet Joint Filler Neoprene Rod/Filler, Bituminous fibre sheet J oint Filler shall be as specified in the Drawings. 12.5 EXECUTION 12.5.1 Movement Joints in General Concrete Structures (1) Where grouting is not required, the movement joints shall be formed with F1 finish. If grouting is required, joints shall be formed with F2 finish. (2) The Contractor shall supply all necessary supports and ties required for placing the waterstop and shall position it so that its central axis coincides with the joint centre. Care shall be taken that waterstop does not bend or deflect during concreting. Concrete adjacent to the waterstop shall be thoroughly worked to ensure full contact with the waterstop but without damaging it. PVC materials shall be protected from sunlight until installation is completed. (3) In the structures founded on the rock, the waterstops shall be sealed 500 mm minimum in the drilled or excavated slot below the effective foundation surface, and the space around the waterstop in the slot shall be filled with non-shrink grout. Prior to commencement of concrete placing, the waterstops placed shall be inspected by the Engineer-in-Charge. (4) Before casting the second part of a movement joint, the whole surface will be covered with bituminous coating, bituminous fibre sheet joint filler, or other approved bond breaker as shown on the Construction Drawings. (5) Before applying the joint sealant, the joint shall be raked out to a depth as specified. All laitance, dirt, oil and foreign matter shall be removed from the joint by sandblasting, compressed air, grinding discs, or other effective means, and the concrete surfaces coated with an approved suitable primer. J oint sealant shall be placed after the concrete curing period in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. The concrete surface temperature shall not be higher than 30C at the time of placing, and the concrete shall be surface dry. After placing, the sealant shall be protected from the effects of water for a period of 10 hours. (6) Sealant that becomes unbonded from the concrete, or cracks, or shows any other defects before final acceptance of the work, shall be replaced by the Contractor. 12.5.2 Construction of Joints in Dam Concrete Face Slab (1) The Contractor shall supply the various joint components as provided for on the Construction Drawings and install them in accordance with the manufacturers recommendations. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 174
(2) In the vertical construction joints in the dam face a cement-sand mortar joint pads shall be placed to provide an even bedding surface for the copper waterstop. The pads shall be 150 mm wider than the copper waterstop, and shall be of such thickness and constructed to such tolerances that the departure from 10 m long straight edge touching the pad at each end shall not exceed 15 mm. Abrupt steps shall not exceed 3 mm. J oint pads shall not intrude into the design thickness of the concrete by more than 30 mm. (3) Perimeter joint between dam plinth and dam face slab and cut-off wall shall be constructed as follows: a) The Contractor shall construct sand asphalt joint pad composed of a mixture of bitumen and graded sand with finished surfaces to the same tolerances as cement-sand mortar pads described above, compacted in layers not to exceed 100 mm. If "Material 1" is selected, completed pad surface shall cover the waterstop and be approximately horizontal or sloping down from the waterstop as required for best compaction. Lean concrete or shotcrete shall be placed on top of the completed pad surface to fill in the space below the concrete face slab. If "Material 2" is selected, placement shall be either as specified for "Material 1" above or the completed pad surface shall be to the base of the concrete face slab without use of lean concrete or shotcrete. As minimal amount as practical of adjacent embankment material may be removed to provide working space for the Contractor. The exposed slope shall be protected to prevent any ravelling or sloughing. b) The copper waterstop shall be positioned firmly on the hypalon band, and shall be carefully protected against movement or damage during the concreting of the starter slabs. c) Copper waterstop installed in the plinth shall be carefully protected during placement and compaction of the adjacent transition zone, and the construction of adjacent plinth structure and starter slabs for the concrete face. The Contractor shall submit details of the waterstop protective measures for approval. 12.6 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 12.6.1 Movement Joints in General Concrete Structures (1) Measurement for payment will be made for the following items in the units stated: a) PVC waterstop per linear meter placed b) Copper waterstop per linear meter placed c) J oint sealing compound per linear meter placed d) J oint filler per square meter e) Bituminous coating per square meter (2) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price entered in the Schedule, which shall include the entire cost of all materials, plant and labour for furnishing and construction movement joints as specified, all temporary protection of the joints from damage. (3) Payment will only be made for the movement joints shown on the Construction Drawings or directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Additional joints for Contractor's 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 175
convenience may be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, but no payment will be made for materials used in such joints. 12.6.2 Joints in the Dam Face Slab (1) Measurement for payment for joints in dam face slab will be in linear meter of type of joint treatments actually performed at site according to Construction Drawings or as directed by Engineer-in-Charge. (2) Payment will be made at appropriate Unit Price per meter depending on the type of the joint treatment as entered in the Schedule which shall include the entire cost of the Labour, tools, supply, transportation, fabrication, installation of all the materials such as: Copper waterstop with Neoprene rod and filler Polyethylene form Bituminous fibres sheet joint filler Bitumen-graded sand mixture, below copper waterstop Mortar pad Hypalon band below copper waterstop Fly ash, hypalon band, 50x50x6mm angle, complete with fixing bolts Surfaces painted with bitumen/asphalt J oint sealant, including primer
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 176
13 MONITORING INSTRUMENTS 13.1 SCOPE OF WORK 13.1.1 General 1) The Contractor shall supply, install, calibrate, test, survey and maintain instrumentation in the embankment, in the concrete slab, in the foundation, in the spillway and intake structure or elsewhere as specified in this Section or as directed by the Engineer-in- Charge. He shall supply and install all ancillary measuring equipment and construct terminal structures, protective surrounds for instruments, excavate pits and trenches, drill holes, install pipes and fittings, and cast concrete where required. 2) The extent, type, and location of the individual instruments are shown on the Drawings. The number and location of the instruments may be altered by the Engineer-in-Charge during the construction period, according to the requirements. 13.1.2 Measuring devices and structures 1) The instrumentation for the dam comprises the following : Surface settlement points Hydrostatic settlement gauges Perimetric jointmeters J ointmeters Temperature gauges Pore pressure gauges Borehole standpipe piezometers Settlement tubes cum inclinometers Inclined inclinometers Uplift measuring devices Automatic weather station Water level measuring gauges Seepage measuring weir 2) Instrumentation for the intake structures comprises: Surface settlement points J ointmeters (1-directional) Temperature gauges Pore pressure gauges Uplift measuring devices. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 177
3) Instrumentation and monitoring for open excavation faces and underground works includes the following: Load cells Tape convergence points Single and multiple point borehole extensometers Pore pressure gauges (piezometers) Total pressure cells Field and laboratory tests. 4) All instruments and accessories shall be suitable for operation at the project site. They shall withstand the high humidity and wetness inside the dam. All steel parts shall be of hot dip galvanised steel, long-term protected against corrosion or of stainless steel of first quality. 5) The Contract Documents give only the numbers, general type, and general arrangement of the instruments to be supplied by the Contractor. 6) All instrumentation operating on electrical or hydraulic systems shall be accompanied by individual test certificates, and shall be tested in the presence of the Engineer-in- Charge prior to installation, unless specifically stated otherwise. 7) All instruments shall be installed to the lines and elevations shown on the Drawings or as established by the Engineer-in-Charge as the work progresses during construction. 8) The installation of instruments may interfere with the overall construction progress. The Contractor shall make provision for such any such interference in his construction planning. He will not be entitled to any compensation or extension of the Time for Completion by reason of any such delays, including repair and replacement of damaged instruments. 9) No instruments or any of their components shall be purchased prior to Engineer-in- Charge's approval. However, approval by the Engineer-in-Charge of the Contractor's proposals and drawings or data shall not relieve the Contractor from his sole responsibility to meet all the requirements under this Contract. 13.2 SUBMITTALS 1) The contractor shall submit with his bid general information on the instrumentation he proposes to install, as brand and type including additional equipment, read out units or probes which may be necessary for the instruments he proposes to use. 2) Within 112 days after the day of receipt of the Notice to Commence, the Contractor shall submit details of the instruments proposed for the installation. These shall be consistent with the general information on the instrumentation submitted by the Contractor with his Tender as well as with any modifications subsequently agreed to by the Engineer-in-Charge and the Contractor, and shall include: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 178
Detailed description of all instrumentation, cabling and accessories including any ancillary measuring equipment he proposes to install Evidence of the successful performance of the instrumentation proposed for installation Manufacturer's instructions for the installation, testing and operation of the instruments Details of the layout of all equipment and accessories to be installed in each switchbox and terminal structure Details of the terminal structures, concrete surrounds, recesses in concrete structures, etc. proposed for the installation of instrumentation and switchboxes 3) Not less than 28 days before the anticipated date of installing any instrumentation, the Contractor shall submit details of construction procedures to be employed in the dam placing operations in the vicinity of the instrument installation, and the programmed sequence of events for this work including details of all labour, construction plant and materials to be used. 4) During the execution of the Works, the Contractor shall submit any further details regarding the instrumentation required by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall prepare surveys and furnish "as-built" drawings for all installed instruments. 13.3 SKILLED PERSONNEL 1) The whole of the instrumentation work shall be carried out under the direct supervision of a senior supervisor, approved by the Engineer-in-Charge, and employed by the Contractor who is well experienced in all types of instrumentation and installation work and who understands the purpose and function of all instruments being installed. 2) Installation and calibration of measurement instrumentation shall be carried out by skilled technicians, acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge, well experienced in the installation of embedded instruments in dams and who have a thorough understanding of the purpose and function of the particular instruments being installed. 13.4 INSTALLATION 1) The Contractor shall install and calibrate all instrumentation conform to the suppliers instructions and shall, where necessary, expose all partially installed instruments, cables and tubes to continue their installation, including carrying out all survey work required to locate such instruments. The Contractor shall tag all cables and tubes with identification tags approved by the Engineer-in-Charge to provide continuous identification. 2) Instrumentation shall be installed and calibrated in the presence of the Engineer-in- Charge, and when he considers it desirable, instruments shall be installed only during daylight hours. At all times, the Contractor shall ensure that adequate lighting is available, whether by natural or artificial means, to ensure proper execution of the work. 3) Cables and tubes shall be installed in the maximum lengths practicable. Splicing and coupling shall be performed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations. Calibration readings shall be taken prior to and immediately after splicing. Open ends of all incomplete lines of tubing and casing shall be kept plugged or sealed and the Contractor shall at all times during installation keep the insides of casings and tubes free from foreign matter. Cables and tubes shall be protected from mechanical damage. They shall be placed loosely at the base of the trench approx. 600 mm deep, protected above and below with 150 mm of stone-free material. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 179
4) The instrumentation shall be put in operation at the earliest practicable period during construction in order to obtain information pertaining to the performance of the dam, its foundation and abutments. 13.5 CARE OF INSTRUMENTATION 1) Unless otherwise specified, no traffic or equipment shall be allowed to pass over any part of any instrument or connection unless protected with fill to a depth of at least 1.0 m. The fill material shall be stone-free for a height of 150 mm or as recommended by the instrument supplier and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The Contractor shall protect all instruments and connections from damage and displacement during the progress of the work. If damage or displacement of the instruments or connections occurs during the progress of the work, they shall be repaired or replaced immediately by the Contractor. 3) The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the maintenance and repair of all instrumentation for the duration of the contract period. 13.6 READING INSTRUMENTS 1) An initial set of readings on all instruments installed at any particular elevation will be taken immediately after their installation, and the Contractor shall not place fill over the instruments or tubes or cables at this location until these readings have been taken. 2) The Contractor, after consultation with the Engineer-in-Charge, shall program his work and make all necessary arrangements to allow the reading of instruments as soon as possible after their installation. Such arrangements shall include, where necessary, the provision of temporary read out points. 3) During construction of the dam embankment, the Contractor shall read the instruments once a week or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The Contractor shall inform the Engineer-in-Charge when reading of instruments will take place. 13.7 SURFACE SETTLEMENT POINTS 1) The Contractor shall supply, install, and survey all surface settlement points; including survey pins, pipes, pipe fittings, lockable cap, and concrete; as shown on the Drawings. Surface settlement points shall be used to measure the horizontal and vertical movements of the dam embankment surface, the dam crest (top of parapet wall), concrete structures and abutments. 2) Survey pins shall be of stainless steel of 15 mm diameter and 250 mm long. Pipes and fittings for settlement points shall be of galvanised mild steel, and of the shape and size as shown on the Drawings. 3) Surface settlement points shall be installed as soon as possible after placement of concrete or fill at the locations where settlement points are required. 4) Immediately after installation of any point, its position and level shall be precisely surveyed. The level and coordinates shall be computed and submitted in writing to the Engineer-in-Charge within 48 hours of installation. 13.8 HYDROSTATIC SETTLEMENT GAUGES 1) The Contractor shall supply, install, calibrate, test, survey, and maintain hydrostatic settlement gauges and their ancillary measuring equipment at the locations shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The gauges shall measure the vertical settlement at various locations in the dam embankment. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 180
2) The hydrostatic settlement measuring system shall allow measurement of gauge settlements to within an accuracy of 2 mm. 3) Gauge levels shall be determined by reading the liquid levels in standpipes installed in the terminal structures which are connected by tubing, valves and fittings to overflow weirs within the gauge units. The standpipes shall be attached to a gauge board with an accurately marked scale, and shall be sufficiently long to allow for settlement readings over a range of 1.2 m. 4) Gauge units shall be manufactured from stainless steel and shall contain two independent weirs, set at a minimum vertical distance of 300 mm apart, each with an independent connection to its own standpipe. Gauge units shall be provided with air holes near the top and adequate drainage holes in the base. 5) Tubing shall be extruded elasticised polyamide of uniform cross section with a minimum internal diameter of 5 mm and minimum axial tensile strength of 500 N, capable of withstanding an internal pressure of 40 kg/cm2 for two minutes without rupture or leakage. Fracture shall not occur when a 100 mm length of tubing is extended to 120 mm. Tubing shall be protected from damage by laying it in 2.5 mm minimum thickness polyethylene duct with load/ extension properties at least equivalent to those of the tubing. The ends of ducts shall be properly sealed. 6) Valves, couplings, and fittings shall be of brass or stainless steel; shall be capable of withstanding a pressure of 5 MPa without leaking; and shall, when fitted to a tube, be capable of withstanding a pull-out force of 700 N. 7) The system shall include a facility for de-airing all tubes by flushing with de-aired liquid operable from the terminal structure, including a tank of adequate capacity, and a hand pump to fill the tank. 8) A permanent indicator board shall be firmly fixed to the terminal structure wall, showing the position of all installed settlement gauges. 9) The Contractor shall provide compacted level surfaces for hydrostatic settlement gauge installation and for the full length of the connecting tubes. The tube shall be laid at least 1.2 m below the level of the installed settlement unit. The instruments and tubes shall be surrounded with uncompacted sand or selected gravel/sand of 200 mm minimum thickness. An additional surrounding of 400 mm minimum thickness of the same material shall be placed in two layers and compacted by the use of a mechanical tamper or other methods approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 13.9 JOINTMETERS, TEMPERATURE GAUGES, PORE PRESSURE GAUGES, CABLES, SWITCHBOXES AND PORTABLE READOUT UNITS 13.9.1 General 1) The Contractor shall supply, install, calibrate, test, and maintain: jointmeters, temperature gauges, pore pressure gauges, cables, and switchboxes at the locations shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) All meters attached to the external surfaces of the dam plinth and dam face slab shall be provided with heavy permanent stainless steel covers to prevent damage of the instruments. 3) The Contractor shall also supply approved reliable and robust portable readout devices for the measurements of the above instruments. 4) Instruments shall be adjusted to settings determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 181
13.10 PERIMETRIC JOINTMETERS (3-DIRECTIONAL) 1) Perimetric jointmeters are required to measure movements of the concrete face relative to the plinth and movements of the toe slabs relative to the cut-off wall. Measurements shall be made in three directions: normal to the joint to measure joint opening or closing parallel to the joint to measure joint shear in the plane of the concrete face normal to the concrete face to measure relative settlement of the concrete slab. Perimetric jointmeters shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 2) The jointmeters shall be durable and strong and shall have the following characteristics: jointmeters normal to the joint and normal to the concrete face: Minimum range 100 mm Accuracy 0.1 mm Resolution 0.01 mm jointmeters parallel to the joint: Minimum range 50 mm Accuracy 0.1 mm Resolution 0.01 mm 3) Adequate provision shall be made to avoid shear on the jointmeter due to movement normal to the axis of the meter. 4) The jointmeters and extension rods shall be protected against falling debris by heavy stainless steel covers. The measurement cables will be routed to the dam crest and readings shall be carried out from a readout box installed on the parapet wall, as shown on the Drawings. The cables shall be placed on the concrete face and protected by a half-pipe duct. 13.10.1 Jointmeters (1-directional) 1) One-directional jointmeters are required to measure movements normal to the joints or normal to the concrete face. They shall be installed in vertical joints on the concrete face. 2) One-directional jointmeters shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 3) The jointmeters shall have the following characteristics:
Minimum range 50 mm Accuracy 0.1 mm Resolution 0.01 mm 4) Protection, cable routing and readings shall be as for perimeter jointmeters. 13.10.2 Temperature gauges 1) Temperature gauges are required to monitor the temperatures in concrete structures or where directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. These gauges are in addition to those the Contractor may need to control the placement temperature of the concrete. 2) Temperature gauges shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer- in-charge. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 182
3) The temperature gauges shall have the following characteristics:
Minimum range - 10C ... +80C Accuracy 0.2C Resolution 0.1C 13.10.3 Pore pressure gauges 1) Pore pressure gauges shall measure the pore water pressures in the foundation downstream of the grout curtain or where directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Pore pressure cells gauges shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 3) The pore pressure gauges shall have the following characteristics:
Measuring range 0 - 1 MPa Accuracy 2 kPa 4) The cells shall be installed in boreholes at elevations as shown in the Drawings. 5) After the hole has been prepared, the lowest cell shall be placed and embedded in an approx. 1 m thick sand layer. This layer shall be sealed off from the other water- bearing areas with bentonite pellets in a thickness of 1-2 m. In the same manner, the cell located at higher levels shall be successively installed. 6) The end of the cables shall be kept during construction in protective boxes and later permanently installed in the terminal structures or switchboxes. 13.10.4 Cables 1) All cabled instruments shall be supplied complete with the required length of cable. Splicing of cables on site shall be avoided wherever possible. No splicing of cables on site may be performed without the prior approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Cables connected to instruments fixed to the dam face slab shall be laid on the slab and taken to switch boxes installed in recesses in the dam parapet wall. Details of cable routes shall be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) Special cables for concrete and earth dams gauges shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 13.10.5 Switchboxes for cabled instruments 1) Switchboxes shall be mounted in recesses in the parapet wall, as shown on the Drawings; they shall be of weather-proof and dust-proof construction and all metal parts, including terminals, shall be of a rust-proof material. 2) Each switchbox shall permit the installation of 12 cables and shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 13.10.6 Portable readout units 1) The Contractor shall supply sets of portable readout units suitable to readout all cabled instruments. 2) The readout units shall have the following provisions: Digital reading Storage of last reading 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 183
RS-232 interface to transmit readings to a computer. 3) The readout units shall be powered by DC batteries and be light, robust and durable. 13.11 BOREHOLE STANDPIPE PIEZOMETERS 1) The Contractor shall supply and install standpipe piezometers in the abutments or downstream of the dam in pre-drilled boreholes of the diameter and length, and in the locations shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) Borehole standpipe piezometers shall consist of a plain PVC standpipe tube, of minimum internal diameter 30 mm and minimum wall thickness 3 mm, with either a ceramic piezometer tip or with only perforated tube sections, as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. The uppermost 3.0 m of the piezometers shall be protected by an outer galvanised mild steel tube. Piezometers shall be provided with a screw-on lockable cap for sealing the end, requiring the use of special tools for it's release. A ventilation hole shall be provided. 3) Perforated piezometer sections shall contain 2 mm slots covering at least 5 percent of the piezometer surface area. In fine grained soils, an outer filter mesh of bronze or plastic shall be provided, where directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4) Measurement shall be by electrical probe. Electrical probes shall be provided with measuring tapes, of 100 meters minimum length marked off in 1 cm gradations. 5) After piezometer installation, the borehole may require to be backfilled with a sand and gravel filter of an approved grading. Sealing of the borehole with cement grout may be required at any depth. 6) The top two meters of all boreholes shall be backfilled with concrete, and sealed to prevent the ingress of surface water into the piezometer. A 500 mm deep by 1.0 meter diameter concrete collar shall be provided around the borehole at surface level, and the reference number of the piezometer shall be clearly and permanently marked by an approved method on the concrete. 13.12 SETTLEMENT TUBES CUM INCLINOMETER 1) Internal settlement measuring devices shall be supplied and installed within the embankment fill where shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in- Charge. The settlement tubes shall also permit to measure deviations from the "vertical" and thus to determine horizontal displacements by an inclinometer torpedo. 2) Tubes shall be installed vertically in the fill and shall consist of plastic tubes with telescopic joints. Metal plates or cross arms shall be placed at 5 m intervals, the first metal plate being provided at the lowest point on the device. 3) Settlement devices shall be provided with a screw-on lockable cap requiring the use of special tools for its release. 4) The top 1.0 m of each settlement device shall be surrounded in concrete of 150 mm minimum thickness, and with a 500 mm diameter, 200 mm thick collar at the surface. The reference number of the settlement tube shall be clearly and permanently marked by an approved method on the concrete. 5) The Contractor shall supply a settlement measuring system, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge, which shall comprise a probe with measuring tape 80 m long; lowering devices and readout and recording unit. 6) The Contractor shall supply an inclinometer measuring system of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge, which shall comprise: 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 184
Torpedo with 100 m cable Pulley assembly Dummy inclinometer probe Readout and recording unit Software for data transmission processing, validating and graphing. 13.13 INCLINED INCLINOMETERS 1) The Contractor shall supply and install inclinometer tubes on the face slab which has a slope of about 1(v) to 1.5(h) as described herein. The ancillary measuring equipment consists of torpedo and readout equipment. The installation shall be such as to allow measurements in changes of inclination and thus deflections normal to the face slab at each 1.5 m length of tube. Inclinometers shall be provided with a screw-on lockable cap, requiring the use of special tools for its release. The tube laid on the face slab shall be protected by a cover of stainless steel. 2) Measurement will be taken from the dam crest. A manhole shall be constructed at the dam crest to provide access to the head of the inclinometer tube. The manhole shall be provided with a removable steel cover designed for the traffic load on the dam crest. 3) During construction and before the filling of the reservoir a mobile probe shall be used to establish the datum line. During the filling and up till the stage of the full reservoir recording should be done every 2 hours at the central casing. Once the location of the maximum deformation positions are established, the installation of fixed probes should follow as shown on drawings. 4) The Contractor shall supply the required measuring system for the inclined inclinometer which shall comprise: Mobile Torpedo with 100 m cable Fixed Probe Pulley assembly Dummy inclinometer probe Readout and recording unit Software for data transmission, processing, validating and graphing. 13.14 UPLIFT MEASURING DEVICES 1) Uplift measuring devices shall be installed on top of boreholes or piezometers. 2) They shall consist of tubes connected to the borehole or piezometers, a valve to release the pressure and to measure the discharge and a readout manometer. The manometer shall permit readings up to 5 bar with an accuracy of 0.05 bar. 13.15 TERMINAL STRUCTURES FOR HYDRAULIC SETTLEMENT GAUGES 1) The Contractor shall construct terminal structures for the hydraulic settlement gauges on the downstream face of the dam at the locations shown on the Drawings. Terminal structures shall be of reinforced concrete with a painted, mild steel, lockable security door. 2) Terminal structures shall be founded on a 300 mm thick layer of selected material (Zone 2) which shall be placed and compacted on the surface of Zone 3C material. Backfill around terminal structures shall also be with selected material. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 185
13.16 COMPUTER HARD- AND SOFTWARE 1) The Contractor shall supply a computer station including printer, plotter and all hard- and software required to handle all monitoring data acquired. 2) The computer shall meet the following minimum requirements:
Model: Laptop Processor: Pentium Ram: 1 GB Hard-disk: 80 GB Drive: Floppy, CD-ROM, 21P-Drive (100 MB) Power adapter: 230 V AC/DC 3) Printer and plotter required for the presentation of the acquired monitoring data. 4) All computer hard- and software necessary for processing and evaluation of the monitoring data. 13.17 AUTOMATIC WEATHER STATION 1) The Automatic weather station (AWS) must permit to record automatically and continuously the following meteorological data: Wind speed Air temperature Rainfall Relative humidity.
2) The sensors of the AWS shall meet the following requirements: Wind speed sensor Range: 0.5 to 100 m/s Resolution: 0.5 m/s Air temperature sensor Range: -15C to +49C Resolution: 0.1C Rainfall sensor Maximum: 10 mm/min Resolution: 0.02 mm Relative humidity sensor Range: 5% to 99% Resolution: 0.1% 3) The sampling interval shall be adjustable from 1 to 3 hours. 4) All the sensors must be operated with solar cells with provision for power module. 5) The station must have the facility for transmitting real time data through VHF radio link, as requested for installations in remote areas. 6) The data storing unit of the AWS shall have the facility to store all data for a period of at least 31 days and shall permit instant display of data. 7) The Contractor shall supply and install a complete AWS including all instrument shelters and including a standby data storing unit. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 186
13.18 WATER LEVEL MEASURING GAUGE 1) The Contractor shall supply and install water level measuring gauges, e.g. at the abutment walls of the spillway or at location determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The height range to be covered by the gauges shall be 50 metres. 3) The gauges shall be of enamelled ironware with melamine resin coating, and shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge. The principal division shall be in metres above sea level, which will be further divided into centimetres. The lettering shall be every 10 cm with large, clearly legible letters. 4) The Contractor shall set the gauges by accurate levelling from a designated benchmark. The gauges shall be fixed to the concrete walls by means of stainless steel expansion bolts (e.g. Nelson or Hilti). 13.19 SEEPAGE MEASURING WEIR 1) A reinforced concrete weir shall be constructed at the downstream toe of the dam. The measuring weir shall consist of a V-notch steel plate designed and calibrated for seepage quantities up to 50 l/s. 13.20 MONITORING OF SPILLWAY EXCAVATION FACES AND UNDERGROUND OPENINGS 13.20.1 General 1) The Contractor shall supply and install the measuring devices, carry out additional excavation, drilling, construct concrete or mortar pads, backfilling with concrete, perform the measurement, and record the readings for the following: Load cells Convergence measuring points Borehole extensometers Piezometers (pore pressure gauges) Total pressure cells Laboratory tests Preparatory works for micro-seismic surveys 2) The measuring devices to be provided shall be manufactured by a reputed manufacturer with prove record and acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) Investigations listed above shall be carried out during excavation work at the locations and time intervals as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The testing shall be performed by Contractor's personnel experienced and trained in rock mechanics testing and recording the readings. All testing to be undertaken shall be done under direct supervision of the Engineer-in-Charge, who will interpret the results. Should the Contractor not have the persons required on his staff, he shall engage a specialised geotechnical firm as his subcontractor, subject to approval by the engineer-in-Charge. 4) The Contractor shall take utmost care in the recording and analysis of the readings and prevent mixing of readings from different instruments. 5) The Contractor shall make provisions in his planned excavation activities to enable the performance of the rock mechanics testing to be carried out concurrently with the underground excavation without disruption or delay. No extension of time for the Completion of Works will be granted to the Contractor due to the performance of such testing. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 187
13.20.2 Load cells 1) Load cells of mechanical type shall be installed to monitor the behaviour of rock bolts installed. 2) The load cells shall have the following characteristics: Capacity: 300 kN Overload capacity: 50% of F.S. Accuracy: 0.5% of F.S. Suitable for 25 mm and 32 mm diameter rockbolts
13.20.3 Convergence measurement 1) Convergence measurement shall be performed in underground excavation works to determine the relative displacement of opposite measuring points placed around the excavation perimeter. 2) The measuring points shall consist of the convergence bolts made of stainless steel pins mounted on a short reinforcing bar grouted into predrilled hole. 3) The distance changes between the opposite convergence bolts shall be measured by means of a steel tape of a low thermal coefficient connected to the bolts and tensioned between them. Change of length shall be read on a dial gauge of 1 cm gauge. Accuracy of the measurement shall be 1 mm. 4) The convergence bolts shall be installed within the heading zone after the installation of supports. At the beginning, the measurement shall be carried out daily. later, weekly readings shall be taken for several months up to the cessation of any movement but latest when the placing of the concrete lining commences. 5) The convergence measuring tape and the dial gauge shall be calibrated on their corresponding calibration devices before and after each measurement. Digital readout shall be in metric unit. 13.20.4 Rod extensometers 1) Rod extensometers shall be installed underground excavation to measure displacements in the rock mass surrounding the excavation. 2) Rod extensometers shall be installed in the boreholes as indicated on the Drawings or as instructed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) The rod extensometers to be installed shall be of single point or three point type. The borehole diameter shall be 76 mm or as recommended by the supplier of the extensometers. The measuring heads shall be installed in recesses excavated around the collar prior to the drilling of the hole and shall be protected from damage by a cover plate. 4) For underground excavations single-point and multipoint extensometers will have a length upto 10 m. On open excavation faces, single- and three-point extensometers shall be up to 15 m long. 5) Reading of the extensometers shall be done with a dial gauge of 0.01 mm scale division. At the beginning, the readings shall be taken daily. Later, weekly readings shall be taken until the Engineer-in-Charge permits termination but latest when the placing of the concrete lining commences. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 188
13.20.5 Piezometers (transducers) 1) Water pressure transducers shall be installed in boreholes behind shotcrete or concrete lining or where directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 2) The transducers shall be as specified for "Pore pressure gauges" above. 3) The transducers shall be provided with a measuring cable of 20 m length. 13.20.6 Total pressure cells 1) Total pressure cells shall measure the pressure normal to the back face of linings. 2) Total pressure meters shall be of standard market quality, as approved by the Engineer-in-charge. 3) Each pressure meters shall be provided with a measuring cable of 20 m length. 13.20.7 Readout unit for electrical instruments 1) The Contractor shall supply a readout unit for load cells, piezometers (transducers) and total pressure cells. 2) If the readout unit is not suitable for other types of instruments installed, several units shall be supplied. 13.20.8 Laboratory tests 1) Point load index and uniaxial compression tests shall be performed by the Contractor for determination of the intact rock strength and modulus. Tests will utilise core samples obtained from test drillholes performed in the tunnels, shaft or cavern. 2) The samples to be tested for point load strength and the method employed will be determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. Approximately 50 samples may be tested. 3) Core samples equipped with resistance type strain gauges will be loaded in uniaxial compression for calculation of the elastic modulus and strength. Approximately 10 samples may be tested. 13.20.9 Tunnel mapping 1) Concurrently with excavation, the Engineer-in-Charge will map the geological conditions along the tunnels, shafts and cavern, and prepare relevant drawings. 2) This mapping and related information, along with the rock mechanics test results, will be used in design of the final lining for the tunnels and shafts, particularly for determination of need and content of the steel reinforcement in the concrete. Contractor's contributions of data shall be made available in timely fashion to the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) The Contractor shall provide adequate lighting, ventilation, and reasonable access for tunnel mapping. Cleaning and washing of the tunnel walls and crown will be necessary. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 189
13.21 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 13.21.1 General 1) Unless otherwise specified, the Unit Prices for instrumentation entered in the Schedule of Prices shall include the supply, installation, calibration, testing, surveying, repairing and maintaining of all instruments, ancillary and read out equipment, including protective steel covers, switchboxes, cables, tubes and tube protections, required to perform the specified measurements. 2) The Unit Prices shall also include for forming all necessary recesses in concrete, all necessary trench and pit excavation, foundation preparation, temporary and permanent protection of instruments and ancillary equipment by surrounding with selected material or by other approved method, and maintaining easy access to all readout points. No deduction will be made for the volume occupied by the instruments and instrument protection when measuring the embankment material for payment. 3) The Contractor shall include in his Unit Prices any additional readout equipment which may be necessary for reading the instruments he proposes to use. 4) The Unit Prices shall also include for the regular reading of the equipment and reports during construction and the handing over of all data up to the time of completion along with and the instruments and readout units, with all accessories, in proper working order as required by the Engineer-in-charge. 13.21.2 Surface settlement points 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of the settlement points installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per piece entered in the Schedule, which shall include all costs for supplying and installing pipes and pipe fittings, lockable cap and concrete infill as shown on the Drawings. 3) The same Unit Prices shall apply for settlement points in concrete structures and settlement points in embankment fill and /or subsoil. 13.21.3 Hydrostatic settlement gauges 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of instruments installed 2) Payment will be at the Unit Price per piece entered in the Schedule of Prices, which shall include the supply and installation of the instruments, tubes, valves, fittings and any other ancillary materials, as well as supply and installation of all necessary devices in the terminal structures such as pipes, water tanks, hand pumps, etc. 13.21.4 Perimetric jointmeters (3-directional) 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of instruments installed, including cables and switchboxes. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price for each instrument entered in the Schedule. 13.21.5 Jointmeters (1-directional) 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of instruments installed, including cables and switchboxes. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per piece entered in the Schedule. The Unit Price shall apply irrespective of the direction of measurement (either perpendicular, parallel, or normal to the joint). 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 190
13.21.6 Temperature gauges 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of the temperature gauges installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per piece entered in the Schedule, which shall include the supply and the installation of the instruments, cables and switchboxes. 13.21.7 Pore pressure gauges 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of the pore pressure gauges installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per piece entered in the Schedule, which shall include all cables and switchboxes, and sand filling and sealing around the cells in the borehole. 3) Payment for drilling boreholes will be made as stipulated in the Section "Drilling and Grouting". 13.21.8 Portable readout units Payment for the supply of portable readout units will be made at the Unit Price entered in the Schedule. 13.21.9 Borehole standpipe piezometers 1) Measurement for payment will be the length of the standpipe piezometers installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include supplying and installing plain and perforated sections of tube, filter webs, steel pipe protection, sand and gravel filter surround and cement sealing at any level required, piezometer head and lockable cap. 3) Separate payment will be made for the supply of electrical probes for measuring the water level within the standpipe. 4) Payment for drilling boreholes will be made as stipulated in the Section "Drilling and Grouting". 13.21.10 Settlement tubes cum inclinometers 1) Measurement for payment will be of the length of the instruments installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include supply, installation, the head and lockable cap of the instruments. 3) Separate payment will be made for the provision of suitable electrical sounders for settlement gauges including all equipment necessary for taking measurements. 4) Separate payment will be made for the provision of suitable sets of torpedoes complete with readout equipment for the vertical inclinometer installed. 13.21.11 Inclined inclinometers 1) Measurement for payment will be the length of inclinometers installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per linear meter entered in the Schedule of Prices. The Unit Price shall include all costs associated with the supply and installation works for the top and the lockable cap of each instrument. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 191
3) Separate payment will be made for the provision of suitable sets of torpedoes complete with readout equipment for the inclined of inclinometers installed. 13.21.12 Uplift measuring devices 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of the uplift measuring devices installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit price per piece entered in the Schedule of prices, which shall include the supply and installation of tubes, valve and manometer of each instrument. 13.21.13 Terminal structures 1) Payment will be made for all necessary equipment and installations necessary in each terminal structure. 2) Concrete work for the terminal structures will be performed and paid under Section "Concrete". Payment for the painted steel entrance doors and frames will be made under Section "Building and Architectural Work". All other work shall be included in the Unit Prices for supply and installation of instruments. 3) No additional payment shall be made for placement of fill materials in foundations for and around instrument houses; but no deduction shall be made for the volume occupied by instrument houses, their foundations, and surrounds when measuring the volume of embankment material placed. 13.21.14 Computer hard- and software for monitoring Payment for the computer system for monitoring will be made at the Unit Price entered in the Schedule of Prices, which shall include supply and installation of the hard- and software as well as the support by the supplier during the first year after installation. 13.21.15 Automatic weather station 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of weather stations to be installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per station entered in the Schedule of Prices, which shall comprise supply and installation of all equipment to fully operate the station including all shelters and a standby data storing unit. 3) Payment for concrete work if required for foundation of the shelters will be made as stipulated in the Sections "Concrete" and "Formwork". 13.21.16 Water level measuring gauge 1) Measurement for payment will be the number of gauges installed. 2) Payment will be made at the Unit Price per gauge entered in the Schedule of Prices, which shall include all cost for the supply, levelling and fixation. 13.21.17 Seepage measuring weir or V-Notches Payment for concrete, metalwork, pipework, excavation and backfill, if required, will be made under the corresponding sections of these Specifications. 13.21.18 Open excavation face and underground monitoring 1) Measurement for payment will be made for the following items and units stated: Load cells; per unit installed 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 192
Convergence measurements; per point installed. The Unit Price shall include measuring type and readout equipment. Rod extensometers; per extensometer installed. Separate Unit Prices will be applied for single point and multiple point (3 point) extensometers. Piezometers (transducers); per instrument installed. Total pressure cells; per instrument installed, including embedded cabling for post-construction monitoring. Readout device for load cells, piezometers (transducers), total pressure cells. 2) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price entered in the Schedule of Prices, which shall include the entire cost of supply and installation, cables, testing, taking measurements and readings and submitting installation protocols and results of the Engineer-in-Charge. 3) No extra payment will be made for rock sampling and testing. The related cost shall be included in the appropriate items for underground excavation. 4) No extra payment will be made for Contractor's services rendered in connection with the tunnel mapping. The related cost shall be included in the appropriate items for underground excavation. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 193
14 SLOPE PROTECTION 14.1 SCOPE OF WORK 1) Work under this Section include all labour, materials, equipment and services required to protect the slopes either excavated or those of embankments and backfills. 2) This Section covers the following items: a) Rip rap b) Gabions c) Masonry walls d) Turfing 3) The Contractor shall place the various items specified herein as protection to slopes or lining to ditches to the lines and thicknesses and in the locations shown on the Construction Drawings, or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 4) Sprayed concrete, rockbolts, wire mesh, and drainage work, which may also be required for the slope protection are specified in other Sections of these Specifications. 14.2 RIP RAP 14.2.1 Materials 1) Fragments of rock for shall be selected from required excavation or quarries and shall have the same properties and qualities as material for riprap. They shall be chosen such that they have a reasonably flat upper surface when laid. Stones for dry rock paving shall not have a round or spherical form and shall be of regular shape. Stones for rock paving in mortar shall be not less than 150 mm thick and not less than 3,000 mm 2 in area. 2) Bedding material for dry rock paving shall consist of a mixture of sand and gravel reasonably well graded between 0.5 and 25 mm. 3) Mortar for rip rap in mortar shall comprise 3 parts of clean fine aggregate to one part of cement by volume. Fine aggregate and cement shall comply with the requirements specified in the Section "Concrete". 14.2.2 Execution 1) The Contractor shall place selected pieces of rock on a mortar bed and fill the joints with mortar. The work shall be performed by experienced masons, duly qualified in their trade. 2) Prior to placing, the rock shall be cleaned of all adherent soil, dust and earthy or organic impurities, and wetted sufficiently to saturate it, but leaving the surface in a damp condition. 3) Rocks shall be placed on a mortar bed of minimum thickness of 50 mm and carefully arranged in such a way that the minimum of voids remain between rocks, no continuous horizontal or vertical joints exist, and the largest rocks are evenly distributed. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 194
4) After rock placing, the joints shall be completely filled with mortar. Splashing of exposed rock surfaces with mortar shall be avoided, and where splashing does occur, the surface of the rock shall immediately be cleaned down with a sponge and clean water. 5) Finished surfaces shall be adequately protected against rainfall until the mortar has set. After setting, mortar shall be raked out to a depth of approximately 15 mm from the face of the rock, and the rocks sponged off along their edges. 6) J oints and weepholes shall be provided in the locations and in accordance with the details shown on the Construction Drawings, or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. 14.3 GABIONS (WIRE CRATES) 14.3.1 Materials 1) Gabions (or wire crates) shall have a volume varying between 1 and 4 m 3 , depending on the local requirement. They shall be rectangular in shape and constructed of double twisted galvanized mild steel wire formed into a hexagonally shaped mesh, of area 5,000 mm 2 . Corners shall be reinforced with larger diameter galvanized wire. 2) Gabions shall be either prefabricated or assembled at the required place of installation, and then filled with cobbles or rock fragments. 3) The iron wire for gabion construction shall be hard drawn conforming to IS 432 (Part II). The galvanised coating on wire shall conform to IS 4826. The wires shall have 4mm/5mm minimum diameters 4) Fill material shall comprise cobbles or rock fragments that are dense, sound and resistant to abrasion. Cobbles and rocks shall be free of cracks, seams and other defects that would increase their susceptibility to destruction by erosive action. Individual cobbles or rock fragments shall be rounded and well graded in size between 120 and 200 mm. Flat rock fragments shall not be used. 14.3.2 Execution (1) Gabions shall be assembled, connected together and filled as shown on the Tender Drawings and described herein. (2) Foundation surfaces upon which gabions are to be placed shall be reasonably smooth and even, with excessive high spots removed and voids filled with small rock fragments. Gabions to be placed at the toe of slopes shall be laid in a trench at least 250 mm deep. (3) Gabions shall be secured in position by tying to adjacent gabions, and where laid on slopes, shall be fixed to the slope surface by 2 m long hardwood stakes driven through the gabions into the ground at 2 m interval. Internal galvanized wire tension rods shall be provided to reduce distortion of the cages. (4) After several gabions have been placed in position adjacent to one another they shall be securely tied together continuously at their corners over their full height, and filled by hand with cobbles and rock fragments as specified. Once full, the cage lid shall be placed in position and securely tied around its whole perimeter. (5) Further gabions to be added, either above or adjacent to those already placed, shall be securely and continuously tied to existing gabions along all edges of contact before filling. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 195
14.4 RANDOM RUBBLE MASONRY 14.4.1 Masonry Wall (1) The Contractor shall construct wet masonry walls (or random rubble masonry) for slope protection to the lines and in locations shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The stone for masonry walls shall be natural or crushed stone having sufficient strength and durability required for its use, not less than 150 mm thick. The rock shall be of suitable color and appearance as determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. The rocks in the exposed face shall be approximately flat. (3) Mortar for masonry walls shall comprise 6 parts of clean fine aggregate to one part of cement by volume. Fine aggregate and cement shall comply with the requirements specified in the Section "Concrete". (4) Stones shall be moistened and hand-placed with uncoursed close joints onto a bedding of 200 mm thick drainage and 150 mm thick filter layers. Spaces between stones shall be filled with mortar. Surface joints shall be finished struck. (5) Weepholes of 75 mm dia. PVC pipe shall be installed through the wall to the pattern shown on the Construction Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. The upper surface of the walls shall be finished smooth with trowelled layer of 10 cm capping concrete. (6) After completion of a section of masonry walls, it shall be cured with water for a minimum of 72 hours. 14.5 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 14.5.1 Riprap (1) Measurement for payment will be of the volume of riprap, placed to the lines and thicknesses shown on the Construction Drawings or those determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. The actual surface area will be determined by survey. (2) Payment will be made at the appropriate Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include for the cost of furnishing, handling, transportation, and placing of paving materials including sand and gravel or mortar bedding. 14.5.2 Gabions (1) Measurement for payment for the gabions (including crate wire filled with boulder) of the volume of placed gabions. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule which shall include all labour, equipment, and materials required for manufacturing, transportation, and placing of wire crates, placing of rocks and boulders. 14.5.3 Random Rubble Masonry Wall 1) Measurement for payment for the wet masonry walls will be of the volume of the walls, placed to the lines and thicknesses shown on the Construction Drawings or those determined by the Engineer-in-Charge. Payment will be made at the Unit Price per cubic meter entered in the Schedule, which shall include for the cost of furnishing, handling, transportation, and placing of rocks, mortar, capping concrete and drainage and filter layers. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 196
2) Measurement for payment and payment for PVC pipes shall be made at the Unit Price per running meter entered in the schedule.
1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 197
15 ROAD WORKS 15.1 SCOPE OF WORK (1) This Section covers all labour, materials, equipment and services required for the construction of temporary site roads, and access roads, parking areas, and such other areas in the vicinity of structures as shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. (2) The Contractor shall be responsible for maintenance and repair of access roads and temporary site roads. (3) Work incidental to road construction such as guard-rails, culverts, drain ditches, etc., is included in other Sections of these Specifications. 15.2 PRINCIPAL ACCESS ROAD TO THE SITE (1) The principal access road to the Site is the approximately 200 km long public road between Siliguri and Chungthang (Dam Site). This road is under the administrative control of West Bengal PWD / Sikkim PWD/ Border Road Organisation (BRO). West Bengal PWD / Sikkim PWD/ BRO will be responsible for the maintenance of this road during the project construction period. (2) Along certain stretches of the access roads as described in (1) above, the slopes above the road become unstable when saturated during the monsoon time and the road may be blocked by the resulting landslides and rockfalls. Such blockages will, in general, be cleared by BRO as soon as reasonably possible, but must be allowed for by the Contractor. No extension of time for the completion of Works will be granted as a consequence of such occurrences, except if the road is blocked continuously at any single location for more than 10 consecutive days and provided the Contractor can prove that this blockage has affected his Works schedule. Claims by the Contractor for additional payment as a consequence of blockage of the access road will not be entertained, irrespective of the duration of said blockage. (3) In order to supplement the resources of State PWD/BRO, if certain activities are ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge, for the execution by the Contractor, the same shall be considered for reimbursement. 15.3 ACCESS ROADS WITHIN THE PROJECT AREA 15.3.1 Access roads in the Dam Complex area (1) In the Dam Complex, the following access roads upto formation level are at present constructed/being constructed by others from the existing road up to the following locations Road to dam, intake, spillway tunnels sites etc. (2) The above access roads will be handed over to the Contractor on an "as is where is" basis at the start of the mobilisation period as decided by Engineer-in-charge. The Contractor shall thereafter and until completion of all Works be solely responsible for construction and completion of balance works and all further remedial and upgrading works, as well as all maintenance and repair work, needed to keep these roads in satisfactory condition at all times for his own use, as well as for use by other contractors, sub-contractors and suppliers working for the Project. 15.3.2 Maintenance, repair work and clearing of slides on access roads (1) The maintenance of access road to be carried out by the Contractor on access roads within the Project area shall include, but not be limited to, the following work: a) Repair of any road-related structures damaged by traffic of the Contractor. 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 198
b) Periodical shaping and grading of the roadway where necessary to allow good surface drainage and to maintain it in optimal condition for traffic at all times, c) Keeping the drainage structures and culverts etc., free of debris or any other material that may reduce their flow capacity, d) Provide the necessary traffic signs and signals, and effective dust control. e) Clearing of slides on access road within the project area shall include, but not to be limited to the following works will be carried out by the contractor. Clearing of slides on the roadway and lateral slopes, during and after monsoons. Disposal of materials removed by the above mentioned operation to approved spoil areas. (2) If there is heavy damage to the protection works (Retaining walls, gabions) and these are required to be rebuilt, the same shall be rebuilt at the orders of Engineer-in-Charge and shall be considered for payment as per relevant unit rates. 15.4 TEMPORARY SITE ROADS (1) The Contractor shall select, design, construct and maintain all necessary temprorary site roads, parking areas and other access facilities within the Site required for the construction of Works, including all borrow and quarry areas. (2) The roads shall be wide enough to allow heavyweight traffic in both directions. To prevent excessive erosion, no steeper longitudinal slope than 10% shall be used, except when specifically approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. (3) Except where rock is encountered, the back slopes of cut banks shall be stable and compatible with existing topography, and shall be flattened and rounded as far as practicable into natural ground surface. (4) The Contractor shall install suitable devices and drainage structures in sufficient numbers to prevent accumulation of excessive water and erosion of the road surface, drainage ditches, and excavated area. (5) The Contractor shall establish adequate traffic control measures and safety regulations on all site roads. Unpaved roads shall be frequently sprayed with water during dry weather to prevent the formation of dust clouds. Site roads shall be well drained and graded to ensure a firm, non-sliding surface during the rains and in winter. (6) The Engineer-in-Charge as well as other contractors and subcontractors working on the Project shall be permitted access, free of charge, to all site roads throughout the duration of the Contract. 15.5 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 15.5.1 General (1) Payment for the construction & repair of access roads in Dam Site Area as described above, will be made under the following items as contained in the respective parts of the Schedule: a) Stone masonry walls. b) Wire crates c) Concrete, reinforcement. d) Any other item of work required. 15.5.2 Repair of Access Roads (1) Measurement for payment shall be made for rebuilding of damaged protection works (Retaining walls, Gabions etc.). Payment will be made at the Unit Price entered in the Schedule, which shall include all costs of labour, equipment, and materials required. In 1200 MW TEESTA STAGE-III HE PROJECT TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 199
addition, the Unit Prices will include all other costs incurred by the Contractor in order to ensure that the traffic of other contractors, sub-contractors and suppliers is able to pass safely up the right bank road, in accordance with the conditions specified in this Section. 15.5.3 Exclusions No extra payment will be made for the following: a) Extra work caused by the Contractor's negligence in setting-out the structures and slopes, b) Rectification, removal and replacement of the materials which during the placement or afterwards have been contaminated with foreign matter, mixed with unsuitable materials, or lost due to erosion, c) Extra work or material required to repair damages to the temporary or final surfaces caused by the erosion or travel of the construction equipment, d) Stockpiling, rehandling, reloading, and transport of materials which can not be directly placed in the final locations after being excavated, e) Damage and repair to the concrete structures caused by Contractor's operations, f) Additional passes of the compacting equipment ordered by the Engineer-in-Charge if he determines that a higher degree of compaction than specified is required g) Maintenance of all access roads. h) Construction of temporary site roads and the cost thereof shall be deemed to be included in the other items of the works. i) Maintenance and repair of the temporary site roads.